Home
        T-Mobile Samsung Galaxy S4 User Manual
         Contents
1.                    Add to reject list  Remove from reject list  allows you to add  or remove the current Contacts entry to a list of automatically  rejected incoming phone numbers     Note  If an entry does not have a phone number  the reject list    option will not appear     Share namecard via  allows you to send the current Contact  entry s information to an external recipient via either Bluetooth   ChatON  Dropbox  if enabled   Email  Exchange or Internet    Gmail  Messaging  or Wi Fi Direct      Print contact info  allows you to print selected information on  a compatible Samsung printer      Add shortcut to home  adds a shortcut to the current Contacts  entry to an available screen location        Contact Entry Options   1  From the Home screen   tap n0   2  Tap an entry to reveal the  Contact entry s Overview  Screen  This screen  contains Name  contact  numbers  email  and  linked contact  information    3  Press    to reveal the  context menu specific to i  this entry  BS Print contact into   4  Tap an available option     Contact Overview Screen       Joining Contact Information    Most people now maintain multiple email accounts  social  networking logins  and other similar account information  For  example  a Facebook account login name might differ from a  corporate email account login because they are maintained  separately and for different groups of people    This device can synchronize with multiple accounts  When  you synchronize your phone with those accoun
2.                  377  Other Important Safety Information          377  Section 13  Warranty Information            379  Standard Limited Warranty                379    End User License Agreement for Software      384    MANU ON 2c tea rc s cnra rae 392    Section 1  Getting Started    This section explains how to get started with your phone by  installing and charging the battery  installing the micro SIM  card and optional memory card  and setting up your voice  mail   Before using your device for the first time  you ll need to  install and charge the battery and install the micro SIM card   The micro SIM card is loaded with your subscription details   such as your PIN  available optional services  and many other  features  If desired  you can also install an SD card to store  media for use with your phone    Understanding this User Manual  The sections of this manual generally follow the features of  your phone  A robust index for features begins on page 392   Also included is important safety information that you should  know before using your phone  This information is available  near the back of the guide  beginning on page 355   This manual provides navigation instructions according to  the default display settings  If you select other settings   navigation may be different     Unless otherwise specified  all instructions in this manual  assume you are starting from the Home screen and using the  available keys     Note  Instructions in this manual are based on default 
3.               2 0202 eee eee 227  Galleries tene kcu A CEP M 227  GMail    cse ath dnd eb eee ae 227  G008l8 Lieu eaaa retia dbe tus ae 228  00018  cere be e ete ng 228  Group Play              00 0c eee eens 228  a  shiva enen iP 230  Interneb   c Shs ch terse eke od ESI 230  Locala a a EO aout ens eens 231  Lookout Security                        231  MANS a eee ea aer SEIS a Du RR RES 232  Messaging             ssssseeeeeesee 235  Messenger 2 2 2    sse 235  Mobile HotSpot                         235    4    MUSIC eec rtg e hase 235  My Files      236  Navigation oeii deuenia raei prre 238  Optical Reader         llle 240  PRONG  i c the ace ire hack ent tnn 240  Play BOOKS    i  iic Racer aca o Rede 240  Play Magazines                     005 241  Play Movies  amp  TV               00000005 241  Play  MUSIC iio torpe 242  Play SIONS o coesnanr bre URIPERRR SR 242  Downloading a New Google Application       242  Launching an Installed Google Application    244  POLARIS OFICO B riesen 245  5 Bealth   obrero or mtm 246  S MBITIO Ge stern EM ERES 246  S Translator    omo ober etae xr ava 248  SMOICB  ub des cotes tust UR ARERE ETUR 249  Samsung Apps              sssueleesss  250  Samsung Hub asai apasae ae ee 250  SAMSUNG Ek ecni en 251  SOUINGS 2   don see prenen a eeneioe 252  Story AIDUm   acer tirer ee 253    T Mobile My Account                    253    T Mobile Name ID                  05  254  T Mobile TV                000 c ee eee 254  Talk  riae ERU RE aa 254  TripA
4.         26  000 eee eee 40  Applications                  0000 ee eee 43  Screen Navigation                       53  Using Motions and Gestures                55  Using the Multi Window                   57  Menu Navigation                 000005 63  Customizing the Screens                  65   Section 3  Memory Card                              71  Using the SD Card        iiuuuuuuuuuuu  71  SD card Overview          sssseessussus 71    Section 4  Call Functions and Using the Samsung Keyboard              103    Contacts BASE scias cerit Ss aec 75 Using the Google Voice Typing              106  Displaying Your Phone Number              75 Section 6  Contacts                                   108  Making a Call            lsssssseeeess 75 AGCOUNIS cs oia 5s iata du tdut t aati 108  Ending a Call           eese 76 Contacts List    108  Making Emergency Calls                   77 Finding a Contact               eee eae 112  Dialing Options                     2    78 Contact List Options                     115  Answering a Call                 00 0e0e 78 Contact Menu Options                    116  Managing Reject Calls                     79 Contact Entry Options                    117  International Calls                  00005 80 Joining Contact Information                117  Pause Dialing                     0005  81 Sending a Namecard                     120  Wait Dialing                 00000 rdest 81 Copying Contact Information               121  Redialing the Last N
5.         Incase of sync conflict allows you to assign the master  source on emails  If there is a conflict with the current email  sync you can assign the server as the main source for all  emails  Server has priority  or assign the phone to be the main  source and update the server accordingly  Device has  priority       Security options  allows you to enable several security options  such as  Encryption  Encryption algorithm  Sign  Sign  algorithms  Email certificates  and Security policy list  These  security policies could restrict some functions from corporate  servers       Security policy list  lists the current email s security policy    These policies could restrict some functions from corporate  servers    Exchange server settings provides access to the  Domain user name  Password  and Exchange server settings     5  Press to return to the previous page                          Using Google Mail  Google Mail  Gmail  is Google   s web based email  When you  first setup the phone  Gmail is configured  Depending on the  synchronization settings  Gmail is automatically synchronized  with your Gmail account    Signing into Google Mail    1  From the Home screen  tap ERE  gt M  Gmail      Note  You must sign in to your Gmail account in order to  access features such as Google Mail and Play Store     2  Tap New if you do not have a Google account    ipr   Tap Existing if you have a Google account   The Inbox loads conversations and email   Opening Gmail  1  From the Home sc
6.        Image viewer Effects Mode  Change     mcd Record video  Viewfinder button    164    Camera Options  Options are represented by icons across both sides of the  Screen   1  From the camera viewfinder  tap the Mode button    to change the mode to one of the following        Auto  Use this mode to automatically adjust the exposure  color   and brightness settings  This mode allows single image shots or  burst shots        Beauty face  Use this to take photos with lightened faces for  gentler images        Best photo  Use this to take multiple photos in a short time   and then choose the best photos among them  Press the   Shutter button to take multiple photos  When Gallery opens  tap  and hold thumbnails of photos to save  and then tap Done        Best face  Use this to take multiple group shots at the same  time and combine them to create the best possible image  Press  the Shutter button to take multiple photos  When Gallery opens   tap the yellow frame on each face  and choose the best  dividual face for the subject  After choosing a pose for each  dividual  tap Done to merge the images into a single photo   and tap Save                                                                                                 Sound  amp  shot  Use this mode to enrich pictures by adding 2  From the top of the camera  the following shortcuts are  background sounds for a few seconds  The background sound available for the camera   is recorded for up to 9 seconds after taking the pho
7.       Add to spam numbers  allows you to tag a number as spam  so that these messages can be directly delivered to your spam  folder     Options while in a current message    1   2     From the Home screen  tap bed  Messaging     From within an open message  press      to display   additional messaging options    e Insert smiley  allows you to add insert smiley icons  images  emoticons     e Preview  only in MMS   allows you to add preview the  MMS message prior to delivery    e Add text  allows you to add text items from sources  such as  S Memo  Calendar  Location  Contacts  and  Text templates    e Add to Contacts  allows you to add the sender to either a new  or existing Contacts entry    e View contact  reveals the current Contact s overview screen      Add slide  converts an SMS message into an MMS   Multimedia  message and allows you to attach an existing  Slideshow          Remove slide  allows you to remove a previously attached  slideshow       Add subject  allows you to enter a subject     Messages 133    e Duration  5 sec   only in MMS   allows you to change the  duration of the image slideshow    e Layout  bottom   only in MMS   allows you to change the  layout      Add recipients  allows you to enter additional recipients to the  message      Delete message  allows you to erase either select specific  message bubbles or all current messages bubbles      Scheduled message  allows you to schedule a time for the  current message to be delivered      Add to spam num
8.       and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound    Tap Ringtones    Tap a ringtone from the available list  The ringtone  briefly plays when selected    Tap Add to locate a compatible media file that can be  used as a ringtone    Tap OK to assign a ringer     Setup the Vibration  This option allows you to set your device to vibrate and ring     1     308    From the Home screen  press E and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound   Tap Vibrations       Select a vibration pattern and tap OK     Tap Create to then use an on screen touch circle to  create your own custom vibration pattern  Tap Save to  store the new vibration pattern     Notifications    This option allows you to set the ringtone that will sound for  notifications and alarms     1     From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound     2  Tap Notifications   3  Select a ringtone and tap OK   Setting up Vibration When Ringing  This option allows you to enable your phone to vibrate when  a call is incoming     1     From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound    Tap the Vibrate when ringing field to activate the  feature     Audible System Tone Settings  These options are used when you use the dialing pad  make  a screen selection  lock your screen  or tap the screen  Each  time you press a key or make a selection the selected tone  sounds  un   1  From the Home screen  press     1 and then tap  Settings  gt  My dev
9.      Newer  swiping to the right displays newer Emails      Older  swiping to the left displays older Emails     2  Press  r   to select one of the following additional   options      Mark important Mark not important  assigns the current  email an important status    Mute  mutes the conversation      Report spam  reports the Email message as spam      Report phishing  reports the Email message as a phishing  email attempt      Settings  allows you to configure the General  or Notification  Settings      Send feedback  sends feedback to Google       Help  launches the browser and displays Google Mobile Help  information        Creating an Additional Gmail Account   1  From the Home screen  tap ER  gt  M  Gmail     2  Press   and then tap Settings  gt  ADD ACCOUNT and  follow the same steps as referenced in the previous  section  For more information  refer to    Signing into  Google Mail    on page 155     Google Talk    Google Talk    is a free Windows and web based application  for instant messaging offered by Google  Conversation logs  are automatically saved to a Chats area in your Gmail  account  This allows you to search a chat log and store them  in your Gmail accounts     Note  Before using this application  you must first have an    active Gmail account available and be currently logged  in     1  From the Home screen  tap dg  gt   Talk      Note  If you are not already logged into Google  refer to the    instructions for signing in on page 155     2  Begin using Goo
10.     Getting Started 13    Warning  While the device is charging  if the touch screen  does not function due to an unstable power supply  unplug the USB power adapter from the power outlet  or unplug the USB cable from the device     ec              Note  This illustration displays both the correct and incorrect    orientation for connecting the charger  If the charger is  incorrectly connected  damage to the accessory port will  occur therefore voiding the phone   s warranty     14    5  When charging is finished  first unplug the charger s  power plug from the AC wall outlet  then disconnect  the charger   s connector from the phone     Important  If your handset has a touch screen display  please    note that a touch screen responds best to a light  touch from the pad of your finger or a non metallic  stylus  Using excessive force or a metallic object  when pressing on the touch screen may damage  the tempered glass surface and void the warranty   For more information  refer to    Standard Limited  Warranty    on page 379     Low Battery Indicator    When the battery level is low and only a few minutes of talk  time remain   15  charge   a warning tone sounds and the   Battery low  message repeats at regular intervals on the  display  In this condition  your device conserves its remaining  battery power  by dimming the backlight    When the battery level becomes too low  the device  automatically turns off    The on screen battery charge is represented  by default  as a  co
11.     Internet   http   www cdc gov niosh topics noise   default html    1 888 232 6348 TTY       Operating Environment    Remember to follow any special regulations in force in any  area  and always switch your mobile device off whenever it is  forbidden to use it  or when it may cause interference or  danger  When connecting the mobile device or any accessory  to another device  read its user s guide for detailed safety  instructions  Do not connect incompatible products    Using Your Mobile Device Near Other Electronic   Devices    Most modern electronic equipment is shielded from Radio  Frequency  RF  signals  However  certain electronic  equipment may not be shielded against the RF signals from  your wireless mobile device  Consult the manufacturer to  discuss alternatives     Implantable Medical Devices   A minimum separation of six  6  inches should be maintained   between a handheld wireless mobile device and an   implantable medical device  such as a pacemaker or  implantable cardioverter defibrillator  to avoid potential  interference with the device    Persons who have such devices      Should ALWAYS keep the mobile device more than six  6  inches  from their implantable medical device when the mobile device is  turned ON      Should not carry the mobile device in a breast pocket      Should use the ear opposite the implantable medical device to  minimize the potential for interference      Should turn the mobile device OFF immediately if there is any  reason to susp
12.    216    Applications  The Applications list provides quick access to all the  available applications on the phone   Calculator  Using this feature allows you to use your device as a  calculator  The calculator provides the basic arithmetic  functions  addition  subtraction  multiplication  and division   You can also use this as a scientific calculator   1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt     5   Calculator    2  Enter the first number using the numeric keys   Enter the operation for your calculation by tapping the  Plus  Minus  Multiplication  or Division key   Enter the next number   5  To view the result  tap the    equals  key   Repeat steps 1 to 4 as many times as required                 Note  Place the screen in Landscape mode to reveal additional  scientific functions     Calendar    With this feature  you can consult the calendar by day  week   or month  create events  and set an alarm to act as a  reminder  Google Calendar is built into the phone and  synchronizes both new and existing entries between your  phone and your online Google account     Important  You should previously add an account  Facebook     Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync  or Google  prior to  using the Calendar     1  From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt   OT  Calendar   The following tabs are available on  the right side of the display     Year  displays the Year view     Month  displays the Month view     Week  displays the Week view     Day  displays the Day view     List  displays t
13.    4  Tap  Add music   This option is available within  user created playlists      Apps   gt     Note  If a playlist is empty  add a song by touching a holding a  song name from the main screen to open the context  menu  Select Add to playlist and choose the playlist     5  Tap a music file  or tap Select all to add all the music  tracks to this playlist then tap Done     Multimedia 203    Removing Music from a Playlist  1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt       Music    2  Tap the Playlists tab   3  Tap the playlist name in which to delete music   4  Touch and hold a song to reveal the on screen context  menu   5  Tap Remove   Editing a Playlist  Besides adding and removing music files in a playlist  you  can also share  delete  or rename the playlist     Note  Only those playlist you have created can be edited   Default playlists can not be renamed     1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt       Music     2  Tap the Playlists tab    3  Touch and hold a playlist entry to reveal the on screen  context menu    4  Tap Edit title     204    5  Enter a new name for this playlist and tap OK   Transferring Music Files  Music files can be downloaded to the phone using one of two  methods   1  Downloaded to the device from the Play Store   Music files are directly stored on your phone    2  Downloaded to the phone via a direct USB connection   Music files are stored into a Music folder on the SD  card    For more information  refer to    Communicating with the SD  card  
14.    9725555555 S  Email    Home   Al gmail com    Address    Home   128Anywhee    Dive  Richardson  Texas  75082    Events       Contact Details Scree    e Tap         to remove a previously entered phone number     Contacts 113    4     Enter additional information such as  Groups  Ringtone   Message alert  Vibration pattern or tap Add another field  to input additional category information      Add another field contains the following options  Phonetic  name  Organization  Email  IM  Address  Notes  Nickname   Website  Internet call  Events  or Relationship      Use your finger to slide the page up or down to see additional  fields and categories    Tap Save to complete and store the new entry     or    Tap Cancel to delete the current entry     Adding a Pause or Wait to an Existing Contact    1     2     From the Home screen  tap  m and use the  on screen keypad to enter a new phone number   Press      and then tap Add 2 sec pause  This feature  adds an automatic two second pause     or        Press   FA and then tap Add wait  This feature causes  the phone to require your acceptance before sending  the next set of entered digits     3  Tap Add to Contacts Update existing     114    4     6     Scroll through the available list of existing entries and  select the desired target     Note  This new phone number is then added as a new number  to the selected entry     Tap the label button  to the left of the new phone  number  and scroll through the list to select a category  
15.    Details  files details such as Title  Time  Width  Height   Orientation  File Size  and Path        Settings  provides access to the Gallery options menu  Choose  from SNS data management  Cloud sync  and Tags    Video viewing options  Note  If no control icons are displayed on the screen in    addition to the picture  tap anywhere on the screen to  display them     1  Tap a video to select it   2  Tap O to play the video     e Share via EH allows you to share the video via ChatON   Bluetooth  Dropbox  Email  Gmail  Google    Messaging   Picassa  Wi Fi Direct  or YouTube     170      Trim E  activates the Trim feature so that you can edit the  length of the current video     Delete T   allows you to delete the current video   Choose either OK or Cancel   3  Press E   for additional options     Using the Camcorder    In addition to taking photos  the camera also doubles as a  camcorder that also allows you to record  view  and send  high definition videos     Shooting Video    Tip  When shooting video in direct sunlight or in bright  conditions  it is recommended that you provide your  subject with sufficient light by having the light source  behind you     Note  The camera may not be able to properly record videos to    a memory card with a slow transfer speed     From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt     e   Camera  to activate the camera mode    Using the camera s main display screen as a  viewfinder  adjust the image by aiming the camcorder  at the subject    Before you 
16.    From the keypad screen  use one of the following options       Voicemail  Ee  to access your Voicemail service     Call  C  to call the entered number     Delete     3 j  to delete digits from the current number     To view additional dialing options   m After entering a number  tap              Send message to send the current caller a text message while  Still maintaining the current call active      Add to Contacts to add the current number to either a new or  existing Contacts entry      Speed dial setting to access the Speed dialing setting menu  where you can assign a speed dial location to a current  Contacts entry      Add 2 sec pause to insert a two second pause to enter a  2 second delay within a number string  the phone continues  dialing after 2 seconds without any additional keys being  pressed    78    Tip  You can create pauses longer than two seconds by  entering multiple 2 second pauses       Add wait to insert a hard pause within the number string  the  phone waits for your input   A wait requires that any  consecutive numbers be manually sent by tapping Yes       Call settings to provide you access to the Call settings screen   Answering a Call    When somebody calls you  the phone rings and displays the  incoming call image  The caller s phone number  picture  or  name if stored in Contacts List  displays     m Atthe incoming call screen     Touch and slide  9   gt   in any direction to answer the call      Touch and slide ZO in any direction to reject 
17.    Settings  provides information on settings for Wi Fi  Bluetooth   Ringtone  Power saving mode  NFC  Air gesture  Air view   Smart screen  Motion  and Screen Mirroring      Online help  provides more detailed online help for additional  questions you may have      Available accessories  provides information on accessories  for your phone that are available for purchase           230    Internet    Open the browser to start surfing the web  The browser is fully  optimized and comes with advanced functionality to enhance the  Internet browsing feature on your phone   m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt      Internet      For more information  refer to  Internet  on page 259     Local    Local  formerly known as Google Places  displays company  logos on a layer of Google Maps  When viewing an area you  can quickly locate a business or person  find out more  information about the business  see coupons  public  responses  and more     1     2     From the Home screen  tap ERE  Apps   gt    9 tocar   Tap al  Search  and then use the Search Maps field  to manually enter a desired place or choose from  among the various categories  Matches are filtered by  those closest to your current location   Locate and tap one of the listed places  Restaurants   Cafes  Bars  Attractions   user added searches    RECOMMENDATIONS  or IN THIS AREA a list of places  within this category displays   Tap the Maps icon to launch the related maps feature   Press  j and then tap Add a search  The f
18.   1  Confirm you are currently signed into your Samsung  account    2  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt   e  Samsung Apps      3  If prompted  read the Disclaimer  Terms and conditions     and Privacy policy and tap Accept   4  Follow the on screen instructions     250    Samsung Hub  Samsung Hub is Samsung s integrated store for media  content that offers a comprehensive and consistent media  service experience  You can browse and purchase all media  content within a single store front     Note  Access to this feature requires that you already be  logged in to your Samsung account application  For  more information  refer to  Creating a Samsung  Account  on page 21     1  rom the Home screen  tap BR  Apps   gt   o  Samsung Hub   For more information  refer to     Samsung Hub    on page 185    2  Ifa Wi Fi connection is not detected  tap Connect to  use your current mobile network     Note  Using your mobile network may result in additional  charges depending on your payment plan     3  Use your fingers to scroll across the available Samsung  Hub screen  You can select Combined view  Music   Video  Books  and Games   Music  Video  Books  or  Games    4  Follow the on screen instructions to browse  view  or  purchase media    5  Press rm  gt  Help for additional information    Samsung Link  This application wirelessly synchronizes your Samsung  mobile phone with your TV  streams content and even keeps  tabs on who calls or sends text messages with real time   on screen 
19.   2  Read the on screen disclaimer information and tap  Confirm to continue     3  Review the Terms of Service and tap Agree to continue     4  Navigate through the following on screen tutorial  screens by reading the information and tapping Next     or tap Skip to continue without reading the information     5  Wake up the application by repeating the phrase  Hi Galaxy     Note  The wake up command phrase can be changed from       Hi Galaxy  to anything else     6  Tap  Speak  if the device does not hear you or  to give it a command     Example 1       want to find the best pizza online   e Tap and say    Find me the best Pizza     This launches  an Internet search   Example 2       want to go to Cambridge     Tap and say    Navigate to Cambridge     This launches  the Map application and indicates where these are in relation to  your current position     Call Functions and Contacts List     93    Logs Tab  The Logs tab is a list of the phone numbers  or Contacts  entries  for calls you placed  accepted  or missed  The Logs  tab makes redialing a number fast and easy  It is continually  updated as your device automatically adds new numbers to  the beginning of the list and removes the oldest entries from  the bottom of the list     The Notification area of the Home screen  upper left  displays  phone notifications  status  or alerts such as     ES  Displays when a call is in progress     Displays when a call was missed     94    Accessing the Logs Tab  1  From the Home scree
20.   During a call you can create a message     1  Press   and then tap Message  gt  A  Compose      2  Address and create the message   3  Review your message and tap   ZA    Send    Creating a Memo During a Call    During a call it may be necessary to record information  a  Note     1  Press   and then tap Memo    2  Use the keyboard to enter the note then tap Save                 90    Multi Party calls   Making a Multi Party Call  A multi party call is a network service that multiple people to  participate in a multi party or conference call   For further details about subscribing to this service  contact  T Mobile customer service    Setting up a Multi Party Call           1  From the Home screen  tap  4     2  Dial the number for the first participant and tap   3  Once connected  tap Add call  enter the second phone  number and tap EU  The first caller is placed on  hold    4  Wait for the second caller to answer the incoming call  and tap Merge  The two calls are now joined into a  multi party call and display in the order in which they  were called     Important  Multiple callers can be joined to a single  multi party line  Additional callers participate in a  new Multiparty session and are held in conjunction  with the previous multiparty call  You can swap or  place each multi party call on hold     Having a Private Conversation With One Participant    Note  The Manage conference call option is not available for    multi party calls created while using the Wi Fi Callin
21.   Home  Menu  and Back     Home Key  The Home key  C  takes you back to your Home screen   indicated by a white Home icon     W Press and hold to launch the Recent apps Task  manager screen  For more information  refer to   Accessing Recently Used Applications  on page 64    Menu Key  The Menu key     activates an available menu function for  the current screen or application    Back Key  The Back key      returns you to the previously active  screen  If the on screen keyboard is currently open  this key  Closes the keyboard     40    Home Screen    The Home screen is the starting point for using the  applications on your phone  There are initially seven  available panels  each populated with default shortcuts or  applications  You can customize each of these panels     Signal strength  Battery status           Connection Status    Time    Notification Widget    area    Status    arga Google Search    Home Screen  Shortcuts    Primary  Shortcuts      Notification area displays those icons associated with end user  notifications such as  email messages  calls  missed  call in  progress   new voicemail  upcoming event  USB connection   Emails  and Text MMS messages        These notifications appear at the top left of the screen  within  the Status bar area  and display important user information        This information can be accessed by swiping down from the  Status bar  page 38       Status area displays those icons associated with the status of  the device such as communicat
22.   Locking Unlocking the Device 19  microSD card 11  SIM Card 9  Switching Device On Off 18  Voice Mail 22    Gmail 155  227  Composing a Message 156  Creating an Additional Account   157   Opening 155  Other Options 156  Personalize 327  Personalize Swype 329  Refreshing 156  Signing In 155  Viewing 156   Google  Backing Up Settings 342  Create New Account 19  Retrieving Password 20  Signing into Your Account 20  Voice Typing 98   Google Books 240   Google Mail  see also Gmail 156   Google Maps  Enabling a location source 232  Opening a map 233    Google Music 193  242  Google Now 26  256  Adjust Settings 26  Google Places  See also Local 231  Google Talk 52  254  Google Voice Typing  Configuring 325  Using 107  GPS  amp  AGPS 368  Group  Joining 229  Group Play 228  Creating a Group 229  Dropbox 226  Joining a Group 229  S Memo 247  Share Music 201  Share Pictures 169  Sharing Pictures 229  Groups  Adding an Member to an Existing  Group 127  Creating a new caller group 127    399    Deleting 128  Deleting a Caller Group 128  Editing a Caller Group 128  Removing an Entry 128  Settings 128  Gyroscope  Calibration 57  334  H  Handwriting 104  Settings 326  Haptic Feedback  Turn On Off 322  Vibrate 309  Vibration Setting 307  HDR 165  Health and Safety Information 355  Help  In Device 230  Hidden Applictions  Show 43  Hold  Placing a Call on Hold 88    400    Home 40   Home Key 40   Home Screen  Assigning a New 66  Changing Wallpaper 69  Menu Settings 42  Overview 40   Home scre
23.   T    e Mute pause  Once enabled  you can pause any  on screen video or mute any current sound by simply covering  the screen with your hand  Once you remove your hand from the  screen  the device goes back to normal by either continuing to  play the current video or unmuting the current sound     334    Gyroscope Calibration  Calibrate your device by using the built in gyroscope    1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures  gt   Gyroscope calibration    2  Place the device on a level surface and tap Calibrate   The phone adjusts the level of the accelerometer   During the calibration process a green circle appears  on screen and the center circle adjusts to the center  position    Smart screen  The Smart screen options allow you to customize your  screen settings to make the screen more responsive and  easier to use    1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab  Smart screen    2  Tap any of the following options to create a checkmark  and activate the features      Smart stay  disables the screen timeout if your phone detects  that your face is watching the screen       Smart rotation  disables the auto screen rotation by checking  the orientation of your face and the device      Smart pause  pauses videos when your device detects that  your head has moved away from the screen      Smart scroll  once your eyes have been detected  the screen  will scroll according to your device s 
24.   Taking a Screen Shot    Also known as a screen capture  this feature allows you to  mimic the print screen function on most computers     1     3     From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Motions and  gestures    In a single motion touch and slide the Palm motion  slider to the right to turn it on    Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At least one feature must be activated before Palm    4     178    motion can be activated     In a single motion  slide a feature s activation slider to  the on position    With the current screen showing the desired image  in  a single motion  place the side of your palm along the  one side of the device and then slowly swipe it in the  opposite direction over the screen     Assigning an Image as a Contact Photo   1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt  EK   Gallery     2  Selecta folder location and tap a file to open it   With the image displayed  press   and then tap  Set as  gt  Contact photo    4  Tap a contact to make a selection    5  Use the on screen crop the image by dragging it  around or out from its corners    6  Tap Done to store the new image     Assigning an Image as a Wallpaper    1     From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt  PX    Gallery     Select a folder location and tap a file to open it    With the image displayed  press l   and then tap   Set as    Select one of the these options      Home screen assigns the current image to the home screen  background 
25.   Tap Connection Preferences and select a preference for  use of the Wi Fi Calling feature      Wi Fi Preferred  Wi Fi network is preferred over cellular  network when making calls  Calling requires you to stay in the  Wi Fi range      Cellular Network Preferred  The cellular network is preferred  over a Wi Fi network when making calls      Never use Cellular Network  Use only Wi Fi for calls  Do not  use Cellular Network  even if available    3  Tap Help from the main Wi Fi Calling Settings page to  navigate through either an on screen tutorial or review  the top 10 Wi Fi Calling questions     296    Near Field Communication  This feature is used to read and exchange tags  When used  in conjunction with Android Beam  your device can be used  to beam application content when NFC capable devices are  touched   1  From the Home screen  press m and then tap  Settings Connections tab   2  Tapthe NFC field and verify the feature is active   indicated by  RSM    Android Beam  When Android Beam is activated  you can beam app content  to another NFC capable device by holding the devices close  together  You can beam browser pages  YouTube videos   contacts  and more  m  1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings Connections tab  gt  NFC  gt  Android Beam   2  Tap the OFF   ON icon to turn Android Beam on   3  Touch the back of your device with another  NFC capable device and the content is transferred     S Beam    This feature  when activated via NFC  allows you to bea
26.   call then tap OK        Choose from  Call connect tone  Minute minder  and Call end  tone    5  Tap Alerts on calls to turn off alarm and message  notifications during a call        314    Accessory settings for call _  1  From the Home screen  tap  Phone    2  Press    1 and then tap Call settings  gt  Call  accessories   3  The following options are available     Automatic answering  configures the device to automatically  answer and incoming call when a headset is detected     Automatic answering timer  configures the time delay before  the device automatically accepts the incoming call     Outgoing call conditions  allows you to make calls even when  the device is locked   Wi Fi Calling  Wi Fi Calling is a free feature for T Mobile customers using  this device with the new SIM card  Wi Fi Calling is an  excellent solution for coverage issues in and around the  home or wherever cellular coverage is limited  Minutes used  while connected to the Wi Fi network count against available  rate plan minutes     m For more information  refer to    Wi Fi Calling  on page  84     Configuring Additional Voice Call Settings  From the Home screen  tap  Phone    Press    and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional    1   2     settings     Tap one of the    following options       Caller ID  chooses whether your number is displayed when  someone answers your outgoing call  Choose from  Network    default  Hide number  or Show number       Call forwarding  configures the forwarding setti
27.   displays in the Status area        To turn Bluetooth off  o   1  From the Home screen  press 11  and then tap  Settings Connections tab  m  2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Bluetooth slider  to the left to turn it off     Note  Bluetooth must be enabled prior to use     Bluetooth Status Indicators    The following icons show your Bluetooth connection status  at a glance     Displays when Bluetooth is active     Displays when Bluetooth is connected  paired  and  communicating     Bluetooth Settings   The Bluetooth settings menu allows you to set up many of   the characteristics of your device s Bluetooth service    including      Entering or changing the name your device uses for Bluetooth  communication and description      Setting your device s visibility  or  discoverability   for other  Bluetooth devices     Displaying your device s Bluetooth address    Connections 267    To access the Bluetooth Settings menu  _   1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Bluetooth    2  Verify Bluetooth is active  indicated by IIS   Press     i and tap the Visibility timeout  Received files   and Help fields to set the options    To change your Bluetooth name    1  Verify Bluetooth is active  f   2  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  About device    3  Tap the Device name field and use the on screen  keyboard to edit the current device name    4  Tap Er to erase the current device name and enter  a new
28.   follow these  instructions to connect to these network types    1  From the Home screen  press ra and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks   gt  Network mode     292    2  Tap GSM WCDMA  auto connect   A selection indicator  displays next to this option to show that it is active   This is the default mode for this device    Using the 2G   GSM Only Network  If you are not using applications that require a faster network  speed  any application that accesses the network or uses a  browser   using the 2G only  WCDMA  network saves battery  life    1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks  gt  Network mode    2  Tap GSM only  A check mark displays next to this option  to indicate that it is active  Connecting to 2G networks  slows the data transfer speed and time    Using the WCDMA   3G Only Network  This option uses a 3G connection only  _   1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks Network mode    2  Tap WCDMA only  A check mark displays next to this  option to indicate that it is active  Connecting to 3G  networks slows the data transfer speed and time     Network Operators  Using this feature you can view the current network  connection  You can also scan and select a network operator  manually  or set the network selection to Automatic    1  From the Home screen  press    1  and
29.   gt      Add      This function allows you to manually enter and assign a phone  number as being sent from a spam source     5  Tap the Number field to manually enter phone number    or   Tap Em to select from either your existing Logs or  Contacts    or   Tap Match criteria and select a parameter that must  match for the spam action to take effect  Choose from     Same as  Starts with  ex  800 or 888   Ends with  or  includes     6  Tap Save   To register text phrases as spam     Some incoming messages might not be associated with a  phone number but rather an email address  In these cases   the only way to block those messages  would be assign a  key used term or phrase to activate the Spam block  Ex    Dear friend    Stock Alert   or  Act Now     1  From the Home screen  tap v     2  Press I and then tap Settings   3  Locate and activate the Spam settings option     4  Tap Add to spam phrases  gt       Add    e This function allows you to assign a specific text phrase as  belonging to a spam message  Ex  Dear friend   5  Enter a term or word into the field     Note  The term is case sensitive  Ex     Act Now    is not the  same as    act now        6  Tap Save   To register unknown numbers as spam     Some incoming messages might not be associated with  either a phone number or email address  These incoming  messages contain no information as their info is blocked by  the sender     1  From the Home screen  tap    2  Press  r   and then tap Settings   3  Locate and activa
30.   message is received       Vibrate  Activates a vibration when a new email message is  received      Sync Email  enables automatic email synching between your  device and the remote server      Sync schedule  allows you to control the email sync schedule  on both Peak and Off Peak times      Period to sync email to assign the sync range for your  incoming and outgoing email messages between your phone  and your external exchange server  How many days worth of  email messages should the phone and server synchronize   Choose from  Automatic  All  1 day  3 days  1 week    2 weeks  or 1 month      Size to retrieve emails configures the incoming email size  allowed to pass through to your phone automatically without  user interaction  Emails with attachments larger than  configured will have to be retrieved manually      Signature  Lets you attach a customized signature to the  bottom of all outgoing emails         n a single motion touch and slide to the right to turn it on       Tap the Signature field  change the current text  and tap Done  to save the new signature        Messages 153    154      Default account  Assign this account as the default email  account used for outgoing messages       Out of office settings allows you to both activate deactivate  your email s out of office settings  and configure both the start   end dates and your outgoing message    Tap the More settings field to access additional options      Account name displays the name used by the device to t
31.   on page  248     S Voice    Launches your phone s built in voice recognition  System that allows you to initiate several common  tasks without having to touch the phone  Features  include  Call  Text  Navigate  Play music  Memo  and  Driving mode     For more information  referto  Using S Voice  on page  93       3    Samsung Apps    Allows you to easily download an abundance of  applications to your device  This includes games   news  reference  social networking  navigation  and  more    For more information  refer to    Samsung Apps  on  page 250     Samsung Hub    This is Samsung s integrated store for media content  that offers a comprehensive and consistent media  service experience  You can browse and purchase all  media content within a single store front     For more information  refer to    Samsung Hub  on  page 250   Samsung Link    Allows you to share your on device media content  with other external devices using DLNA  Digital  Living Network Alliance  technology     For more information  refer to    Samsung Link    on  page 251      amp   ej        ID    Settings      Accesses the device s built in Settings menu     For more information  refer to    Changing Your  Settings    on page 280   Story Album    Allows you to create a digital Album of your story in  media  Special moments will be on a timeline  and if  you wish  you can have your album published as a hard  copy   For more information  refer to  Story Album  on page  253     T Mobile My Account    This
32.   page    Any media item  Media Content  may be rented or purchased after    VIDEO  displays featured film and TV content available for you create an account in Samsung Hub   purchase rent from the video store  Tue page also BMG you   Media Content that is purchased and downloaded may be viewed  to search for new content  or navigate direc Jy to the Movie  amp  concurrently on up to five  5  devices with Samsung Hub  or    the  TV store page by clicking the  Video  link a the top of the page  service     that are also registered to the same account     BOOKS  displays featured Book content available for purchase   You may remove a device from your account no more than once  from the Book store  This page also allows you to search for every 90 days     nev content  i BIS directly to the Book store page by   You may remove Media Content from a device as many times as  PEDI T Books Teenie oe you d like  You will have the ability to re download the Media     GAMES  displays featured Game content valable from the Content later subject to content re download availability and  Game store  This page also allows you to search for new content provider permissions   content  or navigate directly to the Game store page by clicking  the  Games  link a the top of the page             You may need network coverage to access Media Content you  have acquired through the Service     E  To purchase orview  teatured content n bes detail  e You can use 3G  4G  or Wi Fi connectivity to download Me
33.   view your device s MAC address  required    when connecting to some secured networks  not configurable      e IP address  view your device s IP address     284    Manually Adding a Wi Fi Network    1     From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi  gt  Add Wi Fi  network    Enter the Network SSID  the name of your Wireless  Access Point     Tap the Security field and select a security option  This  must match the current security setting on your target  WAP  Wireless Access Point     Enter your WAP   s password if the WAP is secure    Tap Connect to store the new information and connect  to the target WAP     Note  An SSID is a unique key which identifies a wireless LAN     Its purpose is to stop other wireless equipment from  accessing your LAN     whether accidentally or  intentionally  To communicate  wireless devices must be  configured with the same SSID     WPS Push Button    The WPS  Wi Fi Protected Setup  feature  sometimes  associated with a physical or on screen button on most  WAPs  allows you to pair your device and WAP without the  need for entering a passcode  This process is similar to Wi Fi  Direct pairing    In this case  once the WPS feature is active on your WAP     your device can then detect it and then immediately pair to it     Note  WPS capable routers appear in the Wi Fi list of available    devices with the term  WPS available  below their name     To pair your device using WPS    1  Follow the WPS activati
34.  1      38    2  Tap a notification entry to open the associated  application  2         Clearing Notifications  1  Inasingle motion  touch and drag the Status bar down  to the bottom of the screen to open the Notifications  panel   2  Tap Clear  The notifications are cleared from the panel     Accessing Additional Screen Functions    In addition to notifications  this screen also provides quick  and ready access to device functions  These can be quickly  activated or deactivated     Scrolling across a horizontal list of functions has been  enhanced with an accessible Grid view     Note  You can select the function buttons you see at the top of    the Notifications panel   Only 5 buttons are shown at any one time   The Grid view is the only way to view all functions     To activate the Grid view     m From the Notification panel  tap EH  Open Grid view   to display additional functions     To minimize the Grid view   m From the Notification panel  tap E  Close Grid view   to show only your primary functions   To customize the functions displayed   1  From the Notification screen  tap E  Open Grid  view  to display additional functions   2  Tap ra  Edit  then locate the Notifications panel area  located at the bottom of the Notifications panel screen   3  Inasingle motion  touch and hold a desired function  then drag it to the top row        Understanding Your Device 39    Function Keys    Your device comes equipped with three main function keys  that can be used on any screen
35.  107  Voicemail 319  Volume Settings  Adjusting 307  VPN  Adding 294  Settings 294  VPN Client 257  W  Wait 81  114  Adding to a Contact 114  Wait dialing 81  Wallpaper  Assign Home 42  Home and Lock Screens 70  Wallpapers  Assigning from Gallery 169  Changing Home Screen 69  Changing Lock Screen 70  Changing via Settings Menu 70  Managing 69    410    Warranty Information 379  WatchON 189  Adding a New Room 192  Changing Channels 190  Configure Just For You 192  Initial Configuration 189  Locating Programs 191  Personalize 192  Settings 191  Using 190  Web 259  History 264  Web applications  enable downloading 271  Widget  Adding Widgets 42  Widgets  Adding and Removing 68  Google Talk 52  Moving to a Different Screen 69  Settings 252  Stopwatch 222  Wi Fi  About 273    Activating 84  273  281  Advanced settings 275  Calling 84  Connecting to 273  Deactivating 275  Direct Connection 286  During Sleep 283  MAC Address 284  Manually Adding Network 284  Manually scan for network 275  Off 275  On 174  273  275  281  Settings 281  Show Usage 289  Status icons 274   Wi Fi Calling 9  Activating 85  295  Connection Preferences 85  296  Icons 86  Launching 86  On 295  Settings 85  296   Wi Fi Direct 286  Activate and Connect 286    Device Name 18   On 174  286  World Clock   DST Settings 222  WPA2 PSK 277  278  WPS PIN   Pairing 285  WPS Push Button   Connect 285   Pairing 285   Y   YouTube   High Quality 258   High Qulaity 215   Settings 257    411    
36.  2  Tap Mobile HotSpot  gt  Allowed devices    3  Tap  Add new device  to add devices to the  allowed for connection list    4  Enter the Device name and Mac address    5  Tap OK to save the new device     Connections    279    Section 11  Changing Your Settings    This section explains the device settings for your device  It  includes such settings as  display  security  memory  and any  extra settings associated with your device     Accessing the Settings Tabs  m From the Home screen  tap Ea  Apps   gt        Settings     0r   o  Press  gt    and then tap Settings   The four available tabs are then displayed  The  previous Settings list is now broken down into four  available tabs described below    Settings Tabs   Overview    The Settings are divided into 4 main groups  When the  Settings screen displays  the following 4 tabs are located at  the top of the screen     280    Pate Connections   This tab allows you to see all of settings related  to the connection of your device to external  sources  Features include  Wi Fi  Bluetooth  Data  usage  More networks  Airplane mode  Mobile  networks  Tethering and Mobile HotSpot  VPN  and  Wi Fi Calling   NFC  S Beam  Nearby devices   Screen Mirroring  and Kies via Wi Fi    MEME My device    This tab provides access to device configuration  and customization features  Features include   Lock screen  Display  LED indicator  Sound  Home  screen mode  Call  Blocking mode  Power saving  mode  Accessory  Accessibility  Language and  in
37.  2  While in a selection or screen  tap qp  near the  top left of the Application bar  and then scroll left or  right to access the various tabs    3  Available tabs include  PLAYLISTS  RECENT  ARTISTS   ALBUMS  SONGS  or GENRES     Note  The contents of your library display in a scrolling grid or    list view  depending on the view     Searching for Music in Your Library   1  From the Home screen  tap FA  Apps   gt   G  Play Music     2  Tap  Search  to search through your available  songs    3  Type the name of an artist  album  song  or playlist   Matching songs are displayed in a list below the search  box    4  Tapa matching song to play it  tap a matching album   artist or playlist to view a list of its  songs     Changing Music Settings  1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    Play Music    2  Press l   and then make a selection    e Shuffle all  Play all songs in a random order    e Choose on device music  In addition to playing the music that  you add to your online library  you can play music stored on  your device   s internal storage  Then you can listen to music  when you have no Internet connection  To do this  make some  of your online music available offline  For more information   refer to    Making Online Music Available Offline    on  page 199       Settings  Provides access to the Play Music settings    e Help  Displays application help information    Listening to Music  You can listen to music by using your device   s built in  speakers  through a w
38.  241    Play Music  Also known as Google Music  allows you to browse  shop   and playback songs purchased from the Play Store  The  music you choose is automatically stored in your Google  Music library and instantly ready to play or download   m From the Home screen  tap dH  Apps   gt   Ge  Play Music    For more information  refer to    Play Music    on page 193   Play Store  Formerly known as the    Android Market     this application  provides access to downloadable applications and games to  install on your phone  The Play Store also allows you to  provide feedback and comments about an application  or flag  an application that might be incompatible with your phone     Before using the Play Store  you must have a Google  Account     242    Accessing the Play Store   1  From the Home screen  tap    el  Play Store    2  If not already logged in with your Google account  tap  Next    3  Tap Existing and enter your Google account   information    4  Tap Accept to agree to the Play Store terms of service   Downloading a New Google  Application   To download a new application  you will need to use your  Google account to sign in to the Play Store  The home page  provides several ways to find applications  The home page  features applications and includes a list of item applications  by category  a list of games  a link to search  and a link to My    apps   1  From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt    el  Play Store    2  Browse through the categories  find an application  you 
39.  72  Multi Window  Activate Deactivate 57  304  Close App 62  Customizing 60  Increase App Window Size 62  Maximize App 62  Panel Relocation 59  Rearrange Apps 60    Removing Apps 60  Restoring Apps 60  Running Multiple Apps 61  Switch Arrangement 62  Tab Repositioning 59  Using 57  Multi Party Call 90  Dropping One Participant 92  Private conversation 91  Multi party call  Setting up 90  Multi party calls 90  Multi Tasking  Background Calling 76  Watching Videos 183  Music 200  235  Adding Music 203  Creating a Playlist 203  Editing a Playlist 204  Making a Song a Ringtone 201  Options 201  Playing Music 200  Removing Music 204  Using Playlists 203    Volume 307   Music App  Adding Songs to Playlists 198  Changing Library View 194  Changing Settings 195  Creating a Playlist 198  Deleting a Playlist 198  Listening 195  Music Application 193  Now Playing Screen 196  Options While Playing 197  Playing 196  Playing a Playlist 198  Searching for Music 195  Tab Options 196   Music File Extensions  3GP 200  AAC 200  AAC  200  eAAC  200  M4A 200  MP3 200  MP4 200  WMA 200    Music Files   Removing 204   Transferring 204  My Places 232  238  345   N   Namecard   Sending 120   Sending All 120   Share Via 120  Navigating   Application Menus 63   Sub Menus 63   Through Screens 53  Navigation   Enable Location 238   Go Home 239   Options 238  Negative Colors 323  Network connection   Adding a new 274  Network Mode   2G Network 292   GSM WCDMA 292   LTE 292    403    New applications   Do
40.  98    or  6  Review your message and tap   BA    Send    Tap 2 to select from one of the following  7  If you have more than one recipient  the same text  message is sent to all recipients in the Enter Recipients      Groups  to select a recipient from the Group list       Favorites  to select a recipient from the Favorites list  field    e Contacts  to select a recipient from your Contacts list  valid Note  If you exit a message before you send it  it will be  entries must have a wireless phone number or email address   automatically saved as a draft      Logs  to select a recipient from a list of recently sent  messages     3  If adding a recipient from either Logs  Contacts  or  Group  tap the contact to place a check mark then tap  Done  The contact displays in the recipient field     Note  Delete any unnecessary members by tapping their  name number in the recipient area and selecting Delete     Messages 131    Quick Messaging a Number from the Contacts    List  d   2   3     From the Home screen  tap ks  Contacts     Locate an entry from the Contacts list    In a single motion  touch and drag your finger over the  number by going to the left  This action addresses a  new text message to the selected recipient     Message Options  Options before composing a message    1   2     132    From the Home screen  tap    Messaging     Before composing a message  from the main Message   screen press B from the main Messaging screen to   display additional messaging options      
41.  All users must be connected to the  same Wi Fi  For more information  referto  Group Play  on  page 228      Add to playlist  allows you to add the current music file to a  Selected playlist       Set as  allows you to set the current song as a Phone ringtone   Caller ringtone  or Alarm tone  Additionally you can either  choose to start the selected song from the beginning or allow  the application to automatically recommend a start point              e Show Hide Music view  displays an on screen wavefo   timeline of the current song     3    m    Multimedia 201      Scan for nearby devices  allows you to look for DLNA    compliant devices used to control streaming media    e Settings  allows you to change your music player settings      Details  allows you to view media info such as Artist  Title   Album  Track length  Genre  Track number  Format  Size  and  Location      End  closes the application    Music Settings   The settings menu allows you to set preferences for the  music player such as whether you want the music to play in  the background  sound effects  and how the music menu  displays    1  From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt        Music     2  Press     gt  Settings    3  Select one of the following settings    e SoundAlive  set a type of equalization such as Normal  Pop   Rock  Jazz  Dance  Classic  etc      Adapt Sound  enable or disable the adaptive sound feature to  adjust to the sound levels of your current environment     202      Play speed  set the
42.  EULA is held to be void  invalid  unenforceable or illegal  the  other provisions shall continue in full force and effect    101212     Warranty Information    391    Index    Numerics  2G Network  Using Only 292  2 Sec Pause  Adding 78  A  ABC 100  Accessing  Recently used applications 64  Voice mail 23  Accessory 322  Audio Output 322  Dock Sound 322  Accounts and Sync  Adding Contacts 124  Add 2 Sec Pause 81  114  Add to Favorites 129  Adjusting  Call volume 87    392    Adobe PDF 245  Air Call Accept 79  Air Gesture  Activate 55  332  Air Browse 332  Air Call Accept 332  Air Jump 332  Air Move 332  Answering a Call 79  On 55  332  Quick Glance 56  332  Airplane Mode  On 290  Alarm  Deleting an Existing Alarm 222  Setting 220  Turning Off 222  Alerts  Presidential 141    Alerts on Call 311  Allow Diagnostics 18  344  AllShare Cast Hub 36  1st Time Pairing 211  Activation on Device 211  Connecting 210  Disconnecting Your Device 212  Dongle 211  Pairing 211  Pairing Your Devices 211  Re pairing a Device 212  Set Up Hardware 210  Streaming Videos 213  AllShare Play  see Samsung Link 206  251  AllShareCast Hub 251  AMBER Alerts 141  Disable 142  Android Beam 296  Answering  Home Key 311  313    Answering a Call 78  79  Application cache and data  Clearing 244  Application Menus  Navigating through 63  Applications 43  Calculator 44  216  Calendar 44  Camera 44  219  ChatON 45  Chrome 45  Clock 45  Contacts 45  Downloads 45  Dropbox 45  Email 46  226  Flipboard 46  Gallery 46 
43.  Gallery     Verify the Gallery contains all of your pictures and  videos    Remove both the back cover and remove the internal  microSD card prior to initiating the process     Backing Up Media to your SD card    You can back up your pictures  videos  documents  and other  media to your SD card     1     From the Home screen  tap dE  Apps   gt     E  My Files      Select the folder where the files are that you would like  to copy to the SD card  This would include folders such  as DCIM  camera pictures and videos   Pictures  Music   Playlists  Download  etc  For example  tap ES  Apps    gt  ES  My Files  Images Camera       Tap the files that you want to copy to create a    checkmark in the box next to the filename       Tap the options icon in the top right corner of the    display    Select Copy  gt  SD memory card    Go to the folder on your SD card where you would like  to copy to files to  For example  Pictures       Tap Paste here in the top right corner of the display     The files are copied to the folder     Changing Your Settings 341    Backing Up Internet Bookmarks to your  Samsung Account  You can back up your Internet bookmarks by using your  Samsung account  Only bookmarks you have added  non   default  can be backed up  m  1  From the Home screen  press m and then tap    9  When you get a new phone  update your software  or  reset your device  sign in to your Samsung account and  the backed up bookmarks will be displayed on your  Bookmarks page under the Samsu
44.  Google 46  Google Mail 46  227  Google Maps 47  232  Google  46  Group Play 47  Help 47    Hide 43   Internet 47  230  Local 47   Lookout Security 47  Messaging 48  messaging 235  Messenger 48  Mobile Hotspot 48  Music 48   My files 48  Navigation 48  Optical Reader 49  Phone 49   Play Books 49  Play Magazines 49  Play Movies  amp  TV 49  Play Musc 49   Play Store 50  Polaris Office 5 50  S Memo 50   S Translator 50   S Voice 50  Samsung Apps 51  Samsung Hub 51    Samsung Link 51  Settings 51   Sharing with Others 66  Show Hidden 43  Shutting Down 25  Storage Used 350   Story Album 51  T Mobile My Account 51  T Mobile Name ID 51  T Mobile TV 52  TripAdvisor 52   Using the Camcorder 170  Using the Camera 163  Video 52  255   Visual Voicemail 52  Voice Recorder 52  255  Voice Search 52   VPN Client 53   WatchON 53   YouTube 53  257    Applications and Development 216  Apps    Adding 42  Reset Preferences 350    393    Apps Screen  Customizing 43  Area Code  Auto Assign 315  Audio  Output Mode 322  Auto Redial 315  Auto Reject  Configuration 80  Auto Reject List 311  Auto Reject Mode 311  Automatic Answering 311  Automatic Restore 339  B  Back up  My Account 339  My Data 339  Backup and Restore 339  Battery  Charging 13  Display Percentage 15  305  Extending Life 15  Installing 12  Low Battery Indicator 15    394    Removal 12  Wall Charger 13  Battery Cover  Removal 8  Replace 9  Battery Life  Extending 15  Battery Usage 351  Battery Use  amp  Safety 364  Bigger Font  Setting 
45.  Group    1     go RN    6     From the Home Screen  tap  gt  ES    Press ml and then tap Delete groups   Select either Select all or tap the desired group   Tap Delete     Select either the Group only or Group and group  members   Tap OK     Sending a Message to a Group    1   2     From the Home screen  tap B  gt     Groups ff  Tap an existing group  and press   and then tap  Send message  ES  Touch and hold a group entry and select Send message     Select the recipients of the new message  indicated by  a green check mark   If an entry contains multiple  phone numbers  each must be selected individually   Tap Done    Type your message  and tap    Em  Send        The Favorites Tab  The Favorites tab is a list of the phone numbers that have  been designated as favorite contacts  For more information   refer to  Logs Tab  on page 94   1  From the Home screen  tap E   2  Tap  Favorites tab    Adding a contact to your favorites list  i  1  From within the Favorites tab  press   and select  Add to favorites  m  2  Place a check mark alongside those current Contacts  entries you wish to assign as favorites   3  Tap Done to complete the process     Contacts    129    Section 7  Messages    This section describes how to send or receive different types  of messages  It also explains the features and functionality  associated with messaging     Types of Messages  Your phone provides the following message types     Text Messages    Multimedia  Picture  Video  and Audio  Messages    Em
46.  Info  Browse  or Live Channels   YouTube  YouTube is a video sharing website on which users can  upload and share videos  and view them in MPEG 4 format   1  From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt    YouTube    2  When the screen loads you can begin searching and  viewing posted videos   3  Press    Settings  gt  General  gt  High quality on  mobile if you prefer high quality output     Multimedia    215    Section 9  Applications and Development    This section contains a description of each application that is  available in the Applications Menu  its function  and how to  navigate through that particular application  If the application  is already described in another section of this user manual   then a cross reference to that particular section is provided     Note  This manual only addresses applications that have been    loaded on your  device computer tablet  as of the date  of purchase  Information concerning third party  applications that you may choose to download from the  Google Play Store or otherwise should be obtained from  the application provider directly     Tip  To open applications quickly  add the icons of frequently     used applications to one of the Home screens  For more  information  refer to  Customizing the Screens  on page  65    You can also add an application icon as a Primary  Shortcut that will display on all Home screens  If you add  an application as a primary shortcut  the application icon  will not be displayed in the Applications menu  
47.  Mode 310  EDGE Network 292  Edit Page 65  Editing a Picture 179  Email 144  Changing Signature 148  153  Composing 147  Configuring Settings 148  Creating an Internet Account 145  Internet Email 145  Opening 146  Refreshing Messages 147  Sending 125  Wi Fi Download of Attachments  149  154  Emergency  Alert Preview 141  Alerts 141  Emergency Alert  Configuration 141  Emergency Alerts 141  AMBER 141  Imminent Extreme 141    398    Message Settings 141  Severe 141  Emergency Calls 369  Making 77  With SIM 77  Without SIM 77  Emoticons 133  Ending  A call 76  Entering Text 98  Using SWYPE 99  Erasing Files  Memory Card 73  Exchange Email 150  Account Setup 150  Composing 152  Configuring Settings 153  Deleting Message 153  Opening 152  Refreshing Messages 152  Exposure to Radio Frequency  RF     Signals 355  Extra Volume 87  Extreme Alert   Disable 142   F   Face Unlock 300  301  Facebook   Personalize 327   Predictive Text 327   Swpe Connect 329  Facial Recognition 300  Factory Data Reset 343   Prior To 339  Factory data reset 74  Favorites Tab 129  FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility  HAC   Regulations for Wireless Devices 375  FCC Notice and Cautions 377  Fixed Dialing Numbers 317  Flipboard 227  Folder   Create 42  Font   Size 305    Style 305  Font Size  Caption 257  Changing 323  Forgot Pattern  303  G  Gallery  Folder Options 177  Opening 181  Picture In Picture 183  Games  Volume 307  Gesture  Settings 331  Gestures  Overview 55  Getting Started 7  Battery 12  Battery Cover 8
48.  Motions and  gestures      Air gesture  Allows you to control your device by performing  motions above the sensor  without touching the device      Motion  Allows you to control your device using natural    movements  on the screen        Palm motion  Allows you to control your device by touching the  screen with your entire hand     Gyroscope calibration  Allows you to properly calibrate your    device s touch screen   To activate Air gesture   1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap    Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures    2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Air gesture slider  to the right to turn it on   If the feature is available for your selected action  an  Air gesture icon    gt  will appear in the status bar    3  Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At least one feature must be activated before Air gesture    can be activated     4  Tap Learn about sensor and icon field to review  on screen information about the Air gestures sensor  and related icon    5  Ina single motion  slide a feature   s activation slider to    the on position   RSM      Understanding Your Device 55    For more information  refer to  Motions and Gestures  Settings  on page 331   To activate Motion   1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures   2  Ina single motion touch and slide the Motion slider to  the right to turn it on   3  Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At
49.  Network mode  You can configure your device to either automatically select  the LTE option  LTE GSM WCDMA  auto connect   by default     GSM WCDMA  auto connect   GSM only  or WCDMA only    m From the Home screen  press  ra and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks Network mode      LTE GSM WCDMA  auto connect  is the default network  mode option  This selection allows the device to choose the  fastest connection from among the available connection  speeds  including LTE      GSM WCDMA  auto connect  allows you to exclude the LTE  network and choose from only 4G  3G  and 2G networks     Changing Your Settings 291      GSM only restricts your connection to only the 2G network       WCDMA only restricts your connection to only the 3G network     Using the LTE Network Option  To confirm you are always using the fastest possible  connection  the device has an automatic detection method  where it finds both the fastest and most stable connection   communication method from among this selected set   LTE 4G 3G 2G     1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks  gt  Network mode    2  Tap LTE GSM WCDMA  auto connect   A selection  indicator displays next to this option to show that it is  active  This is the default mode for this device    Using the GSM WCDMA Option  If you wish to not use LTE but still require a fast connection  using the standard 3G 2G network speed
50.  Obtain this  information from your company network administrator     Important  Do not accept the default entry as this is a guess  based on returned information     e If your network requires SSL encryption  tap the Use secure  connection  SSL  field to place a check mark in the box and  activate this additional level  Most often  this option should be  enabled     Important  If your Exchange server requires this feature   leaving this field unchecked can prevent  connection     9  Consult your IT Administrator if it is necessary to  enable the Use client certification option    10  With the new server information entered  tap Next    11  Read the on screen Activation disclaimer and  when  prompted  tap OK  The device then verifies your  incoming server settings    12  If prompted  read the Remote security administration  information and tap OK to accept the service and  continue    13  Adjust the various on screen configuration fields and  tap Next  It may take a few seconds for the next screen  to load      Enabling the Automatically download attachments when  connected to Wi Fi option decreases the wait time to access  large email attachments     Messages 151    14  If prompted  read the Activate device administrator   screen and tap Activate to complete the email setup  process     Note  This process can take a few minutes  If the previous    setup screen re appears  ignore it and do not alter any  fields during this process     15  Identify your new work email account 
51.  SYSTEM SOFTWARE MAY CAUSE YOUR DEVICE AND APPLICATIONS TO WORK IMPROPERLY  YOUR  CARRIER MAY NOT PERMIT USERS TO DOWNLOAD CERTAIN SOFTWARE  SUCH AS CUSTOM OS     SAFE     Samsung Approved For Enterprise     SAFE      SAFETV   Samsung for Enterprise  is a mark for a Samsung device which has been tested against Samsung s own  internal criteria for interoperability with certain third party security related solutions for MDM and VPN  The testing includes field  testing with local network connection and menu tree testing which tests functionality of the solutions in conjunction with the  Samsung device  During the testing  the device is tested with the security solutions to see if the solutions work with the device as  described by the third party security solution providers  The testing  for example  includes field testing with local network  connection and menu tree testing which tests functionality of the solutions in conjunction with the Samsung device  For more  information about Samsung s SAFE    program  please refer to www samsung com us safe     Disclaimer of Warranties  EXCEPT AS OTHERWISE PROVIDED IN THEIR STANDARD END USER LICENSE AND WARRANTY  TO THE  FULL EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO   LTD   SAMSUNG TELECOMMUNICATIONS AMERICA  LLC  AND  THEIR AFFILIATES  COLLECTIVELY REFERRED TO HEREIN AS THE  SAMSUNG ENTITIES   EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ANY AND ALL  WARRANTIES  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOS
52.  Settings     gt  Connections tab  gt  Bluetooth     Battery Cover    The battery  micro SIM card and SD card are installed under  the battery cover     Important  Before removing or replacing the battery cover     make sure the device is switched off  To turn the  device off  hold down the           key until the  power off image displays  then tap Power off     Caution  Do not bend or twist the back cover excessively  during installation or removal  Doing so may damage  the cover     To remove the battery cover   1  Hold the device firmly and locate the cover release  latch  1    2  Place your fingernail in the opening  2  and firmly   pop  the cover off the device  similar to a soda can         Release Latch       To replace the battery cover   m Position the battery cover over the battery    compartment and press down until you hear a click     SIM Card Overview    Important  Before removing or replacing the micro SIM card     make sure the device is switched off  To turn the  phone off  hold down the        gt  key until the  power off image displays  then tap Power off     The micro SIM card is loaded with your subscription details  such as your telephone number  PIN  available optional  services  and many other features     Important  The micro SIM card and its information can be  easily damaged by scratching or bending  so be  careful when handling  inserting  or removing the  card  Keep all SIM cards out of reach of small  children     Some features on your device  s
53.  Telecommunications America  LLC  All  rights reserved     No reproduction in whole or in part allowed without prior  written approval  Specifications and availability subject to  change without notice   111611     End User License Agreement for  Software    IMPORTANT  READ CAREFULLY  This End User License  Agreement   EULA   is a legal agreement between you   either an individual or a single entity  and Samsung  Electronics Co   Ltd    Samsung Electronics Co    for  software  owned by Samsung Electronics Co  and its  affiliated companies and its third party suppliers and  licensors  that accompanies this EULA  which includes  computer software and may include associated media   printed materials   online  or electronic documentation    384      Software    Samsung Electronics Co  is a separate company  from the company that provides the limited warranty for this  mobile device  Samsung Telecommunications America  LLC     This device requires the use of preloaded software in its  normal operation  BY USING THE DEVICE OR ITS PRELOADED  SOFTWARE  YOU ACCEPT THE TERMS OF THIS EULA  IF YOU  DO NOT ACCEPT THESE TERMS  DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR  THE SOFTWARE  INSTEAD  RETURN THE DEVICE TO THE  RETAILER FOR A REFUND OR CREDIT     1  GRANT OF LICENSE  Samsung Electronics Co  grants you  the following rights provided that you comply with all terms  and conditions of this EULA  You may install  use  access   display and run one copy of the Software on the local hard  disk s  or other pe
54.  Text Input Method  The Text Input Method can be assigned from within one of  two locations   Settings Menu    m From the Home screen  press     and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Language and  input  gt  Default and select an input method    Text Input field    1  From a screen where you can enter text  in a single  motion  touch and drag the Status bar down to the  bottom of the screen to open the Notifications screen    2  Tap E  Select input method  and select an available  input method     Entering Text Using Swype    Swype    is the default text input method that allows you to  enter a word by sliding your finger or stylus from letter to  letter  lifting your finger between words  Swype uses error  correcting algorithms and a language model to predict the  next word  Swype also includes a touch predictive text  System    The on screen keyboard options are different between the  Android keyboard and Swype on screen input methods     Note  During its initial use  you may be prompted by a series of    Swype Connect set up screens  Follow the initial  on screen set up instructions     Enabling and Configuring Swype  If you configure another text input method  Samsung  keyboard  you must re enable Swype before using the  Swype keyboard   For more detailed information on configuring Swype settings   see  Swype Settings  on page 328     When Swype is enabled there can also be normal keyboard  functionality  i  1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  S
55.  This image is spread across all available screens      Lock screen assigns the selected image to the background for  the lock screen      Home and lock screens assigns the current image to both the  Home screen and Lock screens    Touch and drag the crop box anywhere on the picture    Touch and drag the sides of the crop box to zoom in or   out to create a cropped area    Tap Done to assign the wallpaper image    zip   Tap Cancel to stop without updating the wallpaper   image     Editing a Photo    You can edit your photos using the built in Photo editor  application on your device  The photo editor application  provides basic editing functions for pictures that you take on  your phone  Along with basic image tuning like brightness   contrast  and color it also provides a wide variety of effects  used for editing the picture     1     From the Home screen  tap Eg  Apps   gt  x   Gallery      Select a folder location and tap a file to open it    With the image displayed  press   I and then tap   Edit      Edit  allows you to edit the current image  Launches the Photo  Editor application     Note  To select the picture area  touch and hold the current    picture     Multimedia 179    4  Select an image area by touching and holding the  image and then selecting an available option      Selection mode  provides several on screen selection options  such as  Select area  Inverse selection  Selection size  and  Selection mode  Select area  Inverse selection  Selection size   and Se
56.  To disable data collection  go to Settings Back  up and reset Collect diagnostics and turn off the  Allow diagnostics to be collected feature     Location Services    The Location services allows you to configure the device s  location services     Important  The more location determining functions are  enabled  the more accurate the determination will  be of your position     1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  Location services   2  Tap any of the following options to create a checkmark  and activate the service     Access to my location  allows apps that have asked your  permission to use your location information  Tap the ON OFF  Slider to turn it on     344      Use GPS satellites  allows applications to use GPS to pinpoint  your location     Use wireless networks  allows applications to use data from  mobile networks and Wi Fi to help determine your location     My places  allows you to add location information for your  Home  Office  and Car   Enabling the GPS Satellites      1  From the Home screen  press T    and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Location services   2  Tap Use GPS satellites to enable the GPS satellite     Using Wireless Networks  Before you use applications such as Google Maps and find  your location or search for places of interest  you must  enable the Use wireless networks option   1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Location services   2  Tap Use wireless 
57.  U S  Food and Drug Administration  FDA  has published  information for consumers relating to Radio Frequency  RF   exposure from wireless phones  The FDA publication  includes the following information     Do cell phones pose a health hazard     Many people are concerned that cell phone radiation will  cause cancer or other serious health hazards  The weight of  scientific evidence has not linked cell phones with any health  problems    Cell phones emit low levels of Radio Frequency  RF  energy   Over the past 15 years  scientists have conducted hundreds  of studies looking at the biological effects of the radio  frequency energy emitted by cell phones  While some  researchers have reported biological changes associated  with RF energy  these studies have failed to be replicated   The majority of studies published have failed to show an  association between exposure to radio frequency from a cell  phone and health problems    The low levels of RF cell phones emit while in use are in the  microwave frequency range  They also emit RF at  substantially reduced time intervals when in the stand by  mode  Whereas high levels of RF can produce health effects   by heating tissue   exposure to low level RF that does not  produce heating effects causes no known adverse health  effects     Health and Safety Information 355    The biological effects of radio frequency energy should not  be confused with the effects from other types of  electromagnetic energy     Very high levels of elec
58.  USB drivers     microSD Icon Indicators    The following icons show your microSD card connection  status at a glance     the card can now safely be removed         the card is being prepared for use and for  i mounting     A the card has been improperly removed     Memory Card     71    Important  DO NOT remove a microSD card while the device is    accessing or transferring files  Doing so will result  in loss or damage of data  Make sure your battery  is fully charged before using the microSD card   Your data may become damaged or lost if the  battery runs out while you are using the microSD  card     Mounting the SD Card    To store photos  music  videos  and other applications  You  must mount  install  the SD card prior to use  Mounting the  SD card establishes a USB connection with your computer   1  From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  Storage   2  Tap Mount SD card     72    Communicating with the SD card  1  Insert the SD card into the external  SD card slot  For  more information  refer to    Installing the microSD  Memory Card  on page 11    2  Verify the card is properly mounted     Note  Your device is configured to be used as a storage media    device by default  If it does not respond properly  you will  need to verify the Debugging mode is not enabled     3  Connect the USB cable to the phone and connect the  cable to the computer    4  Confirm the new mounted drive appears as a new drive  on your computer  As soon as t
59.  able to playback DivX videos   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    Video   A list of available videos displays in the  Video list   2  Tap a video file to begin viewing   Sharing Videos  1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   o  Video   After a few seconds  each  on screen video begins to cycle through a preview of  the first five seconds of the clip   Press      and then tap Share via   Select either individual videos or tap Select all   Click Done to complete the process or Cancel to quit   Select a sharing option  Choose from  Bluetooth   ChatON  Dropbox  Email  Gmail  Google   Messaging   Picassa  Wi Fi Direct  or YouTube     m Rr    Using Picture In Picture    This feature can be used during playback of supported video  types via either the Gallery  Play Videos  or Video player     Note  Some applications might not allow this video to remain    active in the foreground  ex  Camera Camcorder    Screen      This feature allows you to continue to view your video as a  background operation while you multi task and do other  things  such as surf the Internet  access your Contacts list   look for a picture  etc      1  From the Home screen  tap RES  Apps    2  Tap the desired video playback application   3  Tap the desired video to begin playback     Note  The Picture In Picture feature only works when using    the Video player application  Other video players  ex     YouTube   do not support this feature     4  As playback is initiated  locate and tap   Picture in 
60.  access to tabs containing a list of your current  downloaded files  Internet and Other    1  From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt    Downloads    Place a checkmark on an available file to select it     3  Choose an available action such as Share  Delete  Sort  by size date  or Clear list     224    Dropbox    Works to provide access to your desktop files directly from  your device  This applications allows you to bring your files  with you when you re on the go  edit files in your Dropbox  from your device  upload photos and videos to Dropbox  and  share your selected files freely with family and friends    The in device application works in conjunction with a partner  program placed on a target computer using an active Internet  connection    Dropbox creates a folder that automatically synchronizes its  contents across all of your connected devices on your  account  Update a file to your Dropbox on your computer  and  its automatically updated to the same folder on your other  devices     Download the Desktop application  1  Use your computer s browser to navigate to   http   www dropbox com    2  Follow the on screen setup and installation instructions  on your target computer containing the desired files     Important  The computer application must be installed on the    Note  It might be necessary to configure your router s firewall  settings to allow this application to gain access to the  Internet     computer containing the desired files  This    computer must have 
61.  across the icons  and  select E3  Settings  to reveal the Samsung keyboard  settings screen     Set any of the following options      Portrait keyboard types allows you to choose a keyboard  configuration  Qwerty keyboard  default  or 3x4 keyboard       Input language sets the input language  Tap a language from  the available list  The keyboard is updated to the selected  language      Predictive text enables predictive text entry mode  This must  be enabled to gain access to the advanced settings  Touch and  hold to access the advanced settings     326      SwiftKey Flow like using Swipe  all    ows you to enter text by    sliding your fingers across the on screen keyboard  This  feature is optimized for use with the on screen QWERTY    keyboard       Cursor control when enabled  allows you to control your    on screen cursor by moving your finger across the keyboard     Handwriting allows you to configure the handwriting settings  Such as  Recognition type  Recognition time  Pen thickness        Pen color  and About       Advanced provides access to additional settings such as            Auto capitalization automatically capitalizes the first letter of  the first word in each sentence  standard English style          Auto spacing automatically inse             s space between words            Auto punctuate automatically inserts a full stop in a sentence    by tapping the space bar twice wh  QWERTY keyboard     len using the on screen        Character preview provides an 
62.  allow you to hear the music  at lower volumes than when using earbuds     Health and Safety Information 371       Limit the amount of time you listen  As the volume increases  less  time is required before you hearing could be affected      Avoid using headphones after exposure to extremely loud noises   Such as rock concerts  that might cause temporary hearing loss   Temporary hearing loss might cause unsafe volumes to sound  normal      Do not listen at any volume that causes you discomfort  If you  experience ringing in your ears  hear muffled speech  or  experience any temporary hearing difficulty after listening to your  portable audio device  discontinue use and consult your doctor     You can obtain additional information on this subject from the  following sources     American Academy of Audiology   11730 Plaza American Drive  Suite 300  Reston  VA 20190   Voice   800  222 2336   Email  info audiology org   Internet    http   www audiology org Pages   default aspx       372    National Institute on Deafness and Other  Communication Disorders   National Institutes of Health   31 Center Drive  MSC 2320   Bethesda  MD 20892 2320   Email  nidcdinfo nih gov   Internet    http   www nidcd nih gov     National Institute for Occupational Safety  and Health  NIOSH    395 E Street  S W   Suite 9200   Patriots Plaza Building   Washington  DC 20201   Voice  1 800 35 NIOSH   1 800 356 4674    1 800 CDC INFO  1 800 232 4636   Outside the U S  513 533 8328    Email  cdcinfo cdc gov
63.  allows you to create a new text message to the  selected entry       Time provides the time and date of the call and its duration    e Copy to dialing screen press      to pass the current  number to your dialer and then edit the selected number before  you place your next outbound call      Delete press    l to delete the Contacts entry      Send number press    to send the current Contacts entry  information to an external recipient      Add to reject list press    p add the current phone  number to an automatic rejection ist  Similar to a block list  the  selected caller will be blocked from making an incoming calls  to your phone      Touch and hold an entry to display the entry specific context  menu      Copy to dialing screen to make alterations to the current  phone number prior to redial      Add to Contacts to save the number if it is not already in your  Contacts      View contact to view the information for the currently stored  Contacts entry      Send number to send the current Contacts entry information to  an external recipient              Call Functions and Contacts List 95    e Add to reject list to add the current phone number to an  automatic rejection list  Similar to a block list  the selected caller  will be blocked from making an incoming calls to your phone      Delete to delete the entry from the Logs list     Altering Numbers from the Logs List  If you need to make a call from the Logs screen and you  need to alter the number prior to dialing  you
64.  allows you to use the Short Message Service   SMS  to send and receive short text messages to and from  other mobile phones   You can also use the Multi Media Service  MMS  to create  multimedia messages to send and receive from other mobile  phones   m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   we  Messaging    For more information  refer to    Messages    on page 130   Messenger  Messenger allows you to bring groups of friends together into  a simple group conversation  When you get a new  conversation in Messenger  Google  sends an update to your  device   m From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt    Messenger    For more information  refer to    Messenger    on page 160     Mobile HotSpot    Provides access to the Tethering and Mobile HotSpot menu  where you can use either the USB tethering or portable  HotSpot functionality   1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt        gt   Mobile HotSpot         2  Activate the desired connection method   For more information see either  USB Tethering on page 276  or  Mobile HotSpot on page 277   Music  This application allows you to play music files that you have  stored on your microSD card  You can also create playlists     m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt         Music      For more information  refer to    Music    on page 200     Applications and Development 235    My Files  This application allows you to manage your sounds  images   videos  bluetooth files  Android files  and other memory card  data in one convenien
65.  and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks   2  Tap Kies via Wi Fi  gt  OK   Select a network connection and follow the on screen  connection process     Lock Screen  This menu contains features that allows you to configure the  device s security parameters    Screen Unlock Pattern Overview    To secure data and limit phone access  set the phone to  require a screen unlock pattern each time you turn on the  device  or every time the phone wakes up from sleep mode   when the screen automatically turns off    m From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Lock screen  gt   Screen lock     The Screen lock menu allows to choose from a variety of  locking features such as     Swipe  Swipe the screen to unlock it       Face unlock  Look at your phone to unlock it      Face and voice  Look at your phone and speak to unlock      Pattern  A screen unlock pattern is a touch gesture you create  and use to unlock your device  Follow the prompts to create or  change your screen unlock pattern      PIN  Select a PIN to use for unlocking the screen      Password  Create a password for unlocking the screen       None  No pattern  PIN  or password is required  The screen will  never lock   Swipe options  1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen   2  Configure one of the following options      Multiple widgets allows you to display multiple widgets on  your lock screen  Appears as an o
66.  and view the    World clock  use a Stopwatch  set a Timer  or Desk  clock  The applications display in atabularformat and  quickly accessed with the touch of a finger     For more information  refer to    Clock    on page 220     ES    Contacts    The default storage location for saving phone  numbers to your Contacts List is your phone s built in  memory     For more information  referto  Contacts List  on page  108   Downloads    Provides quick access to tabs containing a list of  your current downloaded files  Internet and Other      For more information  refer to  Downloads  on page  224   Dropbox    Provides access to your desktop files directly from  your device     For more information  refer to    Dropbox    on page  224     Understanding Your Device 45     e Email    Provides access to both your Outlook  Exchange  Server based  work email and Internet email  accounts  such as Gmail and Yahoo  Mail     For more information  refer to  Using Email  on page  144        Flipboard   F  This application creates a personalized digital  magazine out of everything being shared with you   Access news stories  personal feeds and other  related material     For more information  refer to    Flipboard    on page  227     Gallery  x Displays a Gallery of camera images and video  stored in the microSD card     For more information  refer to    The Gallery    on page  181     46    ON    i    Gmail    Provides access to your Gmail account  Google Mail   Gmail  is a web based email s
67.  application provides you online access to  account information such as your current activity   billing information  service plans  downloads  and  other information    For more information  referto    T Mobile MyAccount     on page 253     T Mobile Name ID  Allows you to modify the on screen Caller ID  information     Understanding Your Device     51    52    T Mobile TV    Allows you to watch live mobile TV on your device   This application is a subscription service     For more information  referto  T Mobile TV  on page  254   Talk    Launches a Web based Google Talk application that  lets you chat and video conference with family and  friends over the Internet for free     For more information  refer to    Google Talk  on page  157   TripAdvisor    Allows you to watch live mobile TV on your device   This application is a subscription service     For more information  refer to    TripAdvisor    on page  254    Video   Launches your device s built in video application  that plays video files stored on your microSD card   For more information  refer to    Using Video  on page  182     era       Visual Voicemail   Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of people  who left a voicemail message  and listen to the any  message they want without being limited to  chronological order    For more information  refer to  Visual Voicemail  on  page 23    Voice Recorder   Allows you to record an audio file up to one minute  long and then immediately send it as a message   For mor
68.  available on    screen options    e Data roaming allows you to connect to your service provider s  partner networks and access data services when you are out of  your service providers area of coverage  For more information   refer to    Data Roaming    on page 291      Restrict background data prevents background data usage   This can help prevent over usage of your data minutes      Auto sync data allows the device to automatically sync  information and updates with your various services      Show Wi Fi usage activates an additional Wi Fi tab that shows  you your Wi Fi data usage     Changing Your Settings 289      Mobile hotspots allows you to select available Wi Fi networks  that can service as mobile hotspots  Place a check mark on  those entries you wish to use    More Networks  This tab displays additional wireless and network  information    m From the Home screen  press     and then tap  Settings  gt   Connections tab   gt  More  networks    Airplane Mode    This mode allows you to use many of your device   s features   such as Camera  Games  and more  when you are in an  airplane or in any other area where making or receiving calls  or data is prohibited     Connections    Important  When your device is in Airplane mode  it cannot    send or receive any calls or access online  information or applications     1  From the Home screen  press   1  and then tap    Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks     290    2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Airplan
69.  can add the  appropriate prefix by prepending the number     1   2     96    From the Home screen  tap Logs tab    Touch and hold an entry to access the entry specific  context menu    Tap Copy to dialing screen    Edit the number using the on screen keypad or delete  digits by pressing     _   to erase the numbers    Tap once the number has been changed           Erasing the Call logs List    You can delete either an individual call log entry or all current  entries from the Logs list     To clear a single entry from the list     1   2     From the Home screen  tap  gt  Logs tab   Touch and hold an entry and select Delete  gt  Delete     To clear all entries from the list     Pon      From the Home screen  tap mo Logs tab   Press    and then tap Delete    Tap Select all    Tap Delete  gt  Delete to continue with the erasure    or    Tap Cancel to stop the current process     Call Duration    1   2   3     From the Home screen  tap a  Logs tab    Press    and then tap Call duration    The following times are displayed for Voice and Data      Last call  shows the length of time for the last call      Dialed calls  shows the total length of time for all calls made      Received calls  shows the total length of time for all calls  received    e All calls  shows the total length of time for all calls made and  received    You may reset these times to zero by pressing     then tapping Reset     Viewing Missed Calls from Lock Screen    When you are unable to answer a call for any 
70.  current Home screen wallpaper     1     Navigate to any screen   Press   to go to the Home screen     Touch and hold an empty area of the screen    From the Home screen window tap Set wallpaper  gt    Home screen    Select a Wallpaper type      Tap Gallery to select from a user image stored in the camera  image gallery  crop the image  and tap Done      Tap Live wallpapers to select from a list of animated  backgrounds  once done tap Set wallpaper      Tap Wallpapers  scroll through the images  tap a wallpaper  image  then tap Set wallpaper    Understanding Your Device 69    Note  Wallpapers supports the following image types  JPEG     PNG  GIF  BMP  and WBMP     To change Wallpapers from Settings Menu     1     Note  The Home and lock screens is an additional option that    From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Display  gt   Wallpaper     or    Touch and hold an empty area of the screen and select  Set wallpaper     Choose from Home screen  Lock screen  or Home and  lock screen     allows you to change both screens at the same time     3  Select a wallpaper type  Gallery  Live wallpaper  or    Wallpapers      4  Choose an image and tap Done or Set wallpaper     70    To change the current Lock screen wallpaper     1     Navigate to any screen  touch and hold an empty area   of the screen  and tap Set wallpaper Lock screen     or    From the Home screen  press        and then tap   Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Display  gt    Wa
71.  editing      Share via  allows you to share your saved photo via Bluetooth   ChatON  Dropbox  Email  Flipboard  Gmail  Google    Group Play  Messaging  Picasa  S Memo  or Wi Fi Direct      Set as  assigns the currently saved image as either a  Contact  photo  Home and lock screens  Home screen  or Lock screen     The Gallery  The Gallery is where you view photos and play back videos   For photos  you can also perform basic editing tasks  view a  slideshow  set photos as wallpaper or caller image  and  share as a picture message     Note  If the phone displays a memory full message when  accessing the Gallery  access Files and remove some of  the media files from the folders  and then open the  Gallery     Opening the Gallery  m From the Home screen  tap Ea  Apps   gt  KH   Gallery   For more information  refer to    Camera  Gallery Options    on page 177     Note  If you stored your files in folders  directories  on the  storage card  Gallery displays these folders as separate  albums  The top left album contains all the pictures in  the storage card     Multimedia 181    Viewing a Video within the Gallery    1  From the Home screen  tap Ea  Apps   gt  PX   Gallery      2  Locate your folder and video   3  Tap     Play  to playback your video   For more information on using the Picture in Picture feature    for video playback  see    Using Picture In Picture    on  page 183     182    Using Video  The Video application plays video files stored on the SD card   This device is
72.  entry s  name  Matching entries are then displayed  This  process filters through all of your current account  Contact entries to only show you the matching entries     sis  In a single motion  touch and hold the letter tab area   on the right  until on screen letters appear  then scroll  through the list  You are then taken to that section of  the Contacts list  Touch the contact entry     112    Tabs    Search  Contacts  field    Contacts       Create  Contacts    Tabbed  Navigation    Editing Contact Information    1   2        From the Home screen  tap n0  Tap a contact name from the list and tap EZ  Edit      Select a contact name and press   I and then tap  Edit     Touch and hold a Contacts entry from the main  Contacts list and then tap Edit     Join contact  Share contact via message Context  Add te favoritos Menu    Add to group    Add to reject list    Share namecard via  Print contact info    Add shortcut to home    3  Edit the contact information then      Tap Save to complete and store the new entry or     Tap Cancel to delete the current entry    Adding a Number to an Existing Contact  From the Home screen  tap B     1   2     Touch and hold an entry  and select Edit to reveal  the Contact entry s  details screen    Tap a phone number   field and enter a phone   number      Tap rJ on the  QWERTY keyboard to  remove a previously  entered phone number    e Tap    toenter an  additional phone number       H Google contact    som gmalic om     Je  Phone     Mobile
73.  eo  Cancel  to cancel the recording of an audio  file     6  Tap BE  List  to display a list of current recordings     7  Tap  Recording quality  to adjust the recording  quality  Choose from  Normal or High quality recording     8  From the Recorded files page  press I and then  select one of the following     Applications and Development 255    256      Share via and select a method in which to share this audio file     Selections are  Bluetooth  Dropbox  Email  Gmail     or Wi Fi Direct  Refer to each    the method you selected to send this voice recording   Delete  allows you to delete 1    the recordings to delete and    Settings  the following settings are available       Storage  allows you to choose where your recording     saved  Select between Pho      Recording quality  allows  High or Normal       Limit for MMS  allows you    MMS by selecting On  you will be ass    be sent in a message       Contextual filename   req  adjust the file    your current GPS location     lessaging   specific section  depending on    or more voice recordings  Tap  ap Delete           ill be    Da          e or memory card   you to set the recording quality to       to select On or Off  If you Limit for    red that the recording can    uires GPS tagging  allows you to             ame based on contextual information such as        Default name  allows you to choose the name prefix for your    recordings  For example  if your Defa  Id be named Voice 001  Voice 002  Voice 003              
74.  eyes of people or pets   122011     Section 13  Warranty Information    Standard Limited Warranty  What is covered and for how long     SAMSUNG TELECOMMUNICATIONS AMERICA  LLC    SAMSUNG   warrants that SAMSUNG s handsets and  accessories   Products   are free from defects in material  and workmanship under normal use and service for the  period commencing upon the date of purchase by the first  consumer purchaser and continuing for the following  specified period of time after that date     Phone 1 Year  Batteries 1 Year  Case Pouch Holster 90 Days  Other Phone Accessories 1 Year    What is not covered     This Limited Warranty is conditioned upon proper use of the  Product     This Limited Warranty does not cover   a  defects or damage  resulting from accident  misuse  abnormal use  abnormal  conditions  improper storage  exposure to liquid  moisture   dampness  sand or dirt  neglect  or unusual physical   electrical or electromechanical stress   b  scratches  dents  and cosmetic damage  unless caused by SAMSUNG     c  defects or damage resulting from excessive force or use  of a metallic object when pressing on a touch screen     d  equipment that has the serial number or the  enhancement data code removed  defaced  damaged   altered or made illegible   e  ordinary wear and tear     f  defects or damage resulting from the use of Product in  conjunction or connection with accessories  products  or  ancillary peripheral equipment not furnished or approved by  SAMSUNG   g  d
75.  gt  Add account and  sign into your Google account    8  Tap the checkbox next to Automatic restore to create a  checkmark  This will restore the settings that were  backed up when you re install an application    Factory Data Reset  From this menu you can reset your device and sound settings  to the factory default settings    1  From the Home screen  press ii  and then tap  Settings  gt  Accounts tab  gt  Backup and reset  gt   Factory data reset    2  Read the on screen reset information    3  Tap Reset device    4  If necessary  enter your password and tap Delete all   The device resets to the factory default settings  automatically and when finished displays the Home  screen     Collect Diagnostics    This feature only collects diagnostic data for troubleshooting  use     1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  Accounts tab  gt  Backup and reset  gt   Collect diagnostics    2  Read the on screen System Manager Application  information     Note  This software collects only diagnostic data from your    device so that T Mobile technicians can better  troubleshoot issues with your device     3  Choose to enable or disable the feature by placing a  check mark in the Allow diagnostics to be collected  field    4  Select either More Info  to read additional information   or Close to close the message screen     Changing Your Settings 343    Important  Selecting Close only closes the current description    screen and does not disable data collection   
76.  handy when you  have multiple entries for the same person    1  From the Home screen  tap EB    2  Tap a Contact entry    3  Press and then tap Mark as default  The Mark as  default screen displays radio buttons next to the  contact name  phone number  or other contact  information    4  Tapthe radio button next to the entry information you  want to be the primary information  such as name   phone number  or email  and select Done     Contacts 119    Vote  If there are multiple phone numbers assigned to an  entry  assigning one as the default will automatically dial  that number when the contact is selected for dialing     Sending a Namecard  A Namecard contains contact information  and can be sent to  recipients as a Virtual Business Card  V card  attachment  using Bluetooth  Google Mail  or as a message   1  From the Home screen  tap By   2  Tapa Contact entry   3  Press    and then tap Share namecard via and select  a delivery method  Bluetooth  ChatON  Dropbox  if enabled    Email  Exchange or Internet   Gmail  Messaging  or Wi Fi  Direct   The Namecard attaches to the selected message type  and is delivered when you send the message     Note  Email appears as an option only after an Internet or  Exchange email account has been created     120    Sending All Current Namecards  Rather than selecting once Contact entry at a time  you can  send all of your current entries at once   1  From the Home screen  tap B    2  Press       and then tap Import Export Share  namecard v
77.  holding 1  will launch the voicemail  application     2  When connected  follow the voice prompts from the  voicemail center   Accessing Your Voice Mail From Another Phone  1  Dial your wireless phone number   2  When you hear your voicemail greeting  press the  asterisk key on the phone you are using   3  Enter your passcode     Visual Voicemail  Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of people who  left a voicemail message  and listen to the any message they  want without being limited to chronological order   1  From the Home screen  tap 8E  Apps   gt   L    Visual Voicemail    2  Read the on screen information and tap Next     Note  You must subscribe to the Visual Voicemail service to  use this feature  Charges may apply  Please contact your  service provider for further details     3  Tapan on screen voicemail message to play it back     Getting Started 23    To check Visual Voicemail messages   1  From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt   BER  Visual Voicemail    2  Tap the voicemail message you want to play   3  Tap J Pa   To delete Visual Voicemail messages   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   BER Visual Voicemail      2  Tap the voicemail message you want to delete     3  Tap T   Delete   gt  OK     24    Task Manager    Your device can run applications simultaneously  with some  applications running in the background     Sometimes your device might seem to slow down over time   and the biggest reason for this are background applications   These are a
78.  is a new visual voicemail  message     Displays in the notifications window when there  is a new Email message     Displays in the notifications window when there  is a new Gmail message     Displays when the user is prompted to set up a  new Dropbox account     E E     I E    X    JA    Displays when the user is prompted with a Lookout  Security notification     Displays when the T Mobile Name ID  application did not recognize a recent number  and would like to know whether you wish to  Not add  or add as a New or Existing number     Displays whenthetime and datefor a Calendar Event  has arrived  For more information  refer to   Calendar  on page 217     Displays when an alarm is set   For more information  referto    Setting an Alarm  on  page 220     Displays when the device is in Silent mode    All sounds except media and alarms are silenced   and Silent mode is set to Vibrate  For more  information  refer to  Silent mode via Device  Options Screen  on page 307     Displays when the device is in Silent mode   All sounds are silenced  and Silent mode is set to  Mute        Displays when data synchronization and  application sync is active and synchronization is in  progress for Gmail  Calendar  and Contacts     Displays when the Blocking mode feature is  active  For more information  refer to  Blocking  Mode  on page 321     Displays when Bluetooth technology is active and  enabled     Displays when the Bluetooth technology is active  and communicating with an external de
79.  least one feature must be activated before Motion can    be activated     4  Inasingle motion  slide a feature s activation slider to    the on position   ED      For more information  refer to    Motions and Gestures  Settings    on page 331     56    To activate Palm Motion  uM  1  From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures   2  Ina single motion touch and slide the Palm motion  slider to the right to turn it on   3  Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At least one feature must be activated before Palm  motion can be activated     4  Inasingle motion  slide a feature   s activation slider to    the on position  fS      For more information  refer to    Motions and Gestures  Settings    on page 331     Gyroscope Calibration  Calibrate your device by using the built in gyroscope     1     From the Home screen  press     1 and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures  gt   Gyroscope calibration    Place the device on a level surface and tap Calibrate   The device adjusts the level of the accelerometer   During the calibration process a green circle appears  on screen and the center circle adjusts to the center  position     Using the Multi Window    This feature allows you to run multiple applications on the  current screen at the same time     Note  Only applications found within the Multi window panel    can be active atop another current application on the  screen    When lau
80.  location from a  starting point       Local  provides access to the places menu where you can  quickly locate a business or person  find out more information  about a business  see coupons  public responses  and more   Local   Locate and tap one of the listed places  Restaurants   Cafes  Bars  Attractions  or select from available categories  Such as Entertainment  ATMs  Gas stations  Hotels  Post office   or Taxi     Layers  al      Traffic   available only in selected areas  Real time traffic  conditions are displayed over roads as color coded lines  Each  color represents how fast the traffic is moving        Satellite  Maps uses the same satellite data as Google Earth   Satellite images are not real time  Google Earth acquires the  best imagery available  most of which is approximately one to  three years old        Terrain  combines a topographical view of the area s terrain  with the current map location        Transit Lines  displays the overlapping transit lines on your  map        Latitude  allows you to see your friend s locations and share  your location with them     lows you to switch map views                          Applications and Development 233        My Maps  displays a list of your preferred maps         Bicycling  displays the overlapping cycling trails on your map         Wikipedia  displays any Wikipedia markers and info on yo   map   4  Press  S  and select one of the following options     Clear Map  allows you to remove all markings and layers fi  
81.  more information  refer to  Calculator  on page  216     tobe Calendar  31 Launches a calendar application that syncs to your  Facebook     Google     or Microsoft Exchange work  calendars     For more information  refer to  Calendar  on page  217     Camera    e Launches the built in 13 0 megapixel camera  application from where you can take a picture with  either the front or rear facing cameras     Note  A micro SD card is no longer needed to take  pictures or shoot video due to built in storage     Note  The default storage location is your phone  It  is recommended that you store your pictures  and videos on a microSD card  If something  were to occur to the device  your files are still  protected     In addition to taking photos  the built in camera also  doubles as a camcorderthatalso allows you to record   view  and send high definition videos    For more information  referto    Using the Camera  on  page 163  For more information  refer to  Using the  Camcorder  on page 170     ChatON    Provides a global mobile communication service  where you can chat with more than 2 buddies via a  group chat  Share things such as pictures  videos   animation messages  Scribbles   audio  Contacts   Calendar entries  and Location information     For more information  referto  ChatON  on page 158     Chrome    Allows you to use the Google Chrome web browser on  your device     For more information  referto  Chrome  on page 220     CON Clock  CO Allows you to set an alarm  configure
82.  name for this device using the keyboard    5  Tap OK to confirm your setting    To set visibility    1  Verify your Bluetooth is active    2  From the top of the Bluetooth settings page  toggle the  state of the visibility check mark  Activating this feature  enabled your device visible allows other devices to pair  and communicate     268    Note  Your device visibility is based on the time set within the    Visible time out field  2 Minutes  5 Minutes  1 Hour  or  Never timeout   Press rj  Menu   gt  Visibility timeout   This value appears as a countdown within this Visibility  timeout field     To scan for Bluetooth devices    1  Verify Bluetooth is active    2  From the bottom of the Bluetooth settings page  tap  Scan to search for visible external  Bluetooth compatible devices such as headsets   devices  printers  and computers    To review your Bluetooth received files    1  Verify Bluetooth is active  f   2  From the Bluetooth settings page  press     1  and then  tap Received files  m    Pairing Bluetooth Devices    The Bluetooth pairing process allows you to establish trusted  connections between your device and another Bluetooth  device  When you pair devices  they share a passkey   allowing for fast  secure connections while bypassing the  discovery and authentication process     Note  Pairing between two Bluetooth devices is a one time    process  Once pairing is established the devices  continue to recognize their partnership and exchange  information without en
83.  not provided by or supported by Google or  any other company  end users operate these devices  at their own risk     This menu allows you to manage installed applications  You  can view and control currently running services  or use the  device for application development    You can also view the amount of memory or resources used  as well as the remaining memory and resources for each of  the applications on your phone and clear the data  cache  or  defaults     m From the Home screen  press I and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  Application manager  2 ALL     348    Clearing Application Cache and Data    Important  You must have downloaded applications installed  to use this feature     1  From the Home screen  press  E and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Application manager   2  Tap an application in which to clear the cache or data     3  Tap Force stop  Uninstall  Clear data  Clear cache  or  Clear defaults     Uninstalling Third party Applications    Important  You must have downloaded applications installed    to use this feature     1  From the Home screen  press 1 1 and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Application manager    2  Tap the DOWNLOADED tab and select your desired  application    3  Tap Uninstall  from within the top area of the  Application info page     4  Atthe prompt  tap OK to uninstall the application     5  Select a reason for uninstalling the application  then  tap OK   Memory Usage  See how memory is being used by Downloaded or R
84.  not use the mobile device with a wet hand  Doing so  may cause an electric shock to you or damage to the  mobile device     370    Extreme heat or cold   Avoid temperatures below 0  C   32  F or above 45  C    113 F    Microwaves   Do not try to dry your mobile device in a microwave oven   Doing so may cause a fire or explosion    Dust and dirt   Do not expose your mobile device to dust  dirt  or sand   Cleaning solutions   Do not use harsh chemicals  cleaning solvents  or strong  detergents to clean the mobile device  Wipe it with a soft  cloth slightly dampened in a mild soap and water  solution    Shock or vibration   Do not drop  knock  or shake the mobile device  Rough  handling can break internal circuit boards    Paint   Do not paint the mobile device  Paint can clog the  device s moving parts or ventilation openings and prevent  proper operation     Responsible Listening    Caution  Avoid potential hearing loss     Damage to hearing occurs when a person is exposed to loud  sounds over time  The risk of hearing loss increases as  sound is played louder and for longer durations  Prolonged  exposure to loud sounds  including music  is the most  common cause of preventable hearing loss  Some scientific  research suggests that using portable audio devices  such as  portable music players and cell phones  at high volume  settings for long durations may lead to permanent  noise induced hearing loss    This includes the use of headphones  including headsets   earbuds  and Bl
85.  play speed anywhere be  2 0X using the slider      Music menu  this menu allows you to select  you want to display  Choices are  Albums  Art  Music square  Folders  Composers  Years     een 0 5X and    which categories  ists  Genres   lost played     Recently played  or Recently added  Tap each item that you    We      5    nt to display in the Music menu          Music auto off  when enabled  sets a timer    or the Music    application to automatically turn off after a pre selected amount    of time     Lyrics  when activated  the lyrics of the song  available     Smart volume  when activated  automaticall  track   s volume to an equal level     Voice control  when activated  allows you to  commands to control the music player              are displayed if    ly adjusts each    use voice control    Using Playlists  Playlists are used to assign music files into groups for  playback  These Playlists can be created using the Music  player on this device  or using a third party application  such  as Windows Media Player  and downloading those files to an  SD card inserted into the device   Creating a Playlist  1  From the Home screen  tap      Music    2  Tap the Playlists tab   3  Press l   and then tap Create playlist   4  Backspace over the default playlist title and type a new  name for this playlist  then tap OK      Apps   gt     Adding Music to a Playlist  1  From the Home screen  tap      Music    2  Tap the Playlists tab   3  Tap the playlist name in which to add music
86.  press 5 to retum to  the Settings menu     Tip  To find your device   s Divx  registration code and  information about registering your device to play DivX  protected video  tap License settings  gt DivX   VOD     e Device name  allows you to both display and edit the device s  name      Model number  displays the device s model number      Android version  displays the firmware version loaded on this  device      Baseband version  displays the baseband version loaded on  this device      Kernel version  displays the kernel version loaded on this  device       Build number  displays the software  build number     Note  Firmware  baseband  kernel and build numbers are  usually used for updates to the handset or support  For  additional information please contact your T Mobile  service representative       SELinux status  displays the status of SELinux  SELinux is a  Set of security policies modules which is applied to the device  to improve the overall security     Software Update    The Software Update feature enables you to use your device  to connect to the network and upload any new software  directly to your device  The device automatically updates  with the latest available software when you access this  option    The following icons show your Bluetooth connection status  at a glance     Displays when the Software updated feature is  active     Displays when the Software update feature is in  progress     Changing Your Settings 353    To update your device        1  Fro
87.  regulatory actions  the FDA has urged the cell phone industry  to take a number of steps  including the following     Support needed research on possible biological effects of RF  for the type of signal emitted by cell phones     Design cell phones in a way that minimizes any RF exposure to  the user  and    Cooperate in providing users of cell phones with the current  information on cell phone use and human health concerns   The FDA also is working with voluntary standard setting  bodies such as the Institute of Electrical and Electronics  Engineers  IEEE   the International Commission on  Non lonizing Radiation Protection  ICNIRP   and others to  assure that safety standards continue to adequately protect  the public     358    Reducing Exposure  Hands Free Kits and Other   Accessories   Steps to Reduce Exposure to Radio Frequency Energy  If there is a risk from being exposed to radio frequency  energy  RF  from cell phones   and at this point we do not  know that there is   it is probably very small  But  if you are  concerned about avoiding even potential risks  you can take  a few simple steps to minimize your RF exposure      Reduce the amount of time spent using your cell phone     Use speaker mode or a headset to place more distance between   your head and the cell phone   Hands Free Kits    Hands free kits may include audio or Bluetooth   headsets  and various types of body worn accessories such as  belt clips and holsters  Combinations of these can be used to  redu
88.  screen instructions to backup and sync your  dictionary based on an email address        Enter the activation code received after your email has been  confirmed      Backup  amp  Sync  when active  allows you to backup your  Swype dictionary and sync your Swype dictionary across  multiple devices    e Contribute usage data  when enabled  allows the Nuance  application to collect usage data for better word predictions      Cellular data  when enabled  activates cellular data usage by  the Swype application so it can receive program updates   language downloads  and other related features via your  existing data connection     Tap Personalization to access and manage your  personal dictionary  Log into the available accounts to  add help personalize your personal dictionary with  commonly used words or names from your available  accounts      Edit Dictionary  allows you to edit your current personal Swype  dictionary      Facebook  allows you to log into your current Facebook  account from where contact names are added to your Swype s  personal dictionary for later use when you enter names into text  fields  Helps recognize familiar names      Twitter  allows you to sign into your existing Twitter account   from where names and words are added to your personal  dictionary  Helps recognize familiar names and words      Gmail  allows you to sign in to your existing Gmail account from  where existing contact information is added to your personal  dictionary  Helps recognize famil
89.  signature to the  bottom of all outgoing emails       In a single motion touch and slide the Signature slider to the  right to turn it on       Tap the Signature field  change the current text  and tap OK to  save the new signature     Default account  Assign this account as the default email  account used for outgoing messages           Tap the More settings field to access additional options       Account name  displays your uniquely created account display  name      Your name  displays the name used in the From field of your  outgoing email messages      Always Cc Bcc myself allows you to include your own email  address in either the CC  Bcc  or None fields  Lets you always  receive a copy of outgoing emails      Forward with attachments  Lets you include attachments  when forwarding an email      Recent messages  adjusts the number of on screen  messages shown in the current category list at any one time      Show images  allows you to view embedded images located  within the body of the currently displayed email      Number of emails to load  allows you to select the number of  on screen emails to keep loaded on the screen by default      Auto download attachments  allows the device to  automatically download email attachments when an active  Wi Fi connection is detected  This process speeds up the  process of downloading an emails attachments for offline  review by not using a 3G or 4G network connection                      Auto resend times  enables  email a specifi
90.  still running  These minimized applications  can  over time  cause your device to  slow down        Turn off any streaming services after use  see Running Services        Animated wallpapers use processing power  memory  and more  power  Change your Live Wallpaper to a non animated Wallpaper  gallery or Gallery image    Initial Device Configuration  1  Select a language from the associated field   English is the default language     Note  If you are visually impaired or have difficulty hearing  tap    Accessibility to configure the accessibility settings   2  Tap Next     Note  You may be prompted with a notification that your  activation is completed     3  Atthe Wi Fi screen  move the slider to activate the  feature and connect to either an existing Wireless  Access Point  WAP  or tap Next to continue     16    4  If prompted  assign the Date and time settings  Enable  the Automatic date and time field  select a time zone   and tap Next    e  f you disable the Automatic date and time feature  you can  then manually assign this information     Note  The Date and time menu may not appear if  automatically detected via your internal microSIM card     5  Atthe Samsung account screen  select one of the  following options   e If this is your first time  tap Create new account   e  f you have previously created a Samsung account  tap Sign in    or   Tap Skip to continue with the setup process and create  an account later  For more information  refer to     Creating a Samsung Acco
91.  such as headsets  devices   printers  and computers     Important  Some Bluetooth devices are secured and require a    PIN number to confirm and pair with them     3  Enter a PIN to pair with the device  if one is required   and tap OK     Data Usage  Monitor and mange your device s data usage capabilities   Features include activation deactivation or network data    usage  set mobile data usage for a set period of time  and  view application data usage     m From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  ae  To activate deactivate Mobile data usage   1  From the Home screen  press  ren   and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Data usage   2  Tap the Mobile data field to activate the feature  A  green check mark indicates the feature is active   3  Tap the Mobile data field again to deactivate the  feature        To set a mobile data limit     1  From the Home screen  press  E and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Data usage     2  Place a check mark in the Set mobile data limit field     3  Read the on screen disclaimer info and tap OK      Connections tab   gt  Data usage     Touch and drag the far right ends of the Red or Orange  horizontal lines to manually adjust both the Warning  and Maximum data limits    Touch and drag the bottom grey vertical lines to adjust   the time frames    Tap the Data usage cycle button and select either the   current cycle or define your own by selecting Change   cycle        Press    and then select from the
92.  tap  gt  m and select the    key     Using the Samsung Keyboard  This QWERTY keyboard can be used to enter text in either a  Portrait or landscape orientation  The only difference  between the two orientations are the sizes of the keys   From a screen where you enter text  rotate your phone  counterclockwise to a landscape orientation  The on screen  QWERTY keyboard displays    The Samsung Keyboard  This device has a built in  QWERTY keypad  portrait mode  or  keyboard  landscape mode   Using the QWERTY keypad   keyboard  you can type letter  numbers  punctuation  and  other characters   To use the Samsung keyboard you must first configure the  settings to default to the Samsung keyboard    1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Language and  input  gt  Default  gt  Samsung keyboard     or    From a screen where you can enter text  in a single  motion  touch and drag the Status bar down to the  bottom of the screen  then select Ea  Select input  method   gt  Samsung keyboard     2  The virtual keyboard is then assigned to the Samsung  keyboard configuration for all subsequent text input     Text input field    Shift key       Input Mode Current Mode Send Delete  Indicator   Input Options   Settings  For more detailed information on configuring Samsung  Keyboard settings  see    Samsung Keyboard Settings    on  page 326     Entering Text 103    Entering Text using Different Input Options  Although the default text input method with 
93.  text mode button displays EM   e Symbol Numeric Srl  to enter numbers by pressing the  numbers selecting them on the on screen keyboard  In this  mode  the text mode button displays ES  There are up to 2 available pages of numeric symbols available  by tapping EPA        Note  After typing an initial uppercase character  tap to    toggle capitalization     lowercase     Initial Uppercase    Displays when the first character of each word is  entered as uppercase but all subsequent  characters are lowercase     All Uppercase  t Displays when all characters will be entered as    uppercase characters     All lowercase  t Displays when the next character is entered in    By default  the first letter of a new entry is capitalized and the  following letters are lowercased  After a character is entered   the cursor automatically advances to the next space     Using ABC Mode in Samsung Keyboard  1  From a screen where you can enter text  tap the text  input field to reveal the on screen keyboard   2  Tap to configure the keyboard for ABC mode   Once in this mode  the text input type shows EM    Note  After typing an initial uppercase character  the EJ key    changes to and all letters that follow are in lower  case     3  Enter your text using the on screen keyboard        If you make a mistake  tap to erase a single character   Touch and hold to erase an entire word   4  Tap   A    Send  to deliver the message                    Entering Text     105    Using SymbollNumeric Mode  Us
94.  the  device to increase the brightness and contrast for better  viewing    e  n dim light conditions  the device increases the screen  brightness to compensate    3  Menu key displays a list of options available for the  current screen  From the Home screen it displays  Add apps and widgets  Create folder  Set wallpaper   Edit page  Search  and Settings options    4  Home key displays the Home screen when pressed   Press and hold to display your recent apps  Task  manager  and Remove all option    Double press to activate S Voice              Understanding Your Device 29    10     30    Microphones are used during phone calls and allow  other callers to hear you clearly when you are speaking  to them  There are two microphones on the device     Bottom microphone  used during handset mode     Top microphone  used while an active call is in the  Speakerphone mode and assists in noise cancellation   2 microphone solution    USB Power Accessory connector allows you to connect  a power cable or optional accessories such as a USB   data cable   Back key redisplays the previous screen or clears  entries   Display shows all the information needed to operate  your phone  such as the connection status  received  signal strength  phone battery level  and time   Front Facing Camera allows you to take pictures while  facing the screen and allows you to video conference   Gestures Sensor used to detect Air View and Air Gesture  motions     11     12     Proximity Sensor detects how close 
95.  the connection by making sure both your TV  and device show the same image screen     AllShare Cast Hub   Streaming Videos    The hub supports streaming of purchased media content that  contains DRM  Digital Rights Management      Note  You can control the volume level of your playback file    being shown on your TV by using your device s Volume  buttons  For additional volume  use your TV s volume  controls     To stream video content to your Tv via AllShare Cast Hub    1  Connect your AllShare Cast Hub to your TV  For more  information  refer to  Connecting AllShare Cast Hub   on page 210    2  Verify your TV is set to the same source as your hub  and that you can see the on screen connection and  configuration tutorials  LS   3  From the Home screen  press    1 and then tap  Settings Connections tab   Screen Mirroring    4  If not already on  tap the Screen Mirroring and then  move the slider to the right to turn it on  The slider  color indicates the activation status  A list of available  hubs will appear on the screen     Press the RESET button on the back of the hub once   LED turns blue  and tap the dongle entry from your  device s list     or    If reconnecting  verify the hub s LED is blinking red and  then tap the dongle entry from your device s list       Verify  AllShare Cast Hub Communicating  appears    at the top of the device s screen       Verify  Wi Fi Direct Communicating  now displays     To playback a user created video       From the Home screen  tap E
96.  the connectors align   2  Gently press down to secure the battery  2      12    Removing the Battery    wm Grip the battery at the top end  3  and lift it up and out  of the battery compartment  4      Installing Battery       Removing Battery    Charging the Battery  Your device is powered by a rechargeable Li ion battery  A  wall charger  which is used for charging the battery  is  included with your device  Use only approved batteries and    chargers  Ask your local Samsung dealer for further details     Before using your device for the first time  you must fully  charge the battery  A discharged battery recharges fully in  approximately 4 hours     ex    Correct d  S    Charging Head    XN Incorrect    Pg       USB Cable    Note  Verify that the battery is installed prior to connecting the    wall charger  If both the wall charger is connected and  the battery is not installed  the handset will power cycle  continuously and prevent proper operation  Failure to  unplug the wall charger before you remove the battery   can cause the device to become damaged     Important  It is recommended you fully charge the battery    before using your device for the first time     Connect the USB cable to the charging head    Locate the Charger Accessory jack    Insert the USB cable into the device   s Charger   Accessory jack    Plug the charging head into a standard AC power  outlet  The device turns on with the screen locked and  indicates both its charge state and percent of charge 
97.  the last number 82  Wait Dialing 81   Call Functons  Vibrate 312    Call Rejection 79  311  Call Settings 310  Additional Settings 315  General 311  Call Sound  Adding More Volume 87  Personalize 87  88  Call Status Tones 311  Call Vibration 311  314  Call Volume  Adjusting 87  Call Waiting 92  315  316  Caller ID 315  Calling  Using Wi Fi 84  Calls  Auto Reject 311  Making a 75  Multi party 90  Muting 89  Camcorder 170  Accessing the Video Folder 172  Settings 167  Shooting Video 170    395    Camera 162  Camera Options 164  Enabling Share Shot 173  Quick Settings 166  Settings 167  Taking Pictures 163  Care and Maintenance 370  Charging battery 13  ChatON 158  Adding a Buddy 159  Adding New Buddy 159  Buddy photo share 169  Chatting On 159  Deleting Bubble 160  Register Service 158  Children and Cell Phones 359  Chrome  Google 220  Clearing  Application cache and data 244  Cloud 338  CMAS 141  Collect Diagnostics 18  Commercial Mobile Alerting System    396     CMAS  362  Configuration  Initial 16  Connections  Accessing the Internet 259  Contact  Copying to microSD Card 122  Copying to SIM Card 121  Creating a New 108  Joining 117  New From Keypad 110  Photo 178  Contact Entry  Options 117  Contact List  Options 115  Contact Menus  Options 116  Contacts  Adding a Number to Existing 113  Adding a Pause or Wait 114  Adding Your Facebook Friends  124  Additional Options 125    Deleting 114   Display Options 123  126   Displaying Contacts by Name 126   Export List to microSD 
98.  then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt    More networks  gt   Mobile networks    2  Tap Network operators  The current network connection  displays at the bottom of the list     Important  You must deactivate data service prior to searching    for an available network     3  Tap Search now to manually search for a network   4  Tap Select automatically to automatically select a  network connection     Note  Connecting to 2G networks slows the data transfer  speed and time     Default Setup Options  Your phone default is set to Automatic  to automatically  search for an available network  You can set this option to  Manual to select a network each time you connect    1  From the Home screen  press  l and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks  gt  Network operators    2  Tap Default setup    3  Tap Automatic to allow the device to automatically  select a network   ep  Tap Manual to locate and connect to a network  manually     Changing Your Settings 293    Tethering and Mobile HotSpot    This option allows you to share your phone s mobile data  connection via a direct USB connection between your phone  and computer  A wireless version of this same functionality  would be the Mobile AP feature     Note  You can not mount your device s microSD card to your    computer while using the USB tethering feature    If additional software or USB drivers are required   navigate to  http   www samsung com us support   downloads        m From 
99.  to the message    e MMS alert  alerts you when the messaging modes changes  from an SMS  text  to MMS  multimedia  mode              Display     Bubble style  allows you to choose from several bubble styles  for your messages  Bubbles are the rounded boxes that  surround each message      Background style  allows you to choose from several  background styles for your messages      Use the volume key  allows you to change the text size by  using the up or down volume keys           140    Push message settings    Push messages  allows you to receive push messages from    the network      Service loading  allows you to set the type of service loading   notification  Choose from  Always  Prompt  or Never   Notification settings     Notifications  allows you to see message notifications on your  Status bar      Select ringtone  allows you to set the ringtone for your  message notifications      Vibrate  allows you to configure the vibration mode associated  with message alerts      Message alert repetition  allows you to set the interval for new  message alerts  Choose from  Once  Every 2 minutes  or  Every 10 minutes      Preview message  when enabled  allows you to view a brief  preview of new message text on the Status bar     Emergency message settings    Emergency alerts  allows you to configure emergency alert    Settings  You can enable disable those alert categories you  wish to receive  Choose from  Imminent extreme alert   Imminent severe alert  and AMBER alerts     No
100.  tutorial is displaying on the  connected TV     Note  The AllShare Cast Hub communicates with your paired    device via a Wi Fi Direct connection     4  Fora first time connection     Press the RESET button  located at the rear of the hub  once  and only for a second until the LED turns solid BLUE     Quickly tap the hub name entry on your device s AllShare Cast  Screen     Multimedia 211    5  Verify  AllShare Cast Hub Communicating  appears  at the top of the device s screen    6  Confirm the connection by making sure both your TV  and device show the same image screen and   Wi Fi Direct Communicating  now displays on the  device     7  Press   to return to the home screen     Important  The AllShare Cast Hub is a 1 to 1 connection  If a    previous device was paired to the Hub and is still  connected to the AllShare Cast Hub  you can not  pair a new device until the first connection is  stopped     To disconnect your device from the Hub   1  Access your device   s AllShare Cast screen and locate  the current connection     2  Tap the entry and select End connection     212    To reconnect your device again to an existing Hub   1  Locate the AllShare Hub  dongle  name displayed at the  bottom of the TV  showing the tutorial    Ex  Name  Dongle   XXXXXX     Important  Verify the LED is not a solid blue  This indicates  there is another device currently connected     2  Access your device   s Screen Mirroring screen and tap  the same hub dongle name in the list    3  Confirm
101.  until you start  the process or application again    4  Tap Show cached processes to view additional cached  applications     Important  Stopping a process might have undesirable  consequences on the application     Changing Your Settings 349    Storage Used  This option allows you to view a list  on the current tab  of  current applications as sorted by size  _   1  From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Application manager    2  Tap the ALL tab to display all available applications   Press i i  and then tap Sort by size to change the  current list to show items based on the amount of  storage they occupy     350    Reset App Preferences  This feature provides you with the ability to reset all  preferences for the following features  Disabled apps   Disabled app notifications  Default applications for actions   and Background data restrictions  _  1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Applications manager   2  Tap the ALL tab to display all available applications   Press   1 and then tap Reset app preferences  gt   Reset apps     Important  As an example  if you assigned your browser to    always launch YouTube links and want that  changed  you must reset the default actions     Battery Usage  This option allows you to view a list of those components  using battery power  The amount of time the battery was  used also displays  Battery usage displays in percentages  per application    1  From the pis 
102.  use wireless mobile  devices  they may detect a buzzing  humming  or whining  noise  Some hearing devices are more immune than others  to this interference noise  and mobile devices also vary in the  amount of interference they generate     The wireless telephone industry has developed a rating  system for wireless mobile devices to assist hearing device  users find mobile devices that may be compatible with their  hearing devices  Not all mobile devices have been rated   Mobile devices that are rated have the rating on their box or  a label located on the box    The ratings are not guarantees  Results will vary depending  on the user s hearing device and hearing loss  If your hearing  device happens to be vulnerable to interference  you may not    be able to use a rated mobile device successfully  Trying out  the mobile device with your hearing device is the best way to  evaluate it for your personal needs    M Ratings  Wireless mobile devices rated M3 or M4 meet  FCC requirements and are likely to generate less interference  to hearing devices than mobile devices that are not labeled   M4 is the better higher of the two ratings  M ratings refer to  enabling acoustic coupling with hearing aids that do not  operate in telecoil mode     T Ratings  Mobile devices rated T3 or T4 meet FCC  requirements and are likely to generate less interference to  hearing devices than mobile devices that are not labeled  T4  is the better higher of the two ratings  T ratings refer to  enablin
103.  while connected    to the Wi Fi network count against available rate plan  minutes     Important  If you are not using a new ISIM card  you will  receive an Error  ERxx Invalid SIM message  You  must be using a new ISIM card to use this feature     Activating Wi Fi Calling  1  Ensure that the Wi Fi connected icon displays on  the Status Bar    e  f prompted with an on screen    Did you know your phone can  make calls over Wi Fi  popup  tap Learn and follow the  remaining on screen instructions  Tap Next   Done    2  From the Home screen  press      and then tap   Settings  gt  MSIE  connections tab   gt    More networks    3  Locate the Wi Fi Calling field and in a single motion  touch and slide to the right to turn it on     If    Missing 911 Address  displays in the Status   Bar  follow these steps to provide 911 an address for   emergency situations        og into my t mobile com      Click on Profile and edit the Edit customer information      Enter your emergency location information and complete the  online registration  m   From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap   Settings Connections tab   More networks  gt    Wi Fi Calling       Tap Connection Preferences and select a preference for    use by the Wi Fi Calling feature      Wi Fi Preferred  Wi Fi network is preferred over cellular  network when making calls  Calling requires you to stay in the  Wi Fi range      Cellular Network Preferred  The cellular network is preferred  over a Wi Fi network when making ca
104.  you turn  on the phone  the Insert SIM card to make calls message  displays and an animated tutorial shows you how to install  the SIM card   Without a SIM card  you can only make an emergency call  with the phone  normal cell phone service is not available   Making an Emergency Call Without a SIM card  installed  1  Tap Emergency call from the on screen display to make  an emergency call   2  Enter 9 1 1 and tap EU Complete your call   During this type of call  you will have access to the  Speaker mode  Keypad  and End Call features     Note  Selecting Location consent may drain battery power  For    more information  refer to  Power Saving Mode  on  page 321     3  Tap in to exit this calling mode     Making an Emergency Call With a SIM card installed  The Emergency calling mode makes redialing an emergency  number a 1 tap process  Before you can resume normal  calling operations  you should first exit this mode    1  Swipe the Lock screen to unlock the device    2  From the Home screen  tap  3    3  Enter the emergency number  ex  911  and then tap   4  Complete your call  During this type of call  you will  have access to the Speaker mode  Keypad  and End  Call features     Note  This mode can drain your battery power more rapidly    than a normal calling mode     5  Atthe Emergency Callback screen  follow the  on screen instructions     Call Functions and Contacts List     77    Dialing Options  When you enter numbers on the Keypad  you will see three  on screen options
105.  you wish to stop the phone  from making noise  in a theater for example  In Silent Mode  the speaker is muted and the phone only vibrates to notify  you of incoming calls  or other functions that normally have a  defined tone or sound as an alert   1  From the Home screen  press and hold               Power End  until the Device options screen displays   2  Tap either Mute  Vibrate  or Sound from the Device  options screen to activate or deactivate these features   the current mode displays      Adjusting the Volume Settings  The Volume menu now provides access to various volume  settings within one on screen popup menu   1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound  gt  Volume   2  Touch and drag the on screen slider to assign the  volume settings for any of the following volume levels   Music  video  games  and other media  Ringtone   Notifications or System   3  Tap OK to assign the volume levels     Vibration intensity  Vibration intensity allows you to select how intense the  vibration is for different options    1  From the Home screen  press E and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound  gt  Vibration  intensity    2  Touch and drag the slider to adjust the Vibration  intensity for Incoming call  Notification  and Haptic  feedback    3  Tap OK to assign the vibration levels     Changing Your Settings 307    Setup the Ringtones  This option allows you to set the ringtone     1     5     From the Home screen  press 
106. 208  Uploading Video to Web 208  Web Storage Setup 207  Samsung Mobile Products and  Recycling 365  Save a Number  From Keypad 110  Scan for Nearby Devices 202  Screen  Home 40  Navigation 53  Screen Capture 334  Taking a Screen Shot 178  Screen Lock  Set Up 301  Sounds 309    Screen Lock Pattern  Changing 302  Creating 301  Deleting 302  Forgot My Pattern 303  Screen Mirroring  AllShare Cast Connection 211  Screen Mirroring  Activate on Device 211  Activation 298  On 211  213  Using AllShare Cast Hub 210  Screen Mirroringt  On 298  Screen Rotation  Auto Rotate 305  Screen Timeout 305  Screen Unlock  Face and Voice Unlock 301  Face Unlock 300  Swipe 300  Screens  Adding and Deleting 65  Customizing 65    Rearranging 66  SD card  Communicating With 72  Mounting the 72  Unmounting 73  Sending a Namecard 120  Setting an alarm 220  Setting up  Voicemail 22  Settings 167  280  Accessing 280  Browser 265  Call 78  Contact list 126  Display 32  Enabling the GPS Satellites 344  Enabling Wireless Locations 345  Messaging 139  Tab Overview 280  Wallpaper 70  Setup  Initial 16  Severe Alert  Disable 142    Share Applications 66  Share Shot 173  Activate 166  Configuring 175  Enabling 174  Stop Sharing 175  Taking Images 175  Shortcuts  Adding from Application Screen  67  Adding from Home Screen 67  Deleting from a Screen 67  Managing 66  Primary 42  SIM  Micro 7  10  see also micro SIM 10  SkyDrive 207  Smart Alarm 221  Smart Practices While Driving 362  Smart Switch 27  Snooze 222  Rep
107. 323  Blacklist  Adding 116  Blocking Mode 321  On 321  Bluetooth 287  About 267  Change Name 268  Changing Name 287  Configure Device Settings 270  Deleting a Paired Device 270  Device Name 18  Disconnecting a Paired Device  270    Media Audio 270   Microhone Function 270   Off 267  287   On 267  287   Outgoing Headset Condition 312   314   Paring Devices 269   Review Downloaded Files 268   Scan for Devices 268   Scanning for other Devices 288   Sending Contact Information 271   Sending Contacts Via 271   Sending Namecard 121   Set Visibility 268   Settings 267   Status indicators 267   Switching to Headset during call  89   Turning on and off 267  287   Visibility 288   Visible Time Out 268    Bookmarks    Backing Up 342    Browser  Adding bookmarks 263  Deleting bookmarks 264  Emptying cookies 264  Entering a URL 261  Navigation 259  Options 259  Resetting Default Actions 350  Settings 265   Bubble  Options 137   Burst Shots 164   C    Calculator  Scientific Functions 216  Calendar  Creating an event 218  Settings 218  Sync 217  Calibrate Screen 57  334  Call  Accessories 311  Settings 78  79  310    Call Alert  Call Vibrations 311  314   Call Alerts 311   Call Answering Ending 311   Call Barring 315  316   Call Duration 97  Resetting Times 97   Call Forwarding 312  Configuring 315   Call Functions 75  Answering 78  Answering w Gestures 79  Background Calling 76  Ending 76  Ending a Call 76  Ending via Status Bar 76  Making a Multi Party Call 90  Pause Dialing 81  Redialing
108. 340   First Name 126   Groups 127   Import from microSD 340   Last Name First 126   Merge with Samsung Account  115   Reject List 116   Sending All 120   Setting Default Location 115   Settings 126   Share Namecard Via 116   Sharing Settings 126   Sharing Sending 120    Contacts List 75  Context Menus 113  116    Navigation 64  Using 64    Cookies    Emptying 264    Copying Contact 121  Create Folder  Group Apps 43  Creating a Playlist 203  Creating and sending  Messages 131    Customizing  Home screens 65  D  Data    Auto Sync Data 289  Restrict Background Data 289  Data Limit  Setting 289  Data Roaming 291  Activate Deactivate 289  291  Data Usage  Cycle 289  Limiting 289  Date  Selecting Format 352  Date and Time 352  Default Storage  Assigning 162    Camcorder 21  162  Camera 21  162  Deleting  Multiple Messages 138  Single Bubble 138  Single Message 138  Deleting a contact 114  Deregister  Web Storage 207  Desk Clock 220  Configuring 223  Device  Calibration 57  334  Reset 343  Device Name  Edit 353  Device Options  Screen 307  Display  Icons 32  Settings 32  Status Bar 32  Using Negative Colors 323    Display   Touch Screen 367  Displaying your phone number 75  DivX  Locating VOD Number 184  Overview 183  Registering Your DivX Device 184  Registration Code 353  Do cell phones pose a health hazard   355  Dock  Sound 322  Dongle  AllShare Cast Hub 211  Downloading  New application 242  Downloads 224  Draft Messages 132  Dropbox 207  Uploading Picture 226    397    E  Easy
109. 60  Section 8  Multimedia                              162  Assigning the Default Storage Location      162  Using the Camera              000005  163  Camera Options                  000   164  Quick Settings                   000   166  Camera and Camcorder Settings           167  Using the Camcorder                005 170    Sharing Pictures                        173  Editing a Photo                  0005  179  The Gallery            0       00  eee 181  USING Video  i i as Rem eer eser 182  Samsung Hub         suuuuuueuusuue 185  Using WatchON                 00005  189  Play Movies  amp  TV          0  eee ee eee 193  Play  MUSIC    ceat ortnm 193  MUSIC netto en ete  200  Using Playlists           lllssssssesee 203  Creating a Playlist                   0   203  Transferring Music Files                  204  Removing Music Files                   204  Samsung Link snusen 205  AllShare Cast Hub                      210  T Mobile TV            0 00 eee eee eees 214  YOUTUBE zessan nan E 215  Section 9  Applications and  Development                                  ee 216  Applications                      005  216  Calculat  esp ane foh  216  Calendan   uci dos hase totes ext 217    CHAON cono mes cerca Ep l 219  CHOME   isis Eb DA Errem 220  GIOCK seca aces ou rures ERU inte EINE 220  CONTACTS   s esee Ses ite des cn Qoae etie na 224  Downloads              22222ee ee eeee 224  Dropbox           0  eee eee ee eee 224  EMail maha can cue eter Ere nein attt 226  Flipboard
110. 77  see USB Tethering 276  Text Input  Methods 98  Text Input Method  Selecting 98  Text Templates 144  Create Your Own 144  Text To Speech 330  Text to speech  Configuration 330  Third Party Applications 348  Uninstalling 244  Time Zone  Selecting 352    Timer   Automatic Answering 311  314  Tools   Camera 163  TrackPad   Configure 331  Transferring Large Files 175  297  Transferring Music Files 204  Translate 134  TranslateMessage Bubble 137  Travel Wallpaper   Lock Screen 70  TTS 330  TTY Mode 320  Twitter   Personalize Swype 329   Predictive Text 327   U   UL Certified Travel Charger 367  Understanding Your Device 27   Back View 30   Display 32   Features 27   Front View 28    Home 40   Side Views 31  Uninstalling   Third party applications 244  Unknown Numbers   Blocking Messages 143  Unknown Sources 244  Unlock   Using Face 300   Using Voice 301  Unmounting   SD card 73  Usage   Battery 351  USB Connections   As Storage Device 272  USB Settings   As Storage Device 272  USB Tethering 276   Activating 276  294  Use GPS Satellites 232  238  344  Use Wireless Networks 232  238     345  Using Favorites  Adding Favorites 263  V  Vibrate 312  Activate Deactivate 320  Vibration  Create 318  Device 308  Intensity Setup 307  Video  Picture In Picture 183  Sharing Videos 182  Volume 307  Videos  Options 170  Voice Input  Recognition 330  Voice mail  Accessing 23  Accessing from another phone 23  Setting up 22    409    Voice Search 256  330  Voice Typing 98  Configuring 325  Using
111. Add shortcut  Adds a shortcut to the bookmarked webpage to  your phone s Home screen    e Share link  Allows you to share a URL address via Bluetooth   ChatON  Dropbox  Email  Flipboard  Gmail  Google  Google     Messaging  S Memo  or Wi Fi Direct      Delete bookmark  Allows you to delete a bookmark  For more  information  refer to  Deleting Bookmarks  on page 264          Set as homepage  Sets the bookmark to your new homepage     Adding Bookmarks  1  From the webpage  tap  gt   Add bookmark      2  Use the on screen keypad to enter the name of the    bookmark and the URL    Select a storage location for your new bookmark   Update the title of the Bookmark and confirm the URL   Tap Save  The new save page now appears on the  Bookmarks page     Editing Bookmarks    1     From the Bookmarks page  touch and hold the  bookmark you want to edit    Tap Edit bookmark    Use the on screen keypad to edit the name of the  bookmark or the URL    Tap the Location field to assign a new folder location   Tap Save or Cancel to exit the operation     Connections 263    Deleting Bookmarks  1  From the Bookmarks page  touch and hold the  bookmark you want to delete   2  Tap Delete bookmark   3  Atthe confirmation window  tap OK   Emptying the Cookies  A cookie is a small file placed on your phone by a website  during navigation  In addition to containing some site   specific information  a cookie can also contain some  personal information  such as a username and password   which might pose 
112. Android  applications      Application  this folder contains app info for S Memo      Bluetooth  this folder stores files sent via a Bluetooth device      DCIM  this is the default location for pictures and videos taken  by the device  Tap DCIM  gt  Camera to view the picture or  video files             Download  this folder contains downloads you have made     Movies  this folder contains your Video and Movie files             Music  this folder contains your Music files       Notifications  this folder contains all of the notifications you  have received       Pictures  this folder contains your photos     Podcasts  this folder contains all of your podcasts       Ringtones  this folder contains any ringtones you have  purchased     S Memo  this folder contains all the S Memos you have written     Note  Different folders may appear depending on how your    phone is configured     3  Once you have located your file  tap the file name to  launch the associated application     Applications and Development 237    Navigation  Google Maps Navigation  Beta  is an internet connected  turn by turn  GPS navigation system with voice guidance     Caution  Traffic data is not real time and directions may be    wrong  dangerous  prohibited  or involve ferries     Important  To receive better GPS signals  avoid using your  device in the following conditions     inside a building or between buildings    in a tunnel or underground passage    in poor weather    around high voltage or electrom
113. Backup and  reset     2  Tap Factory data reset  This action erases all data from  your device except current system software and  bundled applications  or SD card files such as music or  photos     Note  This feature provides an option to format the internal  USB storage  not the microSD card     3  Tap Reset device  gt  Delete all     74    Section 4  Call Functions and Contacts List       This section describes features and functionality associated Making a Call   Wah making or pibe and the Contacts list  which You can store phone numbers that are regularly used to the   b used io Storg contact iniormauon  SIM card or to the device   s memory  These entries are  Displaying Your Phone Number referred to as the Contacts list    m From the gps Screen  press   and then tap 1  From the Home screen  tap  3  Phone    Settings  gt  IE  More tab   gt  About device  gt  2  Enter the phone number and then tap EU   iis Your ad displays in the m If you make a mistake while dialing  tap   TNI MA clear the last digit  Touch and hold  Note  The device s Settings menu can also be activated entire sequence   by pressing    and then tapping EB  Apps   gt       Settings   Note  When you activate the Auto redial option in the    Call settings  gt  Additional settings menu  the device  automatically redials up to 10 times when the person  does not answer the call or is already on the phone   provided your call is not sent to voicemail     Note  If your screen goes black during your interaction 
114. D begins to blink solid red to indicate  it has begun the start up process     LED Color Patterns Description    Red   Solid Indicates the AllShare Cast Hub is  booting or processing   Red   Blinking Indicates the AllShare Cast Hub is in    standby mode  ready for connection      Blue   Solid Indicates the AllShare Cast Hub is    ready to be connected with a new  device     2  Connect your TV to the AllShare Cast Hub via an HDMI  cable  A to A cable     3  Change the source input on your TV to match the input  port used by the incoming HDMI cable     Note  The television screen should now display an on screen    tutorial showing you how to configure your device s  AllShare Cast Hub and device settings     To activate Screen Mirroring on your device    1  From the Home screen  press  ren and then tap  Settings  gt   Connections tab   gt  Screen  Mirroring    2  If not already on  tap the Screen Mirroring and then  move the slider to the right to turn it on  The slider  color indicates the activation status     Pairing AllShare Cast Hub  To pair your device and Hub for the 1st time    1  With the TV on  locate the AllShare Hub  dongle  name  displayed at the bottom of the TV  showing the tutorial    Ex  Name  Dongle   XXXXXX    2  Access your device s Screen Mirroring screen and  locate the same hub dongle name in the list   e Tap Scan if your AllShare Cast Hub  dongle  does not appear in   the list    3  Verify your AllShare Cast Hub is on  blinking red LED   and the on screen
115. E   INTEROPERABILITY OR NON INFRINGEMENT  WITH RESPECT TO INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY SECURITY PROTECTION  SAFE          DEVICES AND APPLICATIONS TESTED WITH SAFE   DEVICES  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE SAMSUNG ENTITIES BE LIABLE FOR ANY  DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  PUNITIVE  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND WHATSOEVER WITH RESPECT TO  INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY SECURITY PROTECTION  SAFE    DEVICES OR APPLICATIONS TESTED WITH SAFE    DEVICES  In  addition  information technology security protection will be affected by features or functionality associated with  among other  things the e mail platform  master data management  and virtual private network solutions selected by the software provider   solution provider or user  Choice of an e mail  master data management  and virtual private network solution is at the sole  discretion of the software provider  solution provider or user and any associated effect on information technology security  protection is solely the responsibility of the software provider  solution provider or user  For complete statement of limited  warranty  please refer to www samsung com us safe  available on the web and where Samsung smartphone and Galaxy Tab     devices are sold   101212        Samsung Telecommunications America  STA   LLC    Headquarters   1301 E  Lookout Drive  Richardson  TX 75082    Customer Care Center    1000 Klein Rd    Plano  TX 75074   Toll Free Tel  1 888 987 HELP  4357     Internet Address   http   www samsung com    92013 Samsung Tele
116. E AT YOUR OWN  DISCRETION AND RISK AND YOU ARE SOLELY RESPONSIBLE  FOR ANY DAMAGE TO THE MOBILE DEVICE OR LOSS OF DATA  THAT RESULTS FROM THE DOWNLOADING OR USE OF SUCH  THIRD PARTY APPLICATIONS  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO   EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTY REGARDING  WHETHER YOUR PERSONAL INFORMATION IS CAPTURED BY  ANY THIRD PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER OR THE USE TO  WHICH SUCH PERSONAL INFORMATION MAY BE PUT BY  SUCH THIRD PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER  ANY THIRD  PARTY APPLICATIONS PROVIDED WITH THIS MOBILE DEVICE    Warranty Information 387    ARE PROVIDED  AS IS  AND ON AN  AS AVAILABLE  BASIS   WITHOUT WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND FROM SAMSUNG  ELECTRONICS CO   EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  TO THE  FULLEST EXTENT POSSIBLE PURSUANT TO APPLICABLE  LAW  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  DISCLAIMS ALL  WARRANTIES EXPRESS  IMPLIED  OR STATUTORY   INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY  SATISFACTORY QUALITY OR  WORKMANLIKE EFFORT  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  PURPOSE  RELIABILITY OR AVAILABILITY  ACCURACY  LACK  OF VIRUSES  QUIET ENJOYMENT  NON INFRINGEMENT OF  THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR OTHER VIOLATION OF RIGHTS   SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  DOES NOT WARRANT AGAINST  INTERFERENCE WITH YOUR ENJOYMENT OF THE THIRD  PARTY APPLICATION  THAT THE FUNCTIONS CONTAINED IN  THE THIRD PARTY APPLICATION WILL MEET YOUR  REQUIREMENTS  THAT THE OPERATION OF THE THIRD PARTY  APPLICATION WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR FREE  OR  THAT DEFECTS IN THE THIRD PARTY APPLICATION WILL BE  CORRECTED  YOU ASS
117. ES  SO THE ABOVE  EXCLUSIONS OR LIMITATIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU  NO  ADVICE OR INFORMATION  WHETHER ORAL OR WRITTEN   OBTAINED BY YOU FROM SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  OR  ITS AFFILIATES SHALL BE DEEMED TO ALTER THIS  DISCLAIMER BY SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  OF WARRANTY  REGARDING THE SOFTWARE  OR TO CREATE ANY WARRANTY  OF ANY SORT FROM SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO     10  THIRD PARTY APPLICATIONS  Certain third party  applications may be included with  or downloaded to this  mobile device  Samsung Electronics Co  makes no  representations whatsoever about any of these applications   Since Samsung Electronics Co  has no control over such  applications  you acknowledge and agree that Samsung  Electronics Co  is not responsible for the availability of such  applications and is not responsible or liable for any content   advertising  products  services  or other materials on or  available from such applications  You expressly acknowledge  and agree that use of third party applications is at your sole    risk and that the entire risk of unsatisfactory quality   performance  accuracy and effort is with you  It is up to you  to take precautions to ensure that whatever you select to use  is free of such items as viruses  worms  Trojan horses  and  other items of a destructive nature  References on this  mobile device to any names  marks  products  or services of  any third parties are provided solely as a convenience to you   and do not constitute or imply an endorsement  sponsorship   or recom
118. From the Home screen  press    1  and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt  VPN   Touch and hold the VPN that you want to edit   In the pop up that opens  select Edit network   Make the desired VPN setting changes   Tap Save     9 PON    Delete a VPN m  1  From the Home screen  press E and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt  VPN   2  Touch and hold the VPN that you want to delete   3  Tap Delete network within the pop up that opens up   Wi Fi Calling  You can configure your device to make and receive calls over  an active Wi Fi connection  Wi Fi Calling is an excellent  solution for coverage issues in and around the home or  wherever cellular coverage is limited  Minutes used while  connected to the Wi Fi network count against available rate  plan minutes     For more information  refer to    Wi Fi Calling    on page 84   1  Ensure that the Wi Fi connected icon displays on  the status bar  EN  2  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks   3  Ina single motion touch and slide the Wi Fi Calling  slider to the right to turn it on     Changing Your Settings 295    Wi Fi Calling Settings    Important  A compatible SIM card must be installed within the    device prior to using this feature  Wi Fi must first  be active and communicating prior to launching  Wi Fi Calling     1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings Connections tab More networks Wi Fi  Calling    2
119. H  Apps   gt     Xn  Gallery        Locate your video and tap it to begin playback  Your TV now  shows the video    Multimedia 213    9  To playback a DRM purchased video     From the Home screen  tap Ea  Apps   gt     KK  Gallery   Locate your video and tap itto begin playback     e From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   BE  Play Movies  amp  TV   Locate your purchased video and  tap it to begin playback      From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   o  Video   Locate your video and tap it to begin playback     214    T Mobile TV    T Mobile TV is an application that allows you to get live TV  and Video on Demand   1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt    T Mobile TV   The T Mobile Terms and Conditions  page displays     Note  A data plan is required to use this feature  Charges may    apply  Please contact your service provider for further  details     2  Tap Accept if you accept the Terms and Conditions     Tap Exit to close the application     Note  T Mobile TV must be initialized over a cellular network    before it can be used  During this initial registration  process  any Wi Fi connections must be disabled     3  Tap Disable Wi Fi if you currently have an active Wi Fi  connection     4  Tap Start Trial to begin a free 30 day trial of the  service    or   Tap Continue to keep viewing the free content or  Purchase Options to buy the paid features     5  Tap any of the following categories to begin viewing   Home  Live TV  TV Shows  Favorites  Help  Search  More 
120. List  Creating a Contact    The default storage location for saving phone numbers to  your Contacts List is your device   s built in memory    If existing Google and Corporate email accounts have been  synchronized to your phone  these will be made available to  your device during the creation of new entries  These new  Contacts entries can be assigned or saved to synced  accounts such as Phone  SIM  Google  or Corporate    Your device automatically sorts the Contacts entries  alphabetically  You can create either a Device  SIM  Samsung  account  Google  or Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync contact     Important  The Google and Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync    account types are only visible after creating an  email account of those types on your phone       Device contacts are stored locally on the device     Note  If the phone is ever reset to its factory default  parameters  contacts stored on the phone can be lost       SIM contacts are stored within the micro SIM Card     Note  SIM contacts only store the Name and Phone number for    an entry       Samsung account contacts are shared with your existing  Samsung account       Google contacts are shared with your existing Google account  and can also be imported to your phone after you have created a  Google Mail account      Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync  also known as Work or  Outlook  contacts are those contacts that are intended to be  shared with either an Exchange Server or from within Microsoft   Outlook         Add new 
121. MANCE AND SUITABILITY OF ANY  SUCH THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT RESTS  SOLELY WITH THE USER AND THE DIRECT VENDOR  OWNER  OR SUPPLIER OF SUCH THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR  EQUIPMENT    Nothing in the Product instructions or information shall be  construed to create an express warranty of any kind with  respect to the Products  No agent  employee  dealer   representative or reseller is authorized to modify or extend  this Limited Warranty or to make binding representations or  claims  whether in advertising  presentations or otherwise   on behalf of SAMSUNG regarding the Products or this Limited  Warranty    This Limited Warranty gives you specific legal rights  and you  may also have other rights that vary from state to state     Warranty Information 381    What is the procedure for resolving disputes     ALL DISPUTES WITH SAMSUNG ARISING IN ANY WAY FROM  THIS LIMITED WARRANTY OR THE SALE  CONDITION OR  PERFORMANCE OF THE PRODUCTS SHALL BE RESOLVED  EXCLUSIVELY THROUGH FINAL AND BINDING ARBITRATION   AND NOT BY A COURT OR JURY     Any such dispute shall not be combined or consolidated with  a dispute involving any other person s or entity s Product or  claim  and specifically  without limitation of the foregoing   shall not under any circumstances proceed as part of a class  action  The arbitration shall be conducted before a single  arbitrator  whose award may not exceed  in form or amount   the relief allowed by the applicable law  The arbitration shall  be conducted accord
122. Picture  from the bottom right of the  playback screen  Your current video is then sent to  foreground of any new page and most application  Screens    5  The video disappears from the screen once it ends    DivX Overview  This device is able to playback DivX videos  DivX Certified  to play DivX video up to HD 720p  including premium  content  If you try to play DivX VOD content not authorized for  your device  the message  Authorization Error  will be  displayed and your content will not play  Learn more at  www divx com vod   Your device must first be registered to playback protected or  purchased DivX content  DRM free or unprotected content  does not required DivX VOD registration     Multimedia 183    Locating Your VOD Registration Number    1     2   3     From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  About device  gt   Legal information  gt  License settings  gt  DivX   VOD  gt   Register    Write down your Registration code    Tap OK     Register Your DivX Device for VOD Playback of  Purchased Movies  To play purchased DivX movies on your device  you will first    need to complete a one time registration using both your  device and your computer     1     2     184    Write down the DivX registration code that appears  on screen  Copy this 8 or 10 digit number down   Verify you have the latest DivX software running on  your computer  Download the free player  for your  computer  from www divx com    Open the DivX Player on your computer an
123. RICTIONS  You acknowledge that the  Software is subject to export restrictions of various countries   You agree to comply with all applicable international and  national laws that apply to the Software  including the U S   Export Administration Regulations  as well as end user  end  use  and destination restrictions issued by U S  and other  governments    8  TERMINATION  This EULA is effective until terminated  Your  rights under this License will terminate automatically without  notice from Samsung Electronics Co  if you fail to comply  with any of the terms and conditions of this EULA  Upon  termination of this EULA  you must cease all use of the  Software and destroy all copies  full or partial  of the  Software    9  Disclaimer of Warranty  ALL SOFTWARE PROVIDED BY  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  WITH THIS MOBILE DEVICE IS  PROVIDED  AS IS  AND ON AN  AS AVAILABLE  BASIS   WITHOUT WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND FROM SAMSUNG  ELECTRONICS CO   EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  TO THE  FULLEST EXTENT POSSIBLE PURSUANT TO APPLICABLE  LAW  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  DISCLAIMS ALL  WARRANTIES EXPRESS  IMPLIED  OR STATUTORY   INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY  SATISFACTORY QUALITY OR    386    WORKMANLIKE EFFORT  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  PURPOSE  RELIABILITY OR AVAILABILITY  ACCURACY  LACK  OF VIRUSES  QUIET ENJOYMENT  NON INFRINGEMENT OF  THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR OTHER VIOLATION OF RIGHTS   SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW EXCLUSIONS OR  LIMITATIONS OF IMPLIED WARRANTI
124. SE  ARISING OUT OF YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE  OR THIRD PARTY APPLICATIONS ON THIS MOBILE DEVICE  OR  ANY OTHER PROVISION OF THIS EULA  SHALL NOT EXCEED  THE AMOUNT PURCHASER PAID SPECIFICALLY FOR THIS  MOBILE DEVICE OR ANY SUCH THIRD PARTY APPLICATION  THAT WAS INCLUDED WITH THIS MOBILE DEVICE  THE  FOREGOING LIMITATIONS  EXCLUSIONS  AND DISCLAIMERS   INCLUDING SECTIONS 9  10  11 AND 12  SHALL APPLY TO  THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW   EVEN IF ANY REMEDY FAILS ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE     13  U S  Government End Users Restricted Rights  The  Software is licensed only with  restricted rights  and as   commercial items  consisting of  commercial software   and  commercial software documentation  with only those  rights as are granted to all other end users pursuant to the  terms and conditions herein  All Products are provided only  with  restricted rights  with only those rights as are granted  to all other end users pursuant to the terms and conditions  herein  All Software and Products are provided subject to  Federal Acquisition Regulation  FAR  52 227 19     14  APPLICABLE LAW  This EULA is governed by the laws of  TEXAS  without regard to conflicts of laws principles  This  EULA shall not be governed by the UN Convention on  Contracts for the International Sale of Goods  the application  of which is expressly excluded    15  DISPUTE RESOLUTION      a  Non United States residents  If a dispute  controversy or  difference is not amicably settled  it shall be fin
125. Samsung GALAXY G 4    available at T  Mobile       4G LTE SMARTPHONE    User Manual  Please read this manual before operating your  phone and keep it for future reference       uu    Intellectual Property    All Intellectual Property  as defined below  owned by or which is otherwise the property of Samsung or its respective suppliers  relating to the SAMSUNG Phone  including but not limited to  accessories  parts  or software relating there to  the  Phone  System    is proprietary to Samsung and protected under federal laws  state laws  and international treaty provisions  Intellectual  Property includes  but is not limited to  inventions  patentable or unpatentable   patents  trade secrets  copyrights  software   computer programs  and related documentation and other works of authorship  You may not infringe or otherwise violate the  rights secured by the Intellectual Property  Moreover  you agree that you will not  and will not attempt to  modify  prepare  derivative works of  reverse engineer  decompile  disassemble  or otherwise attempt to create source code from the software  No  title to or ownership in the Intellectual Property is transferred to you  All applicable rights of the Intellectual Property shall remain  with SAMSUNG and its suppliers   Open Source Software  Some software components of this product incorporate source code covered under GNU General Public License  GPL   GNU Lesser  General Public License  LGPL   OpenSSL License  BSD License and other open sour
126. Search  allows you to search through all of your messages for  a certain word or string of words  Use the on screen keypad to  enter a word or phrase in which to search  then tap    For more information  refer to  Message Search  on page  139       Delete threads  allows you to delete any message thread   Select the messages to delete and a green check mark will  appear next to the message  Tap Delete  For more information   referto  Deleting a single message thread  on page  138      Draft messages  displays the draft messages folder and its  contents      Locked messages  displays the locked messages folder and  its contents      Scheduled messages  displays the scheduled messages  folder and its contents      Spam messages  displays the spam messages folder and its  contents      Text templates  displays your available text message reply  templates  For more information  refer to  Text Templates  on page 144      Settings  allows you to access Messaging settings  For more  information  refer to  Messaging Settings  on page 139          From the Messaging screen list  touch and hold an   on screen message and select an option      Add to Contacts  allows you to add the sender to either a new  or existing Contacts entry      View contact  allows you to view the current entry information  for the sender      Delete thread  deletes the entire message and its bubbles   Deleting a single message threadFor more information  refer to   Deleting a single message bubble  on page 138
127. To relocate the Multi window apps panel     The Multi window contains two components  tab and apps 1  Activate the Multi window feature    panel  The tab can be manually moved across the screen  2  Tapthe tab to display the apps panel  containing the  The apps panel  containing the scrollable apps  can be scrollable apps     relocated to lock onto the different sides of the screen   ENIMS  To move the tab Up or Down  Note  Its only when the tab is detached that the entire panel    1  Activate the Multi window feature  page 57   can be relocated     2  Press and hold the Back key  S  to view the tab    3  In a single motion  touch and hold the tab J for  approximately one second  then slowly drag it to its  new location along the current screen edge     3  Ina single motion  touch and hold   for approximately  one second to detach it from the screen  1   then  slowly drag it to its new location along any other  available screen edge  2         Note  This is a quick way to get the tab out of the way if you  can   t get to a button or option behind it     e e     dps    T  5 5  R      if       Understanding Your Device     59    Customizing the Multi Window apps    The applications found within the apps panel of the Multi  window can be organized by either being rearranged or  removed     To rearrange the Multi window applications     1   2     Activate the Multi window feature    Tap the tab to display the apps panel  containing the  scrollable apps     In a single motion  touc
128. UME THE ENTIRE COST OF ALL  NECESSARY SERVICING  REPAIR  OR CORRECTION  SOME  JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW EXCLUSIONS OR  LIMITATIONS OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES  SO THE ABOVE  EXCLUSIONS OR LIMITATIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU  NO    388    ADVICE OR INFORMATION  WHETHER ORAL OR WRITTEN   OBTAINED BY YOU FROM SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  OR  ANY OTHER PERSON OR ENTITY SHALL BE DEEMED TO  ALTER THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY REGARDING THIRD  PARTY APPLICATIONS  OR TO CREATE ANY WARRANTY BY  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO     12  Limitation of Liability  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  WILL  NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OF ANY KIND ARISING  OUT OF OR RELATING TO THE USE OR THE INABILITY TO USE  THE SOFTWARE OR ANY THIRD PARTY APPLICATION  ITS  CONTENT OR FUNCTIONALITY  INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED  TO DAMAGES CAUSED BY OR RELATED TO ERRORS   OMISSIONS  INTERRUPTIONS  DEFECTS  DELAY IN  OPERATION OR TRANSMISSION  COMPUTER VIRUS  FAILURE  TO CONNECT  NETWORK CHARGES  IN APP PURCHASES   AND ALL OTHER DIRECT  INDIRECT  SPECIAL  INCIDENTAL   EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES EVEN IF  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES  SOME JURISDICTIONS DO  NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  SO THE ABOVE EXCLUSIONS  OR LIMITATIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU   NOTWITHSTANDING THE FOREGOING  SAMSUNG  ELECTRONIC CO  S TOTAL LIABILITY TO YOU FOR ALL    LOSSES  DAMAGES  CAUSES OF ACTION  INCLUDING BUT  NOT LIMITED TO THOSE BASED ON CONTRACT  TORT  OR  OTHERWI
129. US Department of Homeland Security and  will alert customers of imminent threats to their safety within  their area  There is no charge for receiving an Emergency  Alert message     Messages 141    There are three types of Emergency Alerts     Alerts issued by the President      Alerts involving imminent threats to safety of life    AMBER Alerts  missing child alert     Customers may choose not to receive Extreme Alerts  Severe  Alerts  and AMBER Alerts     Important  Alerts issued by the President can not be disabled     To disable Extreme  Severe  and AMBER Alerts   1  From the Home Screen  tap P   2  Press   and then tap Settings   3  Scroll to the bottom and select Emergency alerts  All  alerts are enabled by default  check mark showing    4  Tap on an alert option to disable the alert and remove  the check mark     142    Assigning Messages as Spam    You can now assign either a phone number as spam or use a  key term or phrase  Any message assigned as spam is  automatically placed with your Spam messages folder     To assign a phone number from Messages list as spam   1  From the Home screen  tap P   2  Touch and hold a message from a phone number   3  Select Add to spam numbers and tap OK   To assign a phone number manually as spam   1  From the Home screen  tap wu   2  Press   I and then tap Settings   3  Locate and activate the Spam settings option     Spam settings  when enabled  allows you to configure  available spam settings such as     4  Tap Add to spam numbers
130. Work Fax  Home Fax  Pager  Other   Custom  or Callback    7  Tap a phone number field and enter a phone number     Tap rJ on the QWERTY keyboard to remove a previously   entered phone number   e Tap   toenter an additional phone number  e Tap     to remove a previously entered phone number     110    Enter additional information such as  Groups  Ringtone   Message alert  Vibration pattern or tap Add another field  to input additional category information      Add another field contains the following options  Phonetic  name  Organization  Email  IM  Address  Notes  Nickname   Website  Internet call  Events  or Relationship      Use your finger to slide the page up or down to see additional  fields and categories    Tap Save to complete and store the new entry     or    Tap Cancel to delete the current entry     To save a Number from your Keypad            1   2     From the Home screen  tap  Phone    Enter a phone number using the on screen dialpad     3  Tap Add to Contacts  gt  Create contact or select the    Contact entry from the on screen list     or    Press   and then tap Add to Contacts  gt  Create  contact or select the Contact entry from the on screen  list        f you re updating an existing contact  tap the entry from the list  and proceed to step 5      Tap a destination type  Device  SIM  Samsung account   Google  or Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync   depending  on where you want to save the new contact  information       Tap the Name and enter a name for this cont
131. a security risk if not properly managed   You can clear these cookies from your device at any time   1  From an active Web page  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Privacy  gt  Delete personal data   2  Tap Cookies and site data to create a checkmark   3  Tap Done     264    Using Web History  The History list displays a list of the most recently viewed  websites  These entries can be used to return to previously  unmarked web pages  NN  1  From an active Web page  press       and then tap  History  m  2  Select a visited range category  Choose from  Today   Last 7 days  or Most visited   3  Tapan entry to display the webpage    or   Press   and then tap Clear history to delete the  current History list     Saved Pages  The Saved pages list provides you with a list of the websites  that you have saved  m  1  From an active Web page  press      and then tap   Saved pages   A list of your saved webpages is displayed with their  Name  The webpages that have been visited the most  will appear at the top     2  Tap any entry to display the webpage     Browser Settings  To configure browser settings     1     2   3     From the Home screen  tap Ea  Apps   gt    Internet     Press l   and then tap Settings    Choose an option from the following categories    Basics      Set home page  Sets the current home page for the Web  browser      Auto fill text  Allows you to set the text used for the Web form  auto fill feature    Privacy      Search and URL suggestions  displays prediction
132. a single motion touch and slide the Bluetooth slider  to the right to turn it on Sg    The slider color indicates the activation status  When  active  displays in the Status area     To turn Bluetooth off  E  1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings     2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Bluetooth slider  to the left to turn it off  fal     Note  Bluetooth must be enabled prior to use     Changing the Device Name __   1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  About device    2  Tap the Device name field and use the on screen  keyboard to edit the current device name    3  Tap E xj to erase the current device name and enter  a new name for this device using the keyboard    4  Tap OK to confirm your setting     Changing Your Settings 287    Activating Visibility m   1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Bluetooth    2  Verify your Bluetooth is active    3  From the top of the Bluetooth settings page  toggle the  state of the visibility check mark  Activating this feature  enabled your device visible allows other devices to pair  and communicate     288    Scanning for Devices  This option allows you to scan for active Bluetooth devices so  you can pair with them  uM   1  From the Home screen  press   1  and then tap  Settings Connections tab  gt  Bluetooth    2  From the bottom of the Bluetooth settings page  tap  Scan to search for visible external Bluetooth   compatible devices
133. able Wi Fi connection are displayed with a security  type displayed next to them     Changing Your Settings 281    Network Notification  By default  when Wi Fi is on  you receive notifications in the  Status bar anytime your phone detects an available Wi Fi  network  You can deactivate this feature if you do not want to  receive notifications   n  1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi   2  Press     i  and then tap Advanced   3  Tap Network notification  A check mark displayed next  to the feature indicates Network notification is active   4  Tap Network notification again to remove the check  mark and deactivate this feature     282    Passpoint  Wi Fi CERTIFIED Passpoint    allows users connect to Wi Fi  hotspot networks by simplifying the process of connecting to  the correct network  In addition  this connection type  provides WPA2    security protection for safe data  communication  Mobile devices  such as handsets and  tablets  that are certified for Passpoint can still be used in  existing hotspots  Users on passpoint enabled hotspots  will  also enjoy Wi Fi roaming  uM  1  From the Home screen  press   1  and then tap  Settings Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi   2  Press    and then tap Advanced   3  In a single motion touch and slide the Passpoint slider  to the right to turn it on   4  Tap the Passpoint field and begin the on screen  process of connecting to a compatible AP        Wi Fi During Sleep  By default  when 
134. aborate with other Polaris users        Applications and Development 245    S Health    S Health is a wellness application that allows you to better  manage your health by providing you with relevant    information    1  From the Home screen  tap EHI  Apps   gt       S Health     2  Read the introduction and tap Next    3  Read the Terms and conditions information  place a  checkmark in the Agree checkbox    4  Tap Next    5  Enter your personal information  then tap Start    6  Follow the on screen instructions to use S Health    7  Tap REI Help for more detailed information     246    S Memo    The S Memo application allows you to create memos using  the keypad  your finger  or both  You can add images  voice  recordings  and text all in one place     Creating a New Memo    1     From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   S  S Memo   The S Memo screen is displayed     2  Tapan existing Memo to open it then tap the screen to    enter edit mode     or    Tap  T  to start a new memo in text mode with the  keypad displayed or tap nm to start a new memo in  drawing mode using your finger or a compatible  on screen writing tool  You can change back and forth  in a memo to add text with the keypad and the pen     The icons that you see displayed on the screen are described  in the following table     Ed Allows you to add free format drawing    Displays the keypad to you can add text    KJ Eraser tool allows you to erase marks and drawings   M Undo the last action    E  Redo the last a
135. account lets you create a new account type  Choose  from Samsung account  Google  or Microsoft Exchange  ActiveSync     Note  When storing an entry into your micro SIM card  note  that only the Name  and Number are saved  To save  additional information for a particular contact  such as  notes  email  dates  etc   it is important to save that  Contact into your phone   s onboard memory     1  From the Home screen  tap B  Contacts    2  Tap m E to create a contact     Note  You can also add a new contact by entering a number    from the keypad and pressing  i  and then tap  Add to Contacts  gt  Create contact  Continue with step 3     3  Tap a destination type  Device  SIM  Samsung account   Google  or Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync   depending  on where you want to save the new contact  information      Contacts 109    4  Tapthe Name field and enter a name for this contact  using the displayed keypad   e Tap    to access additional name entries such as  Name  prefix  First name  Middle name  Last name  and Name suffix   5  Tapthe image icon and select a photo for this contact   Selections are  Image  Pictures by people  Take picture   or S Memo     Note  The label entries below can change and are dependant    on the selected destination type  ex  the Other and  Custom might not appear with an Exchange ActiveSync  account destination type      6  Tap the label button  to the left of the Phone field  and  scroll through the list to select a category such as  Mobile  Home  Work  
136. act using  the displayed keypad    e Tap  v  to access additional name entries such as  Name  prefix  First name  Middle name  Last name  and Name suffix      Tap the image icon and select a photo for this contact   Selections are  Image  Pictures by people  Take picture   or S Memo     Note  The label entries below can change and are dependant    on the selected destination type  ex  the Other and  Custom might not appear with an Exchange ActiveSync  account destination type        Tap the label button  to the left of the Phone field  and    scroll through the list to select a category such as  Mobile  Home  Work  Work Fax  Home Fax  Pager  Other   Custom  or Callback    Enter additional fields as desired       Tap Save to complete and store the new entry     Tap Cancel to delete the current entry     Note  For further details about how to enter characters  see     Text Input Methods  on page 98    Contacts 111    Finding a Contact  You can store phone numbers and their corresponding  names onto either your SIM card  your phone s built in  memory  or an external location  such as Google  Exchange   or T Mobile Backup   They are all physically separate but are  used as a single entity  called Contacts   Depending on the storage size of the particular SIM card  the  maximum number of phone numbers the card can store may  differ   1  From the Home screen  tap  Contacts    2  Swipe up or down until you see the contact displayed    or   Tap the Search field and begin entering the
137. adio  frequency energy from cell phone use  The COSMOS study  will follow approximately 300 000 adult cell phone users in  Europe for 20 to 30 years  Additional information about the  COSMOS study can be found at  http   www ukcosmos org index html           Risk of Brain Cancer from Exposure to Radio  Frequency Fields in Childhood and Adolescence   MOBI KIDS     MOBI KIDS is an international study investigating the  relationship between exposure to radio frequency energy  from communication technologies including cell phones and  brain cancer in young people  This is an international  multi center study involving 14 European and non European  countries  Additional information about MOBI KIDS can be  found at  http   www creal cat programes recerca en_projectes creal   view php ID 39    Surveillance  Epidemiology  and End Results  SEER    Program of the National Cancer Institute  The National Cancer Institute  NCI  actively follows cancer  statistics in the United States to detect any change in rates of  new cases for brain cancer  If cell phones play a role in risk  for brain cancer  rates should go up  because heavy cell  phone use has been common for quite some time in the U S   Between 1987 and 2005  the overall age adjusted incidence  of brain cancer did not increase  Additional information about  SEER can be found at  http   seer cancer gow         Health and Safety Information 357    Cell Phone Industry Actions  Although the existing scientific data do not justify FDA 
138. agnetic fields    in a vehicle with tinted windows    1  From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt    Navigation    2  Read the on screen disclaimer regarding the current    release status of the Navigation app and tap Accept     238    Enabling Location v   1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Location services    2  Tap Use GPS satellites to enable the GPS satellite    3  Tap Use wireless networks to allow apps to use data  from sources such as Wi Fi and mobile networks to  provide a better approximation of your current location    4  Tap My places to enable the storage of your favorite  locations     Navigation options  1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt   A  Navigation   The navigation application can be  configured from the main screen   2  If prompted  read the on screen disclaimer and tap  Accept   3  Choose from the following on screen options     Driving Walking Bicycling   tap to configure the  method of travel  Selection of Walking would negate the need  1o track traffic jams and obstructions     Speak destination  allows you to use the voice recognition  feature to search for matching locations in your area       Type destination  allows you to manually enter a destination  address  via the on screen keypad       Go home  allows you to return to a designated  Home   location       When prompted initially to setup a home address  enter the   location into the Enter an address field and tap Save      Map  enables the on sc
139. ail and Gmail Messages    Google Talk    Messenger     ChatON  The Short Message Service  SMS  lets you send and receive  text messages to and from other mobile phones or email    addresses  To use this feature  you may need to subscribe to  your service provider s message service    The Multimedia Messaging Service  MMS  lets you send and  receive multimedia messages  such as picture  video  and  audio messages  to and from other mobile phones or email  addresses  To use this feature  you may need to subscribe to  your service provider s multimedia message service     130    Important  During the creation of a text message  adding an    image  sound file  or video clip automatically  changes it from a text message  SMS  to a  multimedia message  MMS      Message Icons on the Status Bar    Messaging icons are displayed on the Status Bar at the top of  the display when new messages are received  For more  information  refer to  Status Bar  on page 32     Note  The Messaging application can also be accessed by  pressing C and then tapping EB  Apps   gt  9   Messaging      Creating and Sending Messages 4  Add more recipients by tapping either the Enter                1  Fromthe Home screen  tap b  Messaging   gt    A recipient field or and selecting recipients    Compose   5  Tap the Enter message field and use the on screen  2  Tap the Enter recipient field to manually enter a keypad to enter a message  For more information  refer  recipient  to    Text Input Methods    on page
140. all in  progress  if this service is supported by the network and you  have previously set the Call waiting option to Activate   You are notified of an incoming call by a call waiting tone  For  more information  refer to    Configuring Additional Voice Call  Settings    on page 315   To answer a new call while you have a call in progress        1  In a single motion  touch Or and slide it in any  direction to answer the new incoming call     92    2  Tap an option from the Accept call after menu     Putting xxx on hold to place the previous caller on hold while  you answer the new incoming call     Ending call with xxx to end the previous call and answer the  new call     Note  The new caller appears at the top of the list  The  previous caller is placed on hold and appears at the  bottom of the list     3  Tap Swap to switch between the two calls  This places  the new caller on hold and activates the previous call     Important  The currently active call is displayed with a green    background     4  Tap Swap again to switch back     Using S Voice  This is a voice recognition application used to activate a wide  variety of functions on your device  This is a natural language  recognition application   This goes beyond the Google Search Voice Actions feature  that simply recognizes Google commands and search terms   You can ask it questions  Is it raining in Dallas   or give it  commands  Show my where to find cheap gas    1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    S Voice  
141. ally resolved  by arbitration in Seoul  Korea in accordance with the  Arbitration Rules of the Korean Commercial Arbitration Board   The award of arbitration shall be final and binding upon the  parties     b  United States residents  ALL DISPUTES WITH SAMSUNG  ELECTRONICS CO  ARISING IN ANY WAY FROM THIS EULA OR  YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE SHALL BE RESOLVED  EXCLUSIVELY THROUGH FINAL AND BINDING ARBITRATION   AND NOT BY A COURT OR JURY  Any such dispute shall not  be combined or consolidated with any other person s or  entity s claim or dispute  and specifically  without limitation  of the foregoing  shall not under any circumstances proceed  as part of a class action  The arbitration shall be conducted  before a single arbitrator  whose award may not exceed  in  form or amount  the relief allowed by the applicable law  The    Warranty Information 389    arbitration shall be conducted according to the American  Arbitration Association  AAA  Commercial Arbitration Rules  applicable to consumer disputes  This arbitration provision is  entered pursuant to the Federal Arbitration Act  The laws of  the State of Texas  without reference to its choice of laws  principles  shall govern the interpretation of the EULA and all  disputes that are subject to this arbitration provision  The  arbitrator shall decide all issues of interpretation and  application of this arbitration provision and the EULA  For  any arbitration in which your total damage claims  exclusive  of attorney fees and 
142. an active Internet connection     Accessing Dropbox on your Device    1     From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   2   Dropbox  Start    Tap I   m already a Dropbox user  enter your current  account credentials  and tap Log in     or    Tap I m new to Dropbox and follow the on screen  instructions to register for a new account     3  Follow the on screen instructions     4     Initially  you will need to configure your Camera Upload  parameters  Choose from Wi Fi only or Wi Fi or data  plan      Tap Turn on after making your selection     Caution  Enabling this feature can incur data charges     depending on your plan  if the Wi FI or data plan is  selected     Tap 3  Access Dropbox  at the top of the application  window to access the files and folders you area  currently sharing from your computer   Tap an item to open it   Tap the bottom of the image to reveal additional  options     Delete to erase the current file     Share via applications such as  Copy link  Bluetooth  ChatON   Email  Flipboard  Gmail  Google  Google   Messaging   S Memo  or Wi Fi Direct     Add to Favorite to assign a favorite tag to the current image     Applications and Development 225      More to choose from options such as        Open with    to open the current file with the default in device  application        Export to transfer the current file to another location via   Save to SD card  Bluetooth  ChatON  Email  Flipboard  Gmail   Google    Group Play  Messaging  Picasa  S Memo  or Wi Fi   Dir
143. an object is to the   surface of the screen  This is typically used to detect   when your face is pressed up against the screen  such   as during a phone call    While talking on the phone  the sensor detects talk activity and  locks the keypad to prevent accidental key presses    Receiver allows you to hear the other caller and the   different ring tones or sounds offered by your device     Back View    The following illustration shows the external elements of your  Device     1     microSD Card Slot  internal  allows you use a microSD  card to expand the memory of your device    External speaker allows you to hear ringers  music  and  other sounds offered by your phone     micro SIM Card Slot  internal  Installation location for  SIM card     Gaw  MQN    dr     Flash is used to take photos in low light conditions   Headset jack allows you to connect a hands free  headset so you can listen to music    Camera lens is used to take photos    IR Transmitter used to emit infrared signals used for  controlling external devices  For more information   refer to  Using WatchON  on page 189     Side Views  The following illustration shows the side elements of your  device    ED       4    1  Volume key allows you to adjust the ringer volume in  standby mode  with the phone open  or adjust the voice  volume during a call  When receiving an incoming call     Pressing the volume key down mutes the ring tone    2  Power End key             ends a call or switches the  phone off and on  Pr
144. and follow the activation  procedures for Wi Fi Direct     To configure your Share Shot options     1     3     4     Confirm the Share Shot viewfinder is active Or    appears at the top of the screen     Tap  lt   Devices for sharing with  to display list of   current share shot participants      Stop sharing images with select participants by tapping their  entry and removing the green check mark    Tap   a  Shooting modes  to regain access to the   Share menu    Tap   a Off to disable share shot while   maintaining a Wi Fi Direct connection     To take share shot images     1   2     Tap E  Camera  until the shutter sounds    From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt  Kk    Gallery  to locate your newly shot images located in   their default storage location      External users will be able to locate their images in either a  downloaded or RECV  received  folder    Confirm  Share shot images delivered received    appears in the Notifications area of the screen     Using S Beam to Share Pictures    This feature  when activated via NFC  allows you to beam  large files directly to another compatible device that is in  direct contact  These files can be larger  such as Videos  HD  pictures  and other large files  You can beam images and  videos from your gallery  music files from your music player   and more     1     From the Home screen  press S and then tap  Settings  gt  SA  Connections tab     If not already active  in a single motion touch and slide  the NFC slider to the 
145. and tap Sign up     Note  You may be prompted to confirm your credentials via    email     8  If prompted  follow the on screen instructions to verify  your account via the provided email address     Note  Without confirming your email address and following the    documented procedures  related applications will not  function properly since it is Samsung account that is  managing their username and password access     22    Voice Mail  Setting Up Your Voice Mail    Your device automatically transfers all unanswered calls to  voicemail  even if your device is in use or turned off  As soon  as your battery is charged and the micro SIM card inserted   activate your voicemail account     Important  Always use a password to protect against  unauthorized access     For new users  follow the instructions below to set up voice  mail     Note  Voicemail setup may be different depending on your  network     1  From the Home screen  tap and then touch and  hold the   4 a key until the device dials voicemail     You may be prompted to enter a password     2  Follow the tutorial to create a password  a greeting   and a display name     Accessing Your Voice Mail    You can access your Voice Mail by either pressing and  holding 1  onthe keypad  or by using the phone s  Application icon  then tapping the Voice Mail application  To  access Voice Mail using the menu       1  From the Home screen  tap I   and then touch and  hold   1 s     until the device dials voicemail     Note  Touching and
146. angerous and void the mobile device  warranty if said accessories cause damage or a defect to the  mobile device     Although your mobile device is quite sturdy  it is a complex  piece of equipment and can be broken  Avoid dropping   hitting  bending  or sitting on it    Other Important Safety Information     Only qualified personnel should service the mobile device or  install the mobile device in a vehicle  Faulty installation or service  may be dangerous and may invalidate any warranty applicable to  the device      Ensure that any mobile devices or related equipment installed in  your vehicle are securely mounted      Check regularly that all wireless mobile device equipment in your  vehicle is mounted and operating properly      When using a headset in dry environments  static electricity can  build up in the headset and cause a small quick static electrical  shock  To minimize the risk of electrostatic discharge from the  headset avoid using the headset in extremely dry environments or  touch a grounded unpainted metal object to discharge static  electricity before inserting the headset      Do not store or carry flammable liquids  gases  or explosive  materials in the same compartment as the mobile device  its  parts  or accessories     Health and Safety Information 377      For vehicles equipped with an air bag  remember that an air bag  inflates with great force  Do not place objects  including installed  or portable wireless equipment near or in the area over the ai
147. ap Done     66    Note  Shared applications consist of those that have  previously been downloaded from the Play Store     4  Select a sharing method  Choose from  Bluetooth   ChatON  Dropbox  Email  Flipboard  Gmail  Google   Google   Messaging  S Memo  and Wi Fi Direct    5  The recipient will be notified about the receipt of the  new information     Managing Shortcuts    Note  To move a shortcut from one screen to another  you  must carefully touch and hold the shortcut and slowly  drag it to the edge of the screen  As the shortcut turns  light blue  you can begin to move it to the adjacent  screen If this does not work  delete it from its current  Screen  Activate the new screen and then add the  selected shortcut     To add a shortcut from the Applications screen    1  From the Home screen  select a screen location for  your new shortcut by scrolling across your available  screens until you reach the desired one    2  Tap Apps     to reveal all your current available  applications  By default  applications are displayed as  an Alphabetical grid    3  Scroll across the screens and locate your desired  application    4  Touch and hold the on screen icon  The new shortcut  then appears to hover over the current screen    5  While still holding the on screen icon  position it on the  current screen  Once complete  release the screen to  lock the shortcut into its new position    To add a shortcut via the Add to Home screen    1  From the Home screen  navigate to a screen wit
148. ap the Negative colors field to reverse the display of  on screen colors from White text on a Black  background to Black text on a White background    13  Select Color adjustment to allow you to adjust the  display colors if you are color blind and have difficulty  reading the display because of the colors  Touch and  Slide the slider to the right to turn it on  Follow the  on screen instructions     5  Select the Speak passwords field to activate this  feature which reads out password information   6  Select Answering ending calls field to select the       8  Tap Manage accessibility to save and update your  accessibility settings or share them with another  device  You can export your settings  import a  previously saved file  or share your file with another  device    9  Tap TalkBack to activate the feature     Note  TalkBack  when installed and enabled  speaks feedback  to help blind and low vision users     Changing Your Settings 323    14  Tap Accessibility shortcut to allow you to quickly enable  accessibility features in 2 quick steps  Touch and slide  the slider to the right to turn it on  Follow the on screen  instructions    15  Tap the Text to speech options field to configure the  text to speech configuration parameters    16  Tap the Enhance web accessibility field to allow apps to  install scripts from Google that make their Web content  more accessible    17  Use the Sound balance field to allow you to use the  slider to set the Left and Right balance when usi
149. ap the contact s   you want to add  A check mark displays next to contact  entry  Then tap Done     or    Tap Select all to place a check mark alongside all  current entries  Then tap Done     Tap Save to store the newly created group     Note  Some externally maintained group types  such as    Google  can only be managed or updated remotely  online vs via the device  These external types will not  allow editing or deleting members locally via the phone     Adding an Existing Entry to a Current Caller    Group  1   2   3     From the Home screen  tap AB  gt  ES  Tap a group entry  gt  a E  Add group member      From the available list of contacts  tap the contact s   you want to add  A check mark displays next to contact  entry   Tap Done  The selected contacts are added to the  group    Contacts     127    Removing an Entry From a Caller Group    Pon      5     From the Home screen  tap  gt  E3    Tap a group entry    Press     and then tap Remove member    Tap all of the contacts you want to remove from this  group  A check mark displays next to contact entry   Tap Done The contacts are removed from the group     Editing a Caller Group  To edit a Group entry  there must be at least one member as    part of the selected group   1  From the Home screen  tap EB  gt  ES    2  Touch and hold a group entry then select Edit group     128    Make modifications to the Group name  Group ringtone   Message alert  Vibration pattern fields  or Add member   Tap Save     Deleting a Caller
150. applications such as  Play Books    and Play  Magazines        Assisted GPS  Google Navigation       Webkit based browser     Expandable memory slot   supports up to 64GB microSD      Mobile HotSpot and USB Tethering capability      T Mobile   TV     Video Chat via Google Talk     Google Play    Music   e Wi Fi    Calling via the use of a micro SIM card     HD Video Player 1080p      Codec  MPEG4  H 264  H 263  VC 1  WMV7 8  VP8  MP43      Format  3GP  MP4   WMV  ASF   AVI  and DivX    28      Video Player support for PIP  Picture in Picture  viewing     DivX Certified  to play DivX video up to HD 720p  including  premium content  Front View  The following illustrations show the main elements of your  device  The following list correlates to the illustrations    1  Indicator light illuminates with a series of distinct  colors and flashing patterns to indicate different  notifications and statuses  Events include Charging   Low battery  and Missed event      Powering on   blue blinks animates     Battery Charging   red remains on     Battery Fully Charged   green remains on    e Low Battery or Charging Error  red blinks animates     Missed Notification  Call or Messaging    blue blinks animates  For more information  refer to    LED Indicator    on page  306     2  Light  RGB  Sensor lets you use the ambient light level  to adjust the screen brightness contrast  This sensor  decreases screen brightness in dim light    e  n a bright light condition  outdoors   the sensors cause
151. ar next to the account type once  you have created an account  Your email account will  also be displayed in the Accounts section of the main  Settings menu     Removing an Account    Important  Removing an account also deletes all of its    messages  contacts  and other data from the  device     From the Home screen  press    1  and then tap  Settings  gt  Accounts tab  in   Navigate to the My accounts area and then tap the  account name    From the Accounts area of the screen  tap the account  entry    Tap Remove account  then tap Remove account at the  prompt to remove the account and delete all its  messages  contacts  and other data     Synchronizing a Accounts    By default  all managed accounts are synchronized  You can  also manually sync all current accounts     1     From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  Accounts tab        Navigate to the My accounts area and then tap the  account name    Tap the account name entry    Tap Sync now to synchronize your account or tap Sync  all to synchronize all your accounts  Tap Cancel sync to  stop the synchronization     Tap Settings to access your account settings     Changing Your Settings 337    Cloud    This feature allows you to use your external cloud storage  solution to both synchronize your device to your Samsung  account and then backup that local content to the cloud   Your device comes with a built in Cloud storage solution  known as Dropbox     Important  This feature requires an active Wi Fi con
152. arm  How many times will the snooze silence  the alarm    Move the Smart alarm slider to the right to activate this   feature which slowly increases screen brightness and   the volume of nature tones to simulate dawn breaking    Tap the field to assign a interval time  1 minute    3 minutes  5 minutes  10 minutes  15 minutes  or   30 minutes  and nature tone  Fairy fountain  Birdsong   by the lake  Sparkling mist  The secret forest  Serenity    or Gentle spring rain       Interval category describes the length of time the alarm will  remain silent between alarm notifications  snooze time       Tone category provides one of several nature sounds that are  used as the alarm tone    Tap the Name field and enter a name for this Alarm    Tap Save to store the new alarm event     Applications and Development 221    Turning Off an Alarm    To stop an alarm when it sounds  touch and slide  to any direction     Setting the Snooze Feature    To activate the Snooze feature after an alarm sounds   touch and slide to any direction  Snooze must  first be set in the alarm settings     Deleting an Existing Alarm    le    2   3     From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt     AN    EA    C9  Clock    Touch and hold an on screen alarm event   Tap Delete     World Clock    This feature allows you to find out what time it is another part  of world     1     From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt      SO  Clock    Tap the World clock tab     3  Tap Add city then scroll and select the desired city  o
153. ase an entire word    4  Tap     A    Send  to deliver the message                    Entering Text     101    All lowercase      Displays when the next character is entered in    lowercase  Pressing this while in 123SYM mode   reveals additional numeric symbols keys     Initial Uppercase  Displays when the first character of each word is    entered as uppercase but all subsequent  characters are lowercase       All Uppercase  m Displays when all characters will be entered as    uppercase characters     By default  the first letter of an entry is capitalized and the  following letters are lower case  After a word is entered and  you lift your finger  the cursor automatically adds a space  after the word     Note  If multiple word choices exist for your Swype entry  an    on screen popup appears to provide additional word  choices     102    Entering Numbers and Symbols in SWYPE    By using the on screen keyboard in portrait mode  some  symbols are not available  such as Emoticons or Smileys    In SYM mode using Swype  you can only enter symbols and  numbers from the on screen keyboard   Once in SYM mode  the text mode key shows m   1  From a screen where you can enter text  tap the text  input field to reveal the on screen keyboard   2  Tap cs to configure the keyboard for SYM mode   Once in this mode  the text input type shows m   3  Tap the on screen key for the number or symbol you  want to enter   4  Tap to select from additional symbols     For example       To enter    
154. assword information       Email address  your Outlook work email address     Password  typically your network access password   case sensitive    3  Tap Show password to display the password as you  enter it in the associated field   4  Tap Send email from this account by default  to make  this your default email account for outbound emails     150    Note  If selected  the Manual setup button changes to read    Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync  If activated  skip to  Step 6     5  Tap Next  Consult your Network or IT Administrator for  further details and support    6  Tap Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync  from the add new  email account screen      Note  If prompted with an on screen notification that the  connection that the    Setup could not finish     tap  Edit details to continue with a manual update of  necessary information     7  When prompted to provide additional detailed  information within the Exchange server settings  screen  enter an updated Domain  and confirm your  user name and Password information     Important  Remember to manually place the cursor in the  correct spot and enter a Domain name before the      Domain   user name   entry  Most servers only  provide a username     8  Update or re enter your Exchange server information  within the appropriate field  This field can often be  populated with incorrect or out of date information  provided by your server      Exchange Server  your exchange server remote email  address  Typically starts with mail XXX com 
155. ation  refer to    Accessing Additional Screen  Functions    on page 39     Displays your current signal strength  The greater  the number of bars  the stronger the signal     Indicates that the Airplane Mode is active  You  5 f cannot send or receive any calls or access online  information     E SusmEIED    Indicates there is no signal available     Displays when there is no SIM card in the phone     Displays when there is a system error or alert     Displays to indicate a security warning  You are  prompted to set a screen lock password     Displays when a call is in progress  Icon is  displayed in the Status bar area     Displays when a call is on hold  Icon is displayed in  the Status bar area     Displays when an active call is routed through a  Bluetooth headset  Icon is displayed in the Status  bar area     Displays when you have missed an incoming call     p    o    O  bal      Displays when you device is set to automatically  reject all incoming calls  The All numbers option   is enabled from within Call settings  gt  Call rejection   gt  Auto reject mode menu     Displays when the speakerphone is on  Icon is  displayed in the Status bar area     Displays when the microphone is muted  Icon is  displayed in the Status bar area     Displays when Call forwarding is set to Always  forward  Displayed in the Status bar when the  current call is minimized  For more information   referto    Configuring Additional Voice Call Settings  on page 315          Displays your curren
156. ation about no  Wi Fi detected  tap Cancel  to continue by using your  network connection  or Connect to continue    4  Tap Sign in    5  If prompted to log into your Samsung account  tap Sign  in and follow the on screen instructions      Apps   gt     Note  If the main screen still shows a Sign in box  close the    application and restart it     6  Follow the on screen prompts     Multimedia 205    7  Scroll across the application screen to view either   MY RECENT CONTENT or DEVICES  amp  STORAGE    The DEVICES  amp  STORAGE screen contains two separate  streaming media options      Registered storage  allows you to receive and playback media  Stored externally  server  laptop  etc   directly on your device by  allowing you to add a Web storage service for streaming  content      Registered devices allows you to stream share selected  multimedia content from your device to DLNA compliant device  connected to the same Wireless Access Point    Configuring Samsung Link Settings  The Samsung Link   application must first be configured  prior to its initial use  You must setup parameters such as  connected Wi Fi  Items to share  source server address  and  external device acceptance rights   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps  2       Samsung Link   gt  DEVICES  amp  STORAGE    2  Press E and then tap Settings and configure the  following settings as desired     206      Registered storage  allows you to add a Web storage location   Without a storage service location added  you 
157. ation messages   Scribbles   audio  Contacts  Calendar entries  and Location  information  Create special animated messages for your  friends using handwritten messages  text  photos   background images and music   1  From the Home screen  tap       Chaon     2  Log in to the service and follow the on screen  instructions      Apps   gt     For more information  visit  htips   web samsungchaton com   For more information  refer to    ChatON    on page 158        Applications and Development 219    Chrome    The Google Chrome app allows you to use the Google  Chrome Web browser on your device     1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    Chrome    2  Readthe Google Chrome Terms of Service and tap  Accept and Continue     3  If you have an existing Chrome account  tap Sign in to  bring your open tabs  bookmarks  and omnibox data  from your computer to your phone  otherwise tap No  thanks    4  Follow the on screen instructions to use Google  Chrome     220    Clock  Here you can set an Alarm  configure and view the World  clock  use a Stopwatch  set a Timer  or use a Desk Clock   The applications display in a tabular format and quickly  accessed with the touch of a finger     m From the Home screen  tap dH  Apps   gt    C9  Clock    Setting an Alarm   1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt   ey   Clock     2  From the Alarm tab  tap  Create alarm     Use the arrow symbols to enter adjust the hour  and  minutes  then tap AM or PM  toggles depending on  which was last select
158. automatic preview of the          current character selection within  when multiple characters are avail       Key tap vibration enables vibrati  on screen key        he text string  This is helpful  able within one key   ion feedback when you tap an              Key tap sound enables auditory feedback when you tap an  On screen Key     Help launches a brief on screen help tutorial covering the main  concepts related to the Samsung keyboard     Reset settings resets the keyboard settings back to their  original configuration     Predictive Text   Advanced Settings    The predictive text system provides next letter prediction and  regional error correction  which compensates for users  pressing the wrong keys on QWERTY keyboards     Note  Only available when ABC mode is selected  Predictive    text advanced settings are available only if the Predictive  function is enabled     1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt   pnt  adjacent to the Samsung keyboard field     or   From within an active text entry screen  touch and hold   Input Methods   gt  Fey to reveal the Samsung  keyboard settings screen     In a single motion touch and slide the Predict  slider to the right to turn it on     ive text    Tap the Predictive text field and configure any of the    following advanced options       Personalized data activate this feature to use the personal    language data that you have entered and selected  your text entry p
159. b page   Move  fingers inward to zoom out       Spread   Spread  the screen using your thumb and forefinger to  zoom in when viewing a picture or a Web page   Move fingers  outward to zoom in      54    Note  These screens can be re arranged in any desired order   For more information  refer to  Customizing the  Screens  on page 65       Motion Navigation and Activation  The device comes equipped  with the ability to assign specific functions to certain device  actions that are detected by both the accelerometer and  gyroscope     Note  Motion must be enabled for this feature to be active  For  more information  refer to  Motions and Gestures  Settings  on page 331     Accessing Recently Used Apps   1  Press and hold from any screen to open the  recently used applications window    2  Tapan icon to open the selected application    or   Tap g to go to the Task manager    or   Tap to go to Google Search     Tap E  to delete the record of all recently used  applications   Using Motions and Gestures    By activating the various motion and gesture features within  this menu  page 331   you can access a variety of time  saving functions     Caution  Excessive shaking or impact to the device may cause    unintended results  To learn how to properly control  motions  tap ER  Apps   gt  Settings  gt  My device tab   gt  Motions and gestures  When tapped  each entry  comes with an on screen tutorial     m From the Home screen  press  ren and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt 
160. before the screen  automatically turns off  Selections are  15 seconds    30 seconds  1 minute  2 minutes  5 minutes  and  10 minutes          Daydream  allows you to control what your screen does when  your device is docked or sleeping  Tap the adjacent OFF   ON  icon to turn it on  Follow the on screen instructions      Font style  sets the fonts used on the LCD display  Selections  are  Default font  Choco cooky  Cool jazz  Rosemary   Samsung Sans or Get fonts online  Tap Get fonts online to  download additional fonts          Font size  allows you to select which size of font is displayed       Touch key light duration  allows you to adjust the delay before   he Touch key light automatically turns off    Display battery percentage  to activate deactivate the display   of battery charge percentage atop the battery icon at the top of   he screen    Edit after screen capture  allows you to go edit a screen   immediately after taking a screen capture    Auto adjust screen tone  adjusts the phone s LCD brightness   level to automatically adjust and conserve battery power      High touch sensitivity  allows you to adjust the touch  sensitivity of your phone automatically depending on the type of  material on the display        Changing Your Settings 305    Adjusting Screen Brightness  This feature configures the LCD Brightness levels   1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Display Brightness   2  Tap Automatic brightness to allow t
161. bers  allows you to tag a number as spam  so that these messages can be directly delivered to your spam  folder      Discard  closes the current open message     Note  You must be logged into your Samsung account prior to    using the S Translator feature     134      Translate  launches a Translate popup menu  Here you can  both assign the sender s original language and assign a target  language for the recipient  they will receive your message in the  designated language         Enable the translate feature then configure the available options  as desired  Tap OK to store the new settings   Adding attachments to a message   To add an attachment to your message  tap e  Attach    and select one of the following options       mages  allows you to tap an existing image from your Pictures  list to add it to your message      Take a picture  allows you to temporarily exit the message  take  a photo with phone s camera  and then add it to your message by  tapping Save      Video  allows you to choose an existing video from the Videos list   then add it to your message      Record video  allows you to temporarily exit the message   record a video clip using the phone s camera  and then add it  to your message by tapping Save       Audio  allows you to choose an existing audio file from the  Audio list  then add it to your message by tapping the circle to    the right of the audio so that it turns green  then tapping Done       Record audio  allows you to temporarily exit the messag
162. billing information   service plans  downloads  and other information     Note  Wi Fi connection must be disabled prior to use  this  application requires use of a T Mobile network  connection     1  From the Home screen  tap BE  Apps   gt         T Mobile My Account     2  If prompted  follow the on screen information for  what s new in the app     Note  Some features may require you to log into your account     3  The application screen provides several available  options     Account Info provides access to account specific features  such as  Notifications     Device Support provides details about your current billing  summary     Applications and Development 253      Notifications provides about both your current plan  other  available plans and other related services      MobileLife FamilyWhere provides links to other T Mobile  related information     T Mobile Name ID    Allows you to modify the on screen Caller ID information     Name ID identifies unknown callers by Name  City  and State     1  From the Home screen  tap  e  T Mobile Name ID    2  Choose an on screen option     T Mobile TV    T Mobile TV is an application that allows you to get live TV  and Video on Demand     m From the Home screen  tap dH  Apps   gt   Ii   T Mobile TV      For more information  refer to    T Mobile TV  on page 214      Apps   gt     254    Talk    You can instant message with Google Talk  Google Talk  allows you to communicate with other people who are also  connected with Google Talk 
163. bject to changes implemented in accordance with the  Department of Defense policy and the 2008 Federal Radio  navigation Plan  FRP   Changes may affect the performance  of location based technology on your mobile device    Certain Samsung mobile devices can also use an Assisted  Global Positioning System  AGPS   which obtains information  from the cellular network to improve GPS performance  AGPS  uses your wireless service provider s network and therefore    368    airtime  data charges  and or additional charges may apply in  accordance with your service plan  Contact your wireless  service provider for details    Your Location  Location based information includes information that can be  used to determine the approximate location of a mobile  device  Mobile devices which are connected to a wireless  network transmit location based information  Additionally  if  you use applications that require location based information   e g  driving directions   such applications transmit  location based information  The location based information  may be shared with third parties  including your wireless  service provider  applications providers  Samsung  and other  third parties providing services    Use of AGPS in Emergency Calls  When you make an emergency call  the cellular network may  activate AGPS technology in your mobile device to tell the  emergency responders your approximate location   AGPS has limitations and might not work in your area   Therefore     Always tell the emer
164. ble  contact  the manufacturer of the battery or charger      Misuse or use of incompatible phones  batteries  and  charging devices could result in damage to the equipment  and a possible risk of fire  explosion  or leakage  leading to  serious injuries  damages to your phone  or other serious  hazard    Samsung Mobile Products and  Recycling  Samsung cares for the environment and encourages its    customers to recycle Samsung mobile devices and genuine  Samsung accessories     Proper disposal of your mobile device and its battery is not  only important for safety  it benefits the environment   Batteries must be recycled or disposed of properly     Health and Safety Information 365    Recycling programs for your mobile device  batteries  and  accessories may not be available in your area   We ve made it easy for you to recycle your old Samsung  mobile device by working with respected take back  companies in every state in the country   Drop It Off  You can drop off your Samsung branded mobile device  and batteries for recycling at one of our numerous  Samsung Recycling Direct  SM  locations  A list of these  locations may be found at   http   pages samsung com us recyclingdirect        usactivities environment samsungrecyclingdirect locations jsp       Samsung branded devices and batteries will be accepted    at these locations for no fee    Consumers may also recycle their used mobile device or  batteries at many retail or carrier provided locations  where mobile devices an
165. cations  repeated calendar appointments  search queries   etc    This information is then used to display more relevant  information to the user in the form of    cards     These  scrollable on screen cards are displayed when the Google  Now application is launched   These cards are not manually added   The service uses your GPS  Google Search  and usage  information to generate these cards automatically   To initially set up Google Now    1  Press and hold    Home  and then tap   Google Now     2  Follow the on screen instructions to review the  available information    3  When prompted  agree to launch the application  Some  initial on screen  cards  are shown  A default is the  Weather card that provides updated weather  information in your area     26    To configure the Google Now settings   1  Press and hold   and then tap  Google Now    2  Press ml and select Settings   3  Access each desired Settings page and configure it as  desired     When these condition are met  new card information will  begin to appear in the Google Now list of cards     Section 2  Understanding Your Device    This section outlines key features of your device  It also   describes the device s keys  screen and the icons that   display when the device is in use    Features of Your Device   Your device is lightweight  easy to use and offers many   significant features  The following list outlines a few of the   features included in your device      Touch screen with virtual  on screen  QWERTY keyb
166. ce RF energy absorption from cell phones     Headsets can substantially reduce exposure because the  phone is held away from the head in the user s hand or in  approved body worn accessories  Cell phones marketed in  the U S  are required to meet RF exposure compliance  requirements when used against the head and against the  body     Because there are no known risks from exposure to RF  emissions from cell phones  there is no reason to believe that  hands free kits reduce risks  Hands free kits can be used for  convenience and comfort  They are also required by law in  many states if you want to use your phone while driving   Cell Phone Accessories that Claim to Shield the Head  from RF Radiation  Because there are no known risks from exposure to RF  emissions from cell phones  there is no reason to believe that  accessories which claim to shield the head from those  emissions reduce risks  Some products that claim to shield  the user from RF absorption use special phone cases  while  others involve nothing more than a metallic accessory  attached to the phone   Studies have shown that these products generally do not  work as advertised  Unlike  hands free  kits  these so called   shields  may interfere with proper operation of the phone   The phone may be forced to boost its power to compensate   leading to an increase in RF absorption     Children and Cell Phones    The scientific evidence does not show a danger to any users  of cell phones from RF exposure  including chil
167. ce licenses  To obtain the source code covered  under the open source licenses  please visit   http   opensource samsung com     Disclaimer of Warranties  Exclusion of Liability    EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN THE EXPRESS WARRANTY CONTAINED ON THE WARRANTY PAGE ENCLOSED WITH THE PRODUCT  THE  PURCHASER TAKES THE PRODUCT  AS IS   AND SAMSUNG MAKES NO EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  WHATSOEVER WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCT  INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE MERCHANTABILITY OF THE PRODUCT OR  ITS FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR USE  THE DESIGN  CONDITION OR QUALITY OF THE PRODUCT  THE  PERFORMANCE OF THE PRODUCT  THE WORKMANSHIP OF THE PRODUCT OR THE COMPONENTS CONTAINED THEREIN  OR  COMPLIANCE OF THE PRODUCT WITH THE REQUIREMENTS OF ANY LAW  RULE  SPECIFICATION OR CONTRACT PERTAINING    M919_UM_English_MDD_041713_F4          THERETO  NOTHING CONTAINED IN THE INSTRUCTION MANUAL SHALL BE CONSTRUED TO CREATE AN EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTY OF ANY KIND WHATSOEVER WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCT  IN ADDITION  SAMSUNG SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR  ANY DAMAGES OF ANY KIND RESULTING FROM THE PURCHASE OR USE OF THE PRODUCT OR ARISING FROM THE BREACH OF  THE EXPRESS WARRANTY  INCLUDING INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  OR LOSS OF ANTICIPATED PROFITS  OR BENEFITS     Modification of Software    SAMSUNG IS NOT LIABLE FOR PERFORMANCE ISSUES OR INCOMPATIBILITIES CAUSED BY YOUR EDITING OF REGISTRY SETTINGS   OR YOUR MODIFICATION OF OPERATING SYSTEM SOFTWARE     USING CUSTOM OPERATING
168. ces     servers     5  Tap an available on screen file  image  or video to  place a green check mark alongside it    6  Tap  Stream to connected devices  and select an  available target device to begin streaming     7  Onatarget device  ex  Internet TV  select the  on screen Allow button to continue     Note  At this stage your device is requesting access to share    media with the external source     8  Confirm  Samsung Link Controller enabled   appears in the Notification area at the top of the device  to indicate you are using your device as the media  source     Multimedia 209    AllShare Cast Hub    This hardware allows you to enjoy what s currently on your  device directly on your TV     Note  There is no need to be connected to a Wi Fi network or    to be logged into your Samsung Account to use this  feature     AllShare Cast Hub establishes a WI Fi Direct connection  between the device and the hub     For more information about this device  go to     http   www samsung com us mobile cell phones accessories EAD   T10JDEGSTA    http   www samsung com us mobile cell phones accessories EAD   T10JDEGSTA          210    Connecting AllShare Cast Hub  To connect your AllShare Cast Hub hardware     Screen Mirroring This feature functions with an   with Hub external AllShareCast Hub to fully  accessory  mirror what is currently displayed on    your device to the external TV     1  Connectthe AllShare Cast Hub to a power source via  the USB Travel Adapter     Note  The status LE
169. cess the files directory from the  memory card by using the device as a memory card reader     Note  The file directory of the memory card displays as a  removable disk  separate from the internal memory     1  Connect the USB cable to the device and connect the  cable to the computer  After a few seconds  a pop up  window displays on the PC when connected    2  Open the folder to view files    3  Copy files from the PC to the memory card     Wi Fi  About Wi Fi    Wi Fi  short for  wireless fidelity   is a term used for certain  types of Wireless Local Area Networks  WLAN   Wi Fi  communication requires access to an existing and accessible  Wireless Access Point  WAP   These WAPs can either be  Open  unsecured  as within most Hot Spots  or Secured   requiring knowledge of the Router name and password      Note  After you complete a connection to an active Wi Fi  network  the Wi Fi Calling feature will automatically be  enabled     Note  For additional information on WPS Connections  refer to     WPS Push Button  on page 285 and  WPS PIN Entry   on page 285     Activating Wi Fi  By default  your device s Wi Fi feature is turned off   deactivated   Activating Wi Fi allows your device to discover  and connect to compatible in range WAPs  Wireless Access  Points   mE   1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  MMM  Connections tab     2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Wi Fi slider to the  right to turn it on  The device scans for available  in range wire
170. ch as   Time  amp  Date  Notification icons  Missed calls  etc      332      Air jump  Once enabled  you can move your hand over the air  gesture sensor  up or down  and easily jump to either the top or  bottom of a lengthy display page  ex  Internet or Email       Air browse  Once enabled  you can move your hand over the air  gesture sensor  left or right  and easily move to either the  previous or next item in a series  ex  music tracks  pictures  or  pages       Air move  Once enabled  you can move use one finger to hold  down on an app shortcut or event entry and then swipe across the  air gestures sensor to then move it to a new a different page      Air call accept  Once enabled  you can simply wave your hand  over the air gesture sensor to accept any incoming call     To activate Motion  LI  1  From the Home screen  press    1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures   2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Motion slider to  the right to turn it on   3  Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At least one feature must be activated before Motion can    be activated     4  Inasingle motion  slide a feature s activation slider to  the on position   REN     The following is a description some of the most commonly   used gestures      Direct call  Once enabled  the device will dial the currently  displayed on screen Contact entry as soon as you place the  device to your ear      Smart alert  Once enabled  pickup the device to be ale
171. communications America  LLC  Samsung is a registered trademark of Samsung Electronics Co   Ltd    Do you have questions about your Samsung Mobile Device    For 24 hour information and assistance  we offer a new FAQ ARS System  Automated Response System  at   www samsung com us support   Nuance    VSuite     T9   Text Input  and the Nuance logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Nuance Communications   Inc   or its affiliates in the United States and or other countries    ACCESS   and NetFront    are trademarks or registered trademarks of ACCESS Co   Ltd  in Japan and other countries    The Bluetooth   word mark  figure mark  stylized    B Design      and combination mark  Bluetooth word mark and    B Design     are  registered trademarks and are wholly owned by the Bluetooth SIG     microSD    and the microSD logo are Trademarks of the SD Card Association   e       Openwave    is a registered Trademark of Openwave  Inc    Google  the Google logo  Android  the Android logo  Google Play  Gmail  Google Mail  Google Maps  Google Music  Google Talk   Picasa  YouTube and other marks are trademarks of Google Inc    Wi Fi is a registered trademark of the Wireless Fidelity Alliance  Inc    LTE is a trademark of ETSI   Swype and the Swype logos are trademarks of Swype  Inc     2010 Swype  Inc  All rights reserved    DIVX  DivX    DivX Certified  and associated logos are trademarks of Rovi Corporation or its subsidiaries and are used under  license     DivX Certified  to play Di
172. computer  The Mobile HotSpot connectivity is a  wireless version of this same functionality and allows you to  provide Internet connectivity to multiple devices     Note  You can not mount your device s microSD card to your    computer while using the USB tethering feature    If additional software or USB drivers are required   navigate to  http   www samsung com us support   downloads        276    To connect using USB Tethering     1     From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt       gt   Mobile HotSpot     S   From the Home screen  press        and then tap  Settings  gt  MICI  Connections tab   gt  More    networks  Tethering and Mobile HotSpot     Plug in the USB cable between your computer and your  device    Tap USB tethering from the Tethering menu  This places  a green check mark next to the entry and activates the  feature  A Tethering or HotSpot active notification  briefly appears on the screen    Look for the Tethering active icon A in the Status  bar area of the screen    Read the on screen notification regarding data use and  tap OK     To disconnect tethering   1  From the Home screen  tap     Mobile HotSpot    2  Tap USB tethering from the Tethering menu to remove  the check mark and deactivate the feature   3  Remove the USB cable from the device     Mobile HotSpot    This feature allows you to turn your device into a Wi Fi  hotspot  The feature works best when used in conjunction  with 4G LTE data services  although 3G service can also be  used     The Mobile H
173. count    e Contacts to display  allows you to choose to display All  contacts  those on your Phone  SIM card  Samsung account   Gmail  or only display contacts that are part of a Customized    list        e Settings  allows you to con    figure where you save new contacts    to  or view your service numbers  or send contact information     Options include  Only contacts with phones  List by  Display    contacts by  Service numbers  and Contact sharing settings     e Help  provides an on screen Help file that covers most high    level topics for Contacts           Contacts 115    Contact Menu Options    1   2     116    From the Home screen  tap A   Touch and hold an entry to reveal the context menu    The following options display    e Edit  allows you to edit the currently selected Contacts entry    e Delete  allows you to delete the currently selected Contacts  entry      Join contact  allows you to link the current contact to another  current contact  Similar to a  see also  feature  If you can t  remember a contact   s information  linking entries can help you  find the person you are looking for      Share contact via message  allows you to send the current  entry info via text message    e Add to favorites  allows you to copy the current Contacts entry  to the list within the Favorites tab      Remove from favorites  allows you to remove the current  Contacts entry from the Favorites tab    Add to group  allows you to add the current Contacts entry to  an existing group
174. creen  tap  Phone    2  Press     1 and then tap Call settings  gt  Ringtones and  keypad tones   3  Tap Ringtones  select a ringtone  and tap OK     Tap Add to locate an audio file to create as a ringtone   4  Tap Vibrations  select a vibration type  and tap OK     Tap Create to begin creating your own custom vibration   5  Tap Vibrate when ringing to create a check mark if you  want your phone to vibrate when a call is incoming   6  Tap Keypad tones to create a check mark if you want  tones to play when the keypad is pressed   Personalize call sound  This option allows you to personalize the sounds you hear  during a call with and without earphones   1  From the Home screen  tap  Phone    2  Press i     and then tap Call settings Call settings   3  Tap Personalize call sound and activate the feature by  selecting an available option     For more information  refer to  Personalizing the Call Sound  Setting  on page 88     Noise reduction  This option allows you to suppress background noise during  a call   1  From the Home screen  tap W  Phone    2  Press   and then tap Call settings  gt  Noise  reduction to create a check mark and enable the  feature     Increase volume in pocket  This option increases the ringtone volume when the device is  in a pocket or a bag  It uses the proximity sensor to detect its  location  Z   1  From the Home screen  tap a  Phone    2  Press    and then tap Call settings  gt  Increase  volume in pocket to create a check mark and enable  the featu
175. ct    T Mobile for assistance     To unlock your device with a PIN code    1  Tap Forgot pattern   located at the bottom of the  Screen     2  Scroll down and tap the Type PIN code field and use the  on screen keypad to enter the backup PIN code you  setup when you created your lock pattern    3  Tap OK     4  If you have forgotten your current pattern  tap Pattern  from the Screen unlock settings menu and follow the  procedures outlined in  Setting an Unlock Pattern  on  page 301 to create a new pattern    To unlock your device using your Google account    1  Tap Forgot pattern   located at the bottom of the  Screen     2  Tap the Username  email  and Password fields  use the  on screen keyboard to enter your Google Account  credentials  and tap Sign in to complete the login  process    3  If you have forgotten your Google Account credentials   visit the Google website to recover them  If you still  cannot get your Google Account credentials  contact  your wireless carrier for additional options     Changing Your Settings 303    PIN Lock and Unlock    1     From the Home screen  press  re and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen    Tap Screen lock  gt  PIN    Enter a PIN number using the numeric keypad and  touch Continue to confirm the password     Confirm the PIN by re entering it and tap OK to confirm     Your phone now requires you to enter this PIN number  in order to unlock the phone     Password Lock and Unlock    __    1     304    From the Home scr
176. ct a current Preferred TTS engine from the list of  available options  Select Google Text to speech Engine  or Samsung text to speech engine  The default is  Google Text to speech    3  Tap next to the preferred TTS engine configure  the following settings      Language  allows you to set the language for spoken text      Settings for Google Text to speech Engine  allows you to  view Open Source Licenses      Settings for Samsung text to speech engine  allows you to  configure the General settings for the Samsung TTS       Install voice data  allows you to install voice data for speech   synthesis   4  Configure the General options to alter the settings   associated with this feature      Speech rate  adjusts the rate at which on screen text is  spoken by the device  Choose from  Very slow  Slow  Normal   Fast  and Very fast      Listen to an example  plays a short example of what the text   to speech feature sounds like on your device when activated     Configuring the Mouse TrackPad  This feature allows you to configure the pointer speed for a  connected mouse or trackpad    1  From the Home screen  press f    and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt   Pointer speed    2  Adjustthe slider and tap OK     Motions and Gestures Settings  This feature allows you to assign specific functions to certain  phone actions that are detected by both the accelerometer  and gyroscope     Caution  Excessive shaking or impact to the device may cause  unintended 
177. ction that was undone    SAVE Saves the current memo and creates a new one   f  Changes the view mode     L4  Provides access to a quick selection bar  Choose from   Take picture  Images  Clipboard  Maps  Clip art  These  elements can be used within the memo     U Make a voice recording to add to the memo     Add an additional page to the memo     3  From within an active memo  press    to access the  following options     Note  Depending on whether you have saved the memo  are in    keypad mode  or in handwriting mode  the options will  appear differently  The following is a list of the options  you may see       Share via  allows you to share your memo as either an Image  file  jpg   PDF file  pdf   Plain text  or S Memo file   snb  via  Group Play  Wi Fi Direct  Bluetooth  ChatON  Dropbox   Flipboard  Picasa  Google   Messaging  Gmail  or Email      Delete  allows you to delete the S Memo      Export  allows you to save the memo to your Gallery as either  an Image file or PDF file      Save as  allows you to save the memo with a different name      Add tag  allows you to set tags to add in searches    e Add as favorite  allows you to tag the current memo as a  favorite      Change background  allows you to set the background for  your memo  Swipe the screen to the left or right to select a  background and then tap Done           Applications and Development 247      Edit pages  allows you to edit existing memo pages     Create event  allows you to link the memo to your Cal
178. ctivate this option  A check  mark indicates selection     10     11     12     Tap Lock time zone  to lock event time based on your  current user selected time zone   Select a time zone  from within the Select time zone field    Tap Show week number to display the week numbers  along the side of the week entries    Tap Calendars and select the type of general  synchronization settings you want  A check mark  indicates selection    Tap Set alerts  amp  notifications to adjust the event  notification method  Choose from  Alert  Status bar  notification  and Off    Tap Select ringtone to assign a ringtone to a calendar  event notification    Tap Vibration to assign a vibration notification to this  event    Tap Quick responses to edit your default quick  responses for outbound emails  These are default  responses similar to those used by text templates     Camera    Use your 13 0 megapixel camera feature to produce photos  in a JPEG format  The Camcorder shoots High Definition video in  an MP4 format     Note  A microSD card is no longer necessary before you take    pictures or shoot video   It is recommended that you confirm your default storage  location for images and videos     m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt      Q   Camera      For more information  refer to  Using the Camera  on page 163     ChatON    Provides a global mobile communication service where you  can chat with more than 2 buddies via a group chat  In this  service you can send pictures  videos  anim
179. d  communicating     Note  Activating this feature will disconnect your current Wi Fi    network connection     286    To activate your connection   1     From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings Connections tab  l   In a single motion touch and slide the Wi Fi slider to the  right to turn it on  The slider color indicates the  activation status    Tap Wi Fi Direct    Tap Scan and select the single device name to begin  the connection process to another Wi Fi Direct  compatible device     or    Tap Multi connect Scan and select all the device  names to begin the connection process to these Wi Fi  Direct compatible devices     Note  The target device must also have Wi Fi Direct service    active and running before it can be detected by your  device     5  Tap Done  The direct connection is then established   Confirm appears in the Status bar    6  When prompted to complete the connection  the  recipient should tap OK  Your status field now reads   Connected  and your connected device is listed within  the Wi Fi Direct devices listing    Bluetooth settings  In this menu you can activate Bluetooth  view or assign a  device name  activate your phone so other Bluetooth devices  can discover it  or scan for other  available Bluetooth devices  with which to pair  For more information  refer to  Bluetooth   on page 267    Turning Bluetooth On and Off  To turn Bluetooth on  E   1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt   MM  connections tab     2  In
180. d batteries are sold  Additional    information regarding specific locations may be found at     hitp   www epa gov epawaste partnerships plugin cellphone   index htm or at http   www call2recycle org            366    Mail It In    The Samsung Mobile Take Back Program will provide  Samsung customers with a free recycling mailing label   Just go to  http   www samsung com us aboutsamsung citizenship   usactivities environment samsungrecyclingdirect html INT ST  A recyle your phone page and follow the instructions to  print out a free pre paid postage label and then send your  old mobile device or battery to the address listed  via U S   Mail  for recycling    Dispose of unwanted electronics through an approved  recycler     To find the nearest recycling location  go to our website     www samsung com recyclingdirect  Or call   877  278 0799                 Follow local regulations regarding disposal of mobile  devices and batteries    Dispose of your mobile device and batteries in accordance  with local regulations  In some areas  the disposal of these  items in household or business trash may be prohibited  Help  us protect the environment   recycle     THIS POWER UNIT IS INTENDED TO BE  CORRECTLY ORIENTED IN A VERTICAL OR  HORIZONTAL OR FLOOR MOUNT POSITION   Display   Touch Screen  Please note the following information when using your  mobile device   WARNING REGARDING DISPLAY    The display on your mobile device is made of glass or  acrylic and could break if your mobile 
181. d from  within the VOD menu  select Register a DivX Certified  Device        You are prompted to log in or create a DivX account if    your account information has not already been saved in  DivX Player    Follow the instructions in DivX Player to enter the  registration code from step 2 and create a device  nickname  ex     Pat or Pat s Device           Select a location on your computer to download the    DivX registration video with the same title as your  device nickname  ex  Pat divx     Follow the on screen instructions to download the file  and initiate the transfer process  You will need to place  this video file onto your device and play it back   Connect your device to the computer via USB and  transfer this video  For more information  refer to   Communicating with the SD card  on page 72     9  From the Registration screen  Transfer   click Transfer  Video now and select the location of the microSD card  or USB  the device  as the target destination for the  registration video  created in step 6  and click Start    or    Locate the created file  copy and paste it into the new  drive letter corresponding to your device s storage  location     10  From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt      My Files     11  Locate your registration DivX video file and tap the file  to play it  Once you play the registration file on your  device  your registration is complete    12  Return to the DivX VOD Manager screen  from within  your computer s DivX Player  and confirm both you
182. d the following tones   tap Yes to  dial the remaining digits     Call Functions and Contacts List     81    Redialing the Last Number  The device stores the numbers of the calls you ve dialed   received  or missed if the caller is identified    To recall any of these numbers   1  From the Home Screen  tap N   2  Tap the  Logs tab  to display the list of recent   calls    3  Tap the name number and tap q    Speed Dialing    Once you have stored phone numbers from your Contacts  List  you can set up to 99 speed dial entries  2 100  and then  dial them easily whenever you want  simply by touching the  associated numeric key     Note  Speed dial location  1 must be reserved for Voicemail    use     82    Setting Up Speed Dial Entries    Important  Speed dial location  1 is reserved for Voicemail  No    other number can be assigned to this slot     1  From the Home screen  tap   8  gt   tab   o   2  Press ml and then tap Speed dial setting  The Speed  dial setting screen displays a virtual list of locations  with the numbers 2 through 100    3  Tap an unassigned number slot  The Select contact  Screen displays    4  Tapa contact and select a number to assign it to the  speed dial location  The selected contact number   image is displayed in the speed dial number box      Keypad    kepad    Changing a Speed Dial Entry Order  1  From the Home screen  tap N Keypad tab   2  Press Im   and then tap Speed dial setting     Important  The number 1 is reserved for Voicemail and  another n
183. d use the basic features   Accessing the Internet  To access the Browser   m From the Home screen  tap 8E  Apps   gt      Internet      Note  You must disable your Wi Fi connection if you wish  to view the T Mobile home page   http   ml t mobile com    You may be prompted to allow your device to use your  current location     Navigating with the Browser  1  Tapan entry to select an item   2  Sweep the screen with your finger in an up or down  motion to scroll through a website   3  Toreturn to a previous page  tap m    4  To move forward to a Web page  tap Ey     Browser Options  1  From the top of the browser screen  select one of the  available options     Navigation  use the forward and back buttons to navigate  through your browsing activity     Refresh  reloads the current page     Windows  displays a list of the windows you have open     Bookmarks  provides access to the Bookmarks screen    or   From the home page  press fe to access the  following options       Homepage  displays the home Web page     Connections 259      New window  launches a new browser window  By default   this screen shows the home page       Add bookmark  allows you to add a URL to your bookmark list       Add shortcut  allows you to add a shortcut to your Home  Screen      Save page  allows you to store the current page in memory so  that it can be read later even if you loose your Internet  connection  It is saved in your Saved pages folder      Share via  allows you to share the page using Blu
184. dditional research to address gaps in  knowledge  Some of these studies are described below   Interphone Study  Interphone is a large international study designed to  determine whether cell phones increase the risk of head and  neck cancer  A report published in the International Journal  of Epidemiology  June  2010  compared cell phone usage for  more than 5 000 people with brain tumors  glioma and  meningioma  and a similar number of healthy controls     Results of this study did NOT show that cell phones caused  brain cancer  In this study  most people had no increased risk  of brain cancer from using cell phones  For people with the  heaviest use of cell phones  an average of more than Y2 hour  per day  every day  for over 10 years  the study suggested a    slight increase in brain cancer  However  the authors  determined that biases and errors prevented any conclusions  being drawn from this data  Additional information about  Interphone can be found at  http   www iarc fr en media centre pr 2010 pdfs pr200 E pdf     Interphone is the largest cell phone study to date  but it did  not answer all questions about cell phone safety  Additional  research is being conducted around the world  and the FDA  continues to monitor developments in this field   International Cohort Study on Mobile Phone Users   COSMOS   The COSMOS study aims to conduct long term health  monitoring of a large group of people to determine if there  are any health issues linked to long term exposure to r
185. device is    Warning  Never dispose of batteries in a fire because they may  explode     UL Certified Travel Charger    The Travel Charger for this phone has met applicable UL  safety requirements  Please adhere to the following safety  instructions per UL guidelines   FAILURE TO FOLLOW THE INSTRUCTIONS OUTLINED MAY  LEAD TO SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY AND POSSIBLE    PROPERTY DAMAGE     IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS   SAVE THESE  INSTRUCTIONS     dropped or if it receives significant impact  Do not use  if screen is broken or cracked as this could cause  injury to you     DANGER   TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR  ELECTRIC SHOCK  CAREFULLY FOLLOW THESE  INSTRUCTIONS    FOR CONNECTION TO A SUPPLY NOT IN NORTH  AMERICA  USE AN ATTACHMENT PLUG ADAPTOR  OF THE PROPER CONFIGURATION FOR THE  POWER OUTLET     Health and Safety Information 367    WARRANTY DISCLAIMER  PROPER USE OF A  TOUCH SCREEN MOBILE DEVICE    If your mobile device has a touch screen display   please note that a touch screen responds best to a  light touch from the pad of your finger or a non metallic  stylus  Using excessive force or a metallic object when  pressing on the touch screen may damage the  tempered glass surface and void the warranty  For  more information  please refer to the  Standard  Limited Warranty      GPS  amp  AGPS    Certain Samsung mobile devices can use a Global Positioning  System  GPS  signal for location based applications  A GPS  uses satellites controlled by the U S  Government that are  su
186. dia  tap on any content  Thumbnail or text  to navigate to    the product detail page     Content     Multimedia 187      Unlike purchased Media Content  rented Media Content will be e  n no event will rented Media Content be available for a period    viewable on only 1 device in your account at a time  of more than thirty  30  days  or shorter on a title by title basis      Media Content is downloaded and saved to your authorized after the Media Content has been rented  e g   if you begin  device s SD card  No SD Card included out of box  viewing rented Media Content on the 29th day after the rental     Your Media Content may pause stop or not download in networks transaction  but do not finish viewing the entire title  that rented  where there is a weak signal  Media Content may not be available for the entire twenty four    You may begin watching downloaded Media Content as soon as a   24  consecutive hour period if such period would extend the  license acquisition has occurred and b  sufficient amount of the viewable time beyond the thirty  30  day rental window    Media Content has been buffered    Unless otherwise restricted by the Content Providers  you can    You must finish watching Media Content within the time limit set download Media Content to your TV using HDMI connections   out for each piece of content  which may be as short as 24 otherwise  you cannot play Media Content downloaded from your  consecutive hours   mobile device output       Stopping  pausing or 
187. dren and  teenagers  The steps adults can take to reduce RF exposure  apply to children and teenagers as well      Reduce the amount of time spent on the cell phone       Use speaker mode or a headset to place more distance between  the head and the cell phone     Some groups sponsored by other national governments have  advised that children be discouraged from using cell phones  at all  For example  The Stewart Report from the United  Kingdom made such a recommendation in December 2000   In this report  a group of independent experts noted that no  evidence exists that using a cell phone causes brain tumors  or other ill effects  Their recommendation to limit cell phone  use by children was strictly precautionary  it was not based  on scientific evidence that any health hazard exists   Additional information on the safety of RF exposures from  various sources can be obtained from the following  organizations  updated 10 1 2010       FCC RF Safety Program    http   www fcc gov oet rfsafety         Health and Safety Information 359      Environmental Protection Agency  EPA    http   www epa gov radtown wireless tech html       Occupational Safety and Health Administration  OSHA    http   www osha gov SLTC radiofrequencyradiation     Note  This web address is case sensitive        National Institute for Occupational Safety and Health  NIOSH    hitp   www cdc gov niosh       World Health Organization  WHO    http   Awww who int peh emf en                 International Commissio
188. dvisor              00000 cece nia 254  VID TE 255  Visual Voicemail                    00  255  Voice Recorder                 00000  255  VOICE Searcli i22 ke ga dea da ws ee lees 256  VPN UOlient  Lis oiucerdv Rl ue TET 257  WatchON            0 0  c cece eee ee 257  YoUTUbe  icd cres ew ea b erm oe 257  Section 10  Connections                          259  Internets dba e Rcs tate bun 259  Bluetooth              02  cece eee eee 267  Enable Downloading for Web Applications    271  PC Connections                   000  272  WI FI  ios duce dada te tS aad Sand Sands 273  USB Tethering               20000000  276  Mobile HotSpot                  0005  277    Section 11  Changing Your Settings         280  Accessing the Settings Tabs              280  Settings Tabs   Overview                 280  Wi Fi Settings           0   0 0 eee 281  Bluetooth settings                      287  Data sage os toes tette bet RR 289  More Networks         lisse 290  LockScreen ciinei eiaa gaari e eee 299  Display Settings                  0005  304  LED Indicator 2 eere 306  Sound Settings               0    000  307  Home Screen Mode                     310  Call Settings    oo npe rn aet 310  Blocking Mode                 2000005 321  Power Saving Mode                     321  ACCESSO   lsollelsl d en 322  Accessibility Settings                    322  Language and Input Settings              325  Motions and Gestures Settings             331  Smart screen nenon ere ee ee 334  Ait VIEW  1  
189. e  click Sign in Create an account  for free    Follow the on screen prompts to create your free  account    Look for an email from Google in the email box you  provided  and respond to the email to confirm and  activate your new account     Signing into Your Google Account    1     20    Launch an application that requires a Google account   such as Play Store or Gmail     Click Existing    Tap the Email and Password fields and enter your  information    Tap  3  Sign in   Your device communicates with the  Google servers to confirm your information    If prompted  you can enable the option to stay up to  date on news and offers  then tap OK     Retrieving your Google Account  Password    A Google account password is required for Google  applications  If you misplace or forget your Google Account  password  follow these instructions to retrieve it     1     From your computer  use an Internet browser and  navigate to http   google com accounts    Click on the Can t access your account  link    Follow the on screen password recovery procedure        Confirming the Default Image and  Video Storage Location  Although the device is configured to store new pictures and  videos to the Memory card  it is a very good idea to confirm  this location before using your device     Important  Too many users can overlook this storage  destination until something goes wrong  It is  recommended that you verify this location or  change it before initiating the use of the camera or  camcorder f
190. e and  record an audio clip using the phone s microphone  It is then  automatically attached to the message      S Memo  allows you to add an S Memo that you have created      Calendar  allows you to add an event from your calendar      Location  allows you to attach a thumbnail of a map showing  your location      Contacts  allows you to tap on an existing Address Book entry   then add it to your message by tapping Done     Adding Additional Text  You can copy text such as names  phone numbers  and  events from your Contacts  Calendar  or a Memo   1  While composing a message  press I 2 Add text   2  Atthe Add text screen  select one of the following     S Memo  allows you to insert text from an existing S Memo     Calendar  allows you to add the name  date  and time of a  calendar event to your message     Location  allows you to add an address and the link to the  location on Google Maps     Contacts  allows you to add the name and phone number of  any of your contacts to your message     Text templates  allows you to add pre defined phrases and  sentences  For more information  refer to    Text Templates  on page 144     The information is added to your message               Messages 135    Viewing Newly Received Messages    When you receive a message  your phone notifies you by    displaying within the Notification area at the top left of  your Home screen     To read a message     1     136    Open the Notification Bar and select the message  For  more information  refe
191. e applications that are not default to the  device can be downloaded  Tap    to remove the selected  app      Downloaded applications  allows you to filter the view of apps  to only those applications that you have downloaded      View type  allows you to customize the way the Apps menu  listing is shown  page 67       Share apps  allows you to share information about selected  applications with external users  page 66       Hide applications  allows you to specify which current  applications are hidden from view in this menu  Once you have  Selected the apps  tap Done      Show hidden applications  allows you to specify which  previously hidden applications are can be made visible again  for viewing in this menu  Once you have selected the apps  tap  Done    Press   to return to the Home screen        Understanding Your Device 43    The following table contains a description of each application  available via both the Primary shortcuts area and via the  Applications screens  If the application is already described  in another section of this user manual  then a cross reference  to that particular section is provided  For information on  navigating through the Applications icons  see    Navigating  Through the Application Menus    on page 63     Calculator        Launches the on screen calculator application    The calculator provides the basic arithmetic  functions  addition  subtraction  multiplication  and  division  You can also use this as a scientific calculator     For
192. e available while in the  provider s coverage area  If you travel outside your provider s  coverage area  wireless emergency alerts may not be  available  For more information  please contact your wireless  provider     Smart Practices While Driving  On the Road   Off the Phone    The primary responsibility of every driver is the safe  operation of his or her vehicle     Responsible drivers understand that no secondary task  should be performed while driving whether it be eating   drinking  talking to passengers  or talking on a mobile phone    unless the driver has assessed the driving conditions and is  confident that the secondary task will not interfere with their  primary responsibility  Do not engage in any activity while  driving a moving vehicle which may cause you to take your  eyes off the road or become so absorbed in the activity that  your ability to concentrate on the act of driving becomes  impaired  Samsung is committed to promoting responsible  driving and giving drivers the tools they need to understand  and address distractions     Check the laws and regulations on the use of mobile devices  and their accessories in the areas where you drive  Always  obey them  The use of these devices may be prohibited or  restricted in certain areas  For example  only hands free use  may be permitted in certain areas    Before answering calls  consider your circumstances  Let the  call go to voicemail when driving conditions require   Remember  driving comes first  not th
193. e call     If you consider a call necessary and appropriate  follow these   tips      Use a hands free device      Secure your phone within easy reach      Place calls when you are not moving      Plan calls when your car will be stationary      Do not engage in stressful or emotional conversations      Letthe person with whom you are speaking know that you are  driving and will suspend the call if necessary      Do not take notes or look up phone numbers while driving    Notice regarding legal restrictions on mounting this device in   an automobile     Laws in some states may prohibit mounting this device on or  near the windshield of an automobile  In other states  the law  may permit mounting this device only in specific locations in  the automobile  Be sure to consult the state and local laws or  ordinances where you drive before mounting this device in  an automobile  Failure to comply with these restrictions could  result in fines  penalties  or other damages    Never mount this device in a manner that will obstruct the  driver s clear view of the street and traffic     Health and Safety Information 363    Never use wireless data services such as text messaging  Web  browsing  or e mail while operating a vehicle     Never watch videos  such as a movie or clip  or play video  games while operating a vehicle     For more information  go to http   www ctia org   Battery Use and Safety    Important  Handle and store batteries properly to avoid injury or    damage  Most batt
194. e feature works best when you break your message  down into smaller segments     Using Google Voice Typing    1     3     From a screen where you can enter text  in a single  motion  touch and drag the Status bar down to the  bottom of the screen  then select Ls  Select input  method   gt  Google voice typing  The virtual keyboard is  then removed and all subsequent input to done via the  microphone as text to speech    Speak into the device s microphone and watch your  text being entered on screen    If the text is incorrect  tap DELETE     Entering Text    107    Section 6  Contacts    This section explains how to use and manage your Contacts  List  You can save phone numbers to your phone s memory   Accounts  From the Accounts menu you decide if you want applications  to synchronize  send  and receive data at any given time  or if  you want the applications to synchronize automatically  After  determining how you want the accounts to synchronize   indicate which account to synchronize with your Contacts  list    1  Sign in to your Google account    2  From the Home screen  press mi and then tap  Settings  gt  ese  Accounts tab  and then navigate  to the My accounts area    Sore   From the Home sereen  tap ES  Apps   gt  O   Settings   gt  P    Accounts tab  and then navigate  to the My accounts area     108    Note  The Accounts area lists those accounts that have been  added to the device and provides an Add account button  to quickly and easily add new ones     Contacts 
195. e in  professional cameras    Exposure value  allows you to adjust the brightness level by  moving the slider      Guidelines  Display viewfinder guides to help composition  when selecting subjects      Flash  activate or deactivate the flash      Voice control  activates deactivates voice control feature that  allows you to verbally take a photo      Contextual filename  allows you to have your location added  as part of the filename  You must first activate GPS tag  described above      Save as flipped  when set to On  this option allows you to take  and save a mirror image video when using self recording  mode      Storage  Select the memory location for storage                Shutter sound  Tum the shutter sound on or off  3  Press  r   for additional options such as     Reset  Reset the camera settings      Favorite  allows you to assign the current image as a favorite   Pictures and Videos Image Viewer Options     Slideshow  allows you to see your photos in a slideshow   After you take a photo or record a video  you can access     Photo frame  takes the current image and creates a  various options  surrounding photo frame that can be edited with edited text or  Photo viewing options drawn object  then saved   1  Tap a thumbnail to view the picture      Photo note  allows you to write notes on your current image  and then save it   Note  If no control icons are displayed on the screen in     Copy to clipboard allows you to copy one or more pictures to a  addition to the 
196. e information  refer to  Voice Recorder  on  page 255    Voice Search   Launches the Google Now application that is used  for voice to text Internet searching     For more information  referto    Voice Search  on page  256     VPN Client    This is a full featured VPN Client that provides  support for the latest IPSec VPN standards and  provides interoperability with support for all major  VPN Gateways    For more information  refer to  VPN Client  on page  257     WatchON     This application  you can use your phone as aremote  control for your TV     For more information  refer to    Using WatchON    on  page 189    You YouTube   Launches the YouTube Web page via the browser     For more information  refer to    YouTube    on page  257     Important  For help closing any or all current applications  use    the Task manager  For more information  refer to     Task Manager    on page 24     Screen Navigation   Using the touch screen display and the keys  you can   navigate the features of your device and enter characters    The following conventions are used in this manual to   describe the navigation action in the procedures    Navigating Through the Screens   The following terms describe the most common hardware   and on screen actions      Press and hold  Pressing relates to use of the hardware keys and  buttons to select or activate an item  For example  press the  Navigation key to scroll through a menu  Some buttons and keys  require you to press and hold them to activa
197. e limit  allows you to set a limit on how   many multimedia messages are allowed in one conversation   Text message  SMS  settings     Delivery reports  when this option is activated  the network  informs you whether or not your message was delivered      Manage SIM card messages  allows you to manage the  messages stored on the SIM card      Message center  allows you to enter the number of your  message center where your messages reside while the system  is attempting to deliver them      Input mode  allows you to set the input mode for your text  messages  Choose from  GSM Alphabet  Unicode  or  Automatic     Multimedia message  MMS  settings    Delivery reports  when this option is activated  the network    informs you whether or not your message was delivered      Read reports  when this option is activated  your phone  receives a request for a read reply along with your message to  the recipient      Auto retrieve  allows the message system to automatically  retrieve messages        Messages 139      Roaming auto retrieve  allows the message system to  automatically retrieve while roaming     Creation mode  allows you to select the creation mode  Free    Restricted  or Warning        Restricted  you can only create and submit messages with  content belonging to the Core MM Content Domain        Waming  the phone will wam you via pop up messages that  you are creating a multimedia message which does not fit the  Core MM Content Domain        Free  you may add any content
198. e mode  slider to the right to turn it on    3  Tap OK  The Airplane mode icon is displayed at  the top of your screen     Mobile networks    Before you use applications such as Google Maps and find  your location or search for places of interest  you must  enable the Mobile networks options     m From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks     The following options display   Use mobile data  Allows you to activate mobile data usage on your device     m From the Home screen  press        and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks  gt  Mobile data    Data Roaming  Data roaming allows you to connect to your service  provider   s partner networks and access data services when  you are out of your service providers area of coverage    1  From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks    2  Tap Data roaming to connect to data services while  roaming outside your network     or   Tap Data roaming again to remove the green check  mark and deactivate the feature     Access Point Names  To access a wireless access point     m From the Home screen  press     and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Mobile networks  gt  Access Point Names  A list of the  Access point names display  The active access point  displays a bright green  filled circle to the right of the  name    
199. e tab  gt  Security   2  Tap Set up SIM card lock   3  Tap Lock SIM card  enter your SIM PIN code  then tap  OK     Note  You must activate Lock SIM card before you can change    your SIM PIN code     To change an existing SIM Card PIN    Tap Change SIM PIN    Enter the old SIM PIN code and tap OK   Enter the new SIM PIN code and tap OK   Re type the new SIM PIN code and tap OK     momo  T    346    Password Settings  When you create a phone password you can also configure  the phone to display the password as you type it instead of  using an asterisk      m  1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Security     2  Tap Make passwords visible to activate this feature     Device Administration  Activating this feature allows Google to administrate your  phone in a way similar to IT security settings on a corporate  PC  This would be beneficial in the case that your phone was  lost or stolen  The phone could be    deactivated    or     restricted     through administration  from a remote location   1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Security   2  Tap Device administrators to begin configuring this  setting   3  Select an administrator device and follow the prompts     Unknown Sources  Before you can download a web application you must enable  the Unknown sources feature  enables downloading    Developers can use this option to install non Play Store  applications  E  1  From the Home screen  press  ren a
200. e the Symbol Numeric Mode to add numbers  symbols   or emoticons  While in this mode  the text mode key  displays ES  1  From a screen where you can enter text  tap the text  input field to reveal the on screen keyboard  Rotate the  phone counterclockwise to a landscape orientation  if  desired   2  Tap to configure the keyboard for Symbol  mode  Once in this mode  the text input type shows  ABC     3  Tap a number  symbol  or emoticon character   4  Tap BEE to return to ABC mode   To enter symbols   1  Tap Sui to configure the keyboard for Symbol  mode   2  Tapthe appropriate symbol key    or   Tap  2  button to cycle through additional pages     The first number on this key indicates which page  1 or 2  of  additional characters is active   106    Using the Google Voice Typing  This feature uses Google voice recognition to convert your  spoken words into on screen text   You can use your voice to enter text using the Google Voice  typing feature   1  From the keyboard  touch the top of the screen and  drag it down to display your notification panel   2  Tap E  Select input method  Google voice typing   3  Atthe Listening prompt  Speak now   speak  clearly and distinctly into the microphone   The text is displayed in the message as you are  speaking   For more detailed information on configuring Google Voice  Typing settings  see    Configure Google Voice Typing    on  page 325   4  Tap   or   Tap o  Resume  to resume recognition      Done  when you are finished     Note  Th
201. e viewfinder     4   Share shot   Shooting mode  lists the current  IN s    wi shooting modes available from with the Share  Shot mode  Choose from Easy connect  Wi Fi    Direct  or Cancel    lt  Quick Settings  hide Quick settings     Camera and Camcorder Settings  This section describes the different settings that you can  configure on your camera  Not all of the following options are  available in both still camera and video camera modes  The  available options vary by mode   1  From the viewfinder  tap  Quick Settings   gt    Camera Settings      Camcorder  and General ta      The follow settings are located under the Camera     bs  The settings that are    displayed will depend on what camera mode you are    in   Camera     Photo size  Select a resolutio    resolution for higher quality  H  more memory     n for photos  Use higher  igher resolution photos take up      Burst shot  allows several photographs to be captured in quick    Succession by touching and h    olding the Camera button       Face detection  allows you to adjust the camera focus based    on face detection technology     Metering  allows you to set h    ow the camera measures or    meters the light source  Center weighted  Matrix  or Spot     ISO  determines how sensitive the light meter is on your digital       camera  Choose from Auto   lower ISO number to make yo       100  200  400  or 800  Use a    ur camera less sensitive to light  a    higher ISO number to take photos with less light  or Auto to 
202. eat 221    SNS 124  Social Network  Adding Facebook Contacts 124  Resync 125  Social Networking  Adding Contacts From 124  Software Update 352  Wi Fi 354  Song  Set As 201  Sound  Adapt Sound 309  Sounds  Turn Off All 324  Spam 144  Accessing Your Spam Folder 144  Add a Phrase 141  143  Add Number 133  134  137  Assigning Manually 142  Assigning Phone Numbers 142  Block Unknown Numbers 143  Block Unknown Senders 141   143  Manually Add a Number 141  142    407    Match Criteria 143   Registering a Phrase as Spam 143   Settings 141  142  Spam Messages 132   Assigning 132  Speakerphone   Turning on and off 89  Specific Absorption Rate  SAR   Certification Information 360  Speed Dial   Changing an entry 83   Making a call 83   Removing an entry 83   Setting up entries 82  Standard Limited Warranty 379  Standard Mode 310  Status Bar 32  Sub Menus   Navigation 63  SugarSync 207  SwiftKeyFlow   Samsung Keyboard 326  Switching to a Bluetooth   During a call 89    408    Swpe Connect  Backup and Sync 329  Swype 98  123ABC Mode 101  ABC Mode 100  Cellular Data 329  Connect 329  Connect Registration 329  Contribute Usage Data 329  Entering Numbers 102  Entering Symbols 102  Entering Text 99  Keyboard Mode 100  Personal Dictionary 329  Preferences 328  Reset Dictionary 328  Select Text Input Mode 100  Settings 328  SYM mode 100  Updates 329  System  Volume 307    System Manager 343  System Tone  Settings 309  T    Task Manger  Overview 25  Tethering 294  Active Icon 276  Disconnecting 2
203. eatures     1  From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt  ie    Camera     2  Press l   and then tap Settings  gt   and scroll down to the Storage entry    3  Tap this entry and select the desired default storage  location for newly taken pictures or videos  Choose  from  Device or Memory card     EJ  Settings     Note  It is recommended that you set the option to Memory    card     4  Press to return to the Home screen   Creating a Samsung Account  Just as important as setting up and activating a Google  account to help provide access to Play Store  etc   An active  Samsung account is required to begin accessing applications  such as Media Hub     Note  The Samsung account application will manage your  access to the previously mentioned applications  and  there is no longer a need to remember different  passwords for each application     1  From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt   Accounts tab     2  Navigate to the My accounts area and then tap  Add account  gt  Samsung account    3  If you have previously created a Samsung account  tap  Sign in    or   If this is your first time  tap Create new account     Getting Started 21    Enter your the required information and tap Sign up    5  Tap Terms and conditions  Special terms  and Privacy  policy to read the legal disclaimers and related  information    6  If you agree to the terms  place a green check mark in  the I accept all the terms above field and tap Agree    7  Enter your the required information 
204. ect    8  Tap t  Up a Directory Level  at the top of the  application window to navigate up a single level with  every tap    9  Tap  Camera Uploads Albums  at the top of the  application window to access your Uploads and  Albums tabs    10  Tap  Tag as Favorite  at the top of the application  window to assign favorite files    11  Tap  Search  at the top of the application window  to search for files located in your Dropbox account                 226    Manually uploading a Picture to Dropbox   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   ie  Camera     2  After the image is taken  tap the Image Viewer box at  the bottom right  This previews the current image    3  Tapthe image to reveal the image options at the top of  the screen    4  Tap 3  2  Dropbox  select a folder location  and tap Upload     Note  If your share folder is located on your computer  you will  momentarily receive an on screen popup notifying you  that a new image was uploaded to your shared Dropbox  folder     Email enables you to review and create email using most  email services  The device alerts you when you receive an  email message   m From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt   GY   Email    For more information  refer to  Using Email  on page 144     Flipboard    This application creates a personalized digital magazine out  of everything being shared with you  Access news stories   personal feeds and other related material  Flip through your  Facebook newsfeed  tweets from your Twitter account   phot
205. ect that interference is taking place      Should read and follow the directions from the manufacturer of  your implantable medical device  If you have any questions about  using your wireless mobile device with an implantable medical  device  consult your health care provider     For more information see  http   www fcc gov oet r  safety rf   fags html         Health and Safety Information 373    Other Medical Devices  If you use any other personal medical devices  consult the  manufacturer of your device to determine if it is adequately  shielded from external RF energy  Your physician may be able  to assist you in obtaining this information  Switch your  mobile device off in health care facilities when any  regulations posted in these areas instruct you to do so   Hospitals or health care facilities may be using equipment  that could be sensitive to external RF energy    Vehicles    RF signals may affect improperly installed or inadequately  shielded electronic systems in motor vehicles  Check with  the manufacturer or its representative regarding your vehicle  before using your mobile device in a motor vehicle  You  should also consult the manufacturer of any equipment that  has been added to your vehicle    Posted Facilities  Switch your mobile device off in any facility where posted  notices require you to do so    Potentially Explosive Environments  Switch your mobile device off when in any area with a  potentially explosive atmosphere and obey all signs and  instructi
206. ed      CAPS ALT key  When in 123ABC mode  this key changes the  capitalization of the subsequent entered characters  When in  SYM mode  this key can show additional symbol characters      SWYPE settings  Touch and hold this button to access the  Swype settings screen      Text Input mode  There are two available modes  123ABC and  SYM        123ABC mode contains alphanumeric characters and a few  common punctuation marks  Text mode button indicates SYM        SYM mode contains only symbols and numbers  Text mode  button indicates 123ABC        Recipients        Pa n    Text input field    7 This device is lightning fast               Suggestions   m Current    e   Mode  CAPS ALT  Up pco 9 ob Re Ip  key  FUTT gh j k    zx cv bn m   Delete    ie n va  SWYPE Settings    Text Input mode    Using 123ABC Mode in SWYPE  In 123ABC mode  you can enter only letters and a few  common punctuation marks from the on screen keyboard   The text mode key shows B  1  From a screen where you can enter text  tap the text  input field to reveal the on screen keyboard     2  Tap to configure the keyboard for 123ABC mode   showing letters and numbers on the on screen keys    Once in this mode  the text input type shows B    Note  After typing an initial uppercase character  the key  changes to and all letters that follow are in lower  case     3  Swipe your finger continuously over the letters to form  a word        If you make a mistake  tap Ie  1o erase a single character    Touch and hold 1o er
207. ed     4  Tap the Alarm repeat field and touch the number of  times you want this alarm to repeat  Selections are   day blocks or Repeat Weekly  Selected day blocks turn  blue when active    5  Tap the Alarm type field and select one of the following   Melody  Vibration  Vibration and melody  or Briefing     6  Tap More to configure additional alarm settings such as    volume slider  Alarm tone  Location alarm  Snooze   Smart alarm  and assign a name     To configure additional alarm settings     Tap More to access additional alarm settings     2  Tap the Alarm tone field and either select an available    tone or select Add to use locate a sound to use as an  alarm ringtone  Tap OK to activate the ringtone    Slide the slider bar left or right in the Alarm volume field  to decrease or increase the alarm volume  A sample of  the volume level plays    Move the Location alarm slider to the right to activate  the feature  then follow the on screen instructions to  enter a location  When activated  the alarm only  sounds when you are at a specific location    Move the Snooze slider to the right to activate the  feature  Tap the field to assign a Interval time    3 minutes  5 minutes  10 minutes  15 minutes  or   30 minutes  and Repeat  1 time  2 times  3 times    5 times  and 10 times        Interval indicates the length of time the alarm will remain silent  between alarm notifications  snooze time       Repeat indicates the numbers of snooze sessions that are  assigned to this al
208. ed     Desk clock tab at the far right       To make changes  press  r  and then tap Settings     The following options are displayed while in full screen   mode      Calendar  when this is checked  the calendar is displayed  Tap  to uncheck      Weather  when this is activated  the location  temperature  and  weather condition is displayed  Touch and slide the slider to the  right to tum it on      Dock  allows you to set your Dock settings such as Dock  sound  Audio output mode  Desk home screen display   Automatic unlock  and Audio output  For more information   refer to    Accessory    on page 322        7  Tap to display the Desk clock in full screen mode   8  To make changes in full screen mode  press    and    then tap      Edit shortcuts  allows you to edit the shortcuts shown at the  bottom of full screen mode      Hide Show shortcuts  allows you to hide or view the current  on screen shortcuts located along the bottom of the full screen  mode     Applications and Development 223      Settings  provides access to the Desk clock settings menu  from where you can alter the following  Hide status bar   Wallpaper  Calendar  Weather  and Dock      Date and time  provides access to the Date and time menu    Contacts  The default storage location for saving phone numbers to  your Contacts List is your phone s built in memory   m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    B  Contacts     For more information  refer to  Contacts List  on page 108   Downloads    Provides quick
209. ed number of    Security options  allows you  such as  Encrypt all  Sign all     the device to resend an outgoing  imes if delivery fails    to enable several security options  Create keys  Private keys  Public    keys  and Set default key  These security policies could restrict   some functions from corporate servers        Security policy list  lists the current email s security policy   These policies could restrict some functions from corporate  servers      Incoming settings  Lets you specify incoming email settings   such as User name  Password  IMAP server  Security type    Port  and IMAP path prefix      Outgoing settings  Lets you specify outgoing email settings   such as SMTP server  Security type  Port  Require sign in  User  name  or Password              Note  Some the above options may not be displayed when  using some Internet account types     Messages 149    Microsoft Exchange Email  Outlook     Your phone also provides access to your company s Outlook  Exchange server  If your company uses either Microsoft  Exchange Server 2003 or 2007  you can use this email  application to wirelessly synchronize your email  Contacts   and Calendar information directly with your company s  Exchange server   Setting Up a Microsoft Exchange Email account  1  From the Home screen  tap  gt     Email    2  Ifyou already have other email account setup     Open an existing email account  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   F   Add account  m   or   Enter your Email address and P
210. een  press  E and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen   Tap Screen lock       Tap Password     Enter a password using the keypad and tap Continue to  confirm the password    Confirm the password by re entering it and tap OK to  confirm     Display Settings  In this menu  you can change various settings for the display  such as the font  orientation  pop up notifications  puzzle  lock feature  animation  brightness  and screen timeout  and  power saving mode     Adjusting the Screen Display    1     From the Home screen  press J 1 Imi and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab  Display   Configure the following screen display settings      Wallpaper  allows you to set the Wallpaper for your Home  Screen  Lock screen  or both      Notification Panel  allows you to set the brightness of your  notification panel and also select the quick setting buttons that  you want to display at the top of the notification panel   page 38       Multi window  tap this option to enable disable the automatic  Multi window feature      Screen mode  allows you to select from several different color  modes       Brightness  adjusts the on screen brightness level  For more  information  refer to    Adjusting Screen Brightness  on  page 306      Auto rotate screen  when enabled  the phone automatically  Switches from portrait to landscape orientation and vice versa   When this setting is disabled  the phone displays in portrait  mode only      Screen timeout  adjusts the delay time 
211. efects or damage resulting from improper  testing  operation  maintenance  installation  service  or  adjustment not furnished or approved by SAMSUNG     h  defects or damage resulting from external causes such as  collision with an object  fire  flooding  dirt  windstorm   lightning  earthquake  exposure to weather conditions  theft   blown fuse  or improper use of any electrical source     i  defects or damage resulting from cellular signal reception    Warranty Information 379    or transmission  or viruses or other software problems  introduced into the Product  or  j  Product used or purchased  outside the United States  This Limited Warranty covers  batteries only if battery capacity falls below 8096 of rated  capacity or the battery leaks  and this Limited Warranty does  not cover any battery if  i  the battery has been charged by a  battery charger not specified or approved by SAMSUNG for  charging the battery   ii  any of the seals on the battery are  broken or show evidence of tampering  or  iii  the battery has  been used in equipment other than the SAMSUNG phone for  which it is specified    What are SAMSUNG s obligations     During the applicable warranty period  provided the Product  is returned in accordance with the terms of this Limited  Warranty  SAMSUNG will repair or replace the Product  at  SAMSUNG   s sole option  without charge  SAMSUNG may  at  SAMSUNG   s sole option  use rebuilt  reconditioned  or new  parts or components when repairing any Product  
212. end email feature     1  From the Home screen  tap E    2  Press    and then tap Send message email  gt  Send  email  Contacts that contain an email address display    3  Tap the contact s  to which you want to send an email   A check mark displays next to the selection     Note  The select contact must have an email as part of their  details screen     4  Tap Done   5  Select an email account type   6  Compose the email and tap Send     Contacts 125    Exportilmport  For more information  refer to  Copying Contact Information   on page 121   Contact List Settings  From this menu you can determine the default storage  location for Contacts  display your phone s primary number   and view service numbers listed in your Contact list   1  From the Home screen  tap BA   2  Press   1 and then tap Settings  Configure any of the  following options     Only contacts with phones allows you to display only those  contacts containing phone numbers     List by defines how the current list of Contacts are sorted   First name or Last name     Display contacts by defines how the current list of Contacts  are listed  First name  ex  Steve Smith  or Last name first   Smith  Steve      Service numbers lists the currently available service numbers     126      Contact sharing settings allows you configure how your  Contacts entries are sent  individually or as a single file  containing all available entries    Tap Settings to select a share setting        Send all namecards allows you to set you
213. endar  events     e Set as  allows you to set a memo as a Contact icon  Home  Screen wallpaper  Lock screen wallpaper  or Home and lock  Screens      Print  allows you to print the screen or Web page on a  Samsung printer using Wi Fi     When you are finished creating your memo  tap Save on the  top menu bar     248    S Translator    Allows you can easily translate words and phrases  verbal or  text messages  into many different languages     Note  Access to this feature requires that you already be  logged in to your Samsung account application  For  more information  refer to  Creating a Samsung  Account  on page 21     1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt    amp   S Translator     2  If prompted  follow the on screen instructions to log  into your Samsung account    To translate text    1  Atthe S Translator screen  tap the top language bar to  select your target source language  Default is Spanish    2  Tapthe bottom language bar to select the destination  language that you would like to translate to  Default is  English  US     3  Enter text into the top box and it will automatically be  translated into the lower box     4  Tapthe selected o  Translate  button within the  bottom field  The top target language field is then  updated with the new translation     To translate using your voice     Important  The two on screen buttons at the bottom of the    application correspond to the two currently  selected languages     1  Atthe S Translator screen  tap the left v
214. ended screens     68    Adding and Removing Widgets  Widgets are self contained applications that can be placed  on any screen  Unlike shortcuts  widgets appear as  applications   To add a Widget   1  From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt  Widgets  tab     2  Scroll across the Widget pages and locate a desired  Widget    3  Touch and hold an available Widget until it detaches  from the screen    4  While still holding the Widget  scroll left or right across  the available screens and let go of the Widget to place  it on your current screen     To remove a Widget     1     Touch and hold a Widget until it unlocks from the   current screen    Drag the widget over the Remove tab qu and   release it      As you place the Widget into the Trash  both items turn red      This action doesn t delete the Widget  it just removes it from the  Current screen     To place a widget onto a different screen     1     Touch and hold the widget until it becomes  transparent    Slowly drag it past the edge of the screen until the  adjacent page appears highlighted and it then snaps  onto the new page    Drag the widget to its desired position on the new  Screen    Repeat these steps to continue moving it to other  Screens     Managing Wallpapers  Wallpapers consist of either Gallery images  user taken   Live  wallpapers  animated backgrounds   or Wallpaper gallery   default phone wallpapers      Note  Selecting animated Live wallpapers will require    additional battery power     To change the
215. ens  Customizing 65   Homepage  Setting New 263   l    Icons  Description 32  Indicator 32  Status 32  Images  Assigning as a Contact icon 178  Assigning as wallpaper 179  Transferring 341  Verifying 341  Importing and Exporting  To micro SIM card 126    In Call  Options 87  In call  Options 89  Incognito 262  Create Window 262  Exit Window 262  Incoming Call  Vibration Setting 307  Indicator icons 32  International Call 80  International Calls  Making 80  Internet 259  Brightness Setting 260  Search 261  Set Home Page 265  Set New Homepage 263  Internet Email 144  IP Address 352  IR  Smart Remote 27    J  Joining  Contact information 117  L  Language  Select 325  Latitude 233  LDAP 115  Live Wallpaper  Selecting 70  Local 231  Location  Settings 234  Lock Pattern  If   Forgot My Pattern 303  Lock Screen 299  Changing Wallpaper 70  Say Wake Up Command 299  Shortcuts 299  Viewing Missed Calls 97  Logs 94  Accessing 94  Accessing from Notifications 95  Altering Numbers 96    Erasing 96  Lookout Security 231  Low battery indicator 15  LTE  Network Mode 291  Selecting 292  LTE Network 292  M  Making  Emergency Calls 77  International Calls 80  New call 75  Managing Applications  Clearing Application Cache 348  Uninstalling Third party  Applications 348  Market  see Play Store 242  Marking contact  As a default 119  Media  Backing Up to microSD Card 341  Backing Up to PC 340    Memory Card  Erasing Files 73  Merge Calls 90  Merge with Google 115  Message  Options 132  Read 136  Re
216. ensitive      Messages 145    3  Tap Show password to display the password as you  enter it in the associated field      Tap Manual setup to configure your connection settings  manually  POP3 or IMAP   Follow the on screen prompts and  enter the information specific to your email provider      Tap Send email from this account by default to assign this    email account as your default account for all outgoing emails     4  Tap Next    5  Atthe Account options screen  select the frequency  which the device should check for new email on the  server and tap Next     Important  The Sync Email feature must be enabled to allow    synching between your device and the remote  Server       Tap the Notify me when email arrives field to receive new  email notifications      Tap the Automatically download attachments when  connected to Wi Fi field to assist with faster access to large  email attachments when using Wi Fi     146    6  Atthe Setup email screen  name the account and enter   a screen name to identify yourself on this account      The unique account name is used to differentiate this account  from other email accounts accessed by your device    7  Tap Done to store the new account   Messages for this account display on the Inbox tab  You can  also view Personal information for this account  Receipts  if  you setup the account to return receipts   Travel information   and more  if available    Opening an Email  1  From the Home screen  tap ER  gt     Email    2  Tap  account na
217. er compatible device     Displays to alert you to disable an active Wi Fi  Direct connection if not in use   to conserve  battery power     Displays when the USB Tethering mode is active  and communicating  For more information  refer to   USB Tethering  on page 276     Displays when Wi Fi is being used as a Mobile  HotSpot feature is active and communicating   For more information  referto  Mobile HotSpot  on  page 277     HOB naa GE     Displays when a share shot has been established  with other users via a Wi Fi Direct connection     Displays when the Wi Fi calling feature is active   Minutes used while connected to the Wi Fi network  count against available rate plan minutes     Displays when the Wi Fi calling feature is active and    you are using it with within your current active call     Displays when there is an error in the use or 911  registration of the Wi Fi Calling feature     Displays when you are currently in Emergency  calling mode  You must exit this mode to resume  normal calling function     Displays in the notifications window when  a new T Mobile account information is available     Displaysinthe notifications window whenthere are  too many on screen notification icons to display   Tap to show more notifications     Tap to select a text input method        Dgs M    EE     3    Displays in the notifications window when a  song is currently playing within the Music  application     Displays in the notifications window when a song is  currently playing with
218. er experience for first time  smartphone users on the home screens    Tap Apply and give your device a few seconds to   update the device with the new look and feel     Call Settings  1  From the Home screen  tap m   2  Press    and then tap Call settings    or   From the Home screen  press m and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Call   To access the Call settings menu   1  From the Home screen  tap Ww  Phone      2  Press  i and then tap Call settings     Configuring General Call Settings  Configure the general call settings using this option     1     From the Home screen  tap  Phone   Press mI  and then tap Call settings   From the Home screen  press   and then tap    Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Call     Tap one of the following options     Call rejection  allows you to manage your rejection mode and  rejection list       Auto reject mode  sets the phone to automatically reject  incoming calls or messages       Auto reject list  provides access to current rejection entries  and numbers     Setup call rejection messages  allows you to manage both  existing rejection messages and create new ones     Answering ending calls  allows you to manage the settings  for answering and ending calls       The home key answers calls allows you to press   to  answer the phone         Voice control allows you to answer incoming voice calls using  voice       The power key ends calls allows you to press the power key  to end the current call     Turn off screen during call
219. ervice  Gmail is  configured when you first set up your phone    For more information  referto  Using Google Mail  on  page 155     Google    Provides an on screen Internet search engine  powered by Google        For more information  refer to    Google    on page 228     Google     This application makes messaging and   sharing with your friends a lot easier  You can   set up Circles of friends  visit the Stream to get  updates from your Circles  use Messenger for fast  messaging with everyone in your Circles  or use  Instant Upload to automatically upload videos and  photos to your own private album on Google     For more information  refer to    Google      on page  160     e         o    Group Play  This application lets you share documents  photos or  music in real time with other connected friends     For more information  refer to  Group Play  on page  228     Help   The Help app provides additional in device  information on Learning the basics  Applications   Changing important settings  Help settings  and  available Accessories    For more information  refer to  Help  on page 230     Internet    Open the browser to start surfing the Web  The  browser is fully optimized and comes with  advanced functionality to enhance the Internet  browsing feature on your phone     For more information  referto  Internet  on page 259     Local    Displays company locations as markers on Google  Maps  When viewing an area you can quickly locate a  business or person  find out more in
220. ery issues arise from improper  handling of batteries and  particularly  from the  continued use of damaged batteries       Do not disassemble  crush  puncture  shred  or otherwise  attempt to change the form of your battery  Do not put a high  degree of pressure on the battery  This can cause leakage or an  internal short circuit  resulting in overheating     364      Do not let the phone or battery come in contact with liquids   Liquids can get into the phone s circuits  leading to corrosion   Even when the phone appears to be dry and appears to operate  normally  the circuitry could slowly corrode and pose a safety  hazard  If the phone and or battery get wet  have them checked  by your service provider or contact Samsung  even if they appear  to be working properly      Do not place your battery in or near a heat source  Excessive  heating can damage the phone or the battery and could cause the  phone or the battery to explode  Do not dry a wet or damp battery  with an appliance or heat source such as a microwave oven  hair  dryer  iron  or radiator  Avoid leaving your phone in your car in  high temperatures      Do not dispose of the phone or the battery in a fire  The phone  or the battery may explode when overheated      Do not handle a damaged or leaking battery  Do not let leaking  battery fluid come in contact with your eyes  skin or clothing  For  safe disposal options  contact your nearest Samsung authorized  Service center       Avoid dropping the cell phone  Dro
221. esired target playlist    Playing a Playlist   1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt   e  Play Music     2  Selectthe PLAYLISTS tab     3  Tap P next to a playlist title and tap Play   Deleting a Playlist    1     2     From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   QV  Play Music    Display the PLAYLISTS library view     3  Tap P next to a playlist title and tap Delete     Shopping for Music at the Play Store  To visit the Google Play   Store where you can find and buy  music   1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt   Qv  Play Music    2  Tap m  Play Store in the Application Bar   The Google Play Store music section displays     Making Online Music Available Offline    In addition to playing the music that you add to your online  library  you can play music stored on your device s internal  storage  Then you can listen to music when you have no  Internet connection  To do this  make some of your online  music available offline     Tip  You can also copy music directly from your computer to    your device     To make your online music available offline on your device   1  From the Home screen  tap RES  Apps   gt   Qv  Play Music    2  Change your library view to Albums  Artists  or  playlists     Press FA and then select Choose on device music and  tap the album or playlist you want to make available  offline    A blue pin g indicates that the item is already  available offline     Darker pins appear next to the items you can make  available offline  A bar at the bottom o
222. ess and hold for two seconds to  turn toggle the Silent mode or Airplane mode states   turn the device on or off  or Restart    Understanding Your Device 31    Device Display   Your display provides information about the device s status   and is the interface to manage features  The display  indicates your connection status  signal strength  battery  status and time  Icons display at the top of the device when  an incoming call or message is received and also alerts you  at a specified time when an alarm was set  The screen also  displays notifications  and Application  or shortcut  bar with  five primary shortcuts  Phone  Contacts  Messaging  Internet   and Apps     Display settings  In this menu  you can change various settings for the for the  wallpaper  cube  brightness or backlight   m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt       Settings   gt  FILM  My device tab   gt  Display   For more information  refer to    Display Settings    on  page 304     32    Status Bar    The Status Bar shows information about the connection  status  signal strength  phone battery level  and time  and  displays notifications about incoming messages  calls and  other actions    This list identifies the icons you see on your phone   s display  screen     Indicator Icons    This list identifies the symbols you ll see on your device s  display and Indicator area     Note  Some Notification icons can be hidden manually by  toggling the status of the Notification panel function  For  more inform
223. ess to both Power settings  Screen  dimming  and Information  Terms  privacy  amp  notices      Exit navigation  terminates the application     Help  provides on screen help     Applications and Development 239    Optical Reader  The Photo reader allows you to use your camera to identify  text  via definitions  and extract useful information   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   e  Optical Reader    2  Aim the camera at an object containing written words   3  ALign the on screen box atop the target text  Once  detected  the device shows on screen information  such as link and descriptions   Phone  This application provides the ability to make or answering  calls  access the Contacts list  which is used to store contact  information   m From the Home screen  tap W  Phone      For more information  refer to  Call Functions and Contacts  List    on page 75     240    Play Books    Formerly known as Google Books  this application allows you  to read over 3 million ebooks on the go     Build your ebooks library in the cloud with Play Books  jump  right into a bestseller or select from nearly 3 million free  ebooks  Personalize the reader to your liking  pick up reading  where you left off on your phone or computer  and settle  down with a great book on your Android phone     Note  You must logged into your Google account prior to using    this feature     1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt   W Play Books     2  If prompted  tap Turn sync on  This synchronizes your  b
224. etooth   ChatON  Dropbox  Email  Flipboard  Gmail  Google  Google    Messaging  S Memo  or Wi Fi Direct      Find on page  allows you to search in the current page      Incognito mode  pages viewed in incognito mode won t  appear within your browser history or search history  and no  traces  such as cookies  are left on your device  For more  information  refer to  Going Incognito    on page 262    Saved pages  contains web pages you have saved using the  Save page option      History  provides access to your History screen           260      Desktop view  allows you to assign the browser to display the  current page in the desktop view  to closely mimic the display  as it would appear on a Desktop computer       Brightness  allows you to assign a brightness level specifically  for the browser window  This is independent of the brightness  assigned within the device s Settings menu      Print  provides print access on compatible Samsung printers      Settings  allows you to change the way you view your web  pages by changing these options  For more information  refer  to  Browser Settings  on page 265      Help  allows you view additional information concerning the  Internet application          Entering a URL    You can access a website quickly by entering the URL   Websites are optimized for viewing on your phone     To enter a URL and go to a particular website    m From the homepage tap the URL field at the top of the   screen  enter the URL and tap Ifefeg   Search the In
225. ettings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input   2  Tap Default  gt  Swype     Swype Text Entry Tips   You can access the SwypeTips application and watch a video   or tutorial on using Swype  You can also use the following   Swype text entry tips      Create a squiggle  like an S shape  to create a double letter  such  as pp in apple       Touch and hold a key to view the punctuation menu then make a  selection       Move your finger or stylus over the apostrophe to enter  contractions       Double touch on the word you want to change to correct a  misspelled word  then touch the delete key to erase one  character  Touch and hold the delete key to erase an entire word     Entering Text 99    Selecting a Text Input Mode in Swype  1  From a screen where you can enter text  tap the text  input field to reveal the on screen keyboard   2  With Swype as your text entry method  select one of  the following text mode options   Edit      ABC  E    the on screen keyboard       SYM  Symbol        on screen keyboard     to use Swype with alphanumeric characters from    to enter numbers and symbols from the    Note  After typing an initial uppercase character  the key    changes to and all letters that follow are in lower  case     100    Swype Keyboard Overview     Recipients  a field where you can enter the recipients of the  current message  You can choose from Groups  Favorites   Contacts  or Logs      Text Input field  a field where text  number  or other characters  can be enter
226. evice features are in use  Check with local service  providers   To make an emergency call   1  If the mobile device is not on  switch it on   2  From the Home screen  tap WW   3  Key in the emergency number for your present location   for example  911 or other official emergency number    Emergency numbers vary by location     4  Tap EU  If certain features are in use  call blocking  for example   you  may first need to deactivate those features before you can  make an emergency call  Consult your User Manual and your  local cellular service provider  When making an emergency  call  remember to give all the necessary information as  accurately as possible  Remember that your mobile device    Health and Safety Information 369    may be the only means of communication at the scene of an  accident  do not cut off the call until given permission to do  SO     Care and Maintenance    Your mobile device is a product of superior design and  craftsmanship and should be treated with care  The  suggestions below will help you fulfill any warranty  obligations and allow you to enjoy this product for many  years   Keep your Samsung Mobile Device away from   Liquids of any kind  Keep the mobile device dry  Precipitation  humidity  and  liquids contain minerals that will corrode electronic  circuits  If the mobile device does get wet  do not  accelerate drying with the use of an oven  microwave  or  dryer  because this may damage the mobile device and  could cause a fire or explosion   Do
227. eviously configured  room   e Settings  provides access to the Samsung WatchOn settings  menu   e Help  displays on screen help information   e About  displays on screen information about the application     Multimedia 191    Personalize WatchON  You can personalize your application to do things such as  show content only from your selected media categories  or  add an additional room s set top box   To configure your Just for you settings   The Just for you option displays available content matching  your activated media categories  These categories can be  configured during your initial set up or at any later time   1  Sign into your Samsung account   2  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    S  matenon   3  From the main screen Tap  Combined View   gt   Just for you  2t  4  From the On TV tab  press    and then select  Settings   5  Access parameters such as Basic info  Genres and  Sports to then configure and enable those parameters  you would like to show in the Just for you tab     192    To add a new room    Your device can be used to control boxes receivers from  several rooms  You could go from controlling your set top box  in your living room and then move into your bedroom to do  the same     1  Sign into your Samsung account   2  From the Home screen  tap      matenon      3  From the On TV tab  press     and then select  Settings  gt  Add room    4  Name the new room and tap Next    5  Enter your current zip code and tap Done  This zip code  must correspond t
228. exists with a  slightly different name  separate entries are created and can  later be linked  joined  together into a single entry     Important  This process not only synchronizes your contact    information but also your status  events  and more     1  From the Home screen  tap   C    Play Store     2  Search for and select the Facebook app    3  When you are prompted to download the Facebook  application from the Play Store     Tap Install  gt  Accept  amp  download to complete the process     Tap Open to launch the application    4  Log into your Facebook account   e Enter your account s access Email and Password information   and tap Log in    5  If prompted  configure any requested optional   permissions and tap Log in     6  If prompted  select a Contacts Sync option  Choose  from  Sync all  Sync with existing contacts  or Don t  sync    7  Tap Done to complete the login and sync process     To resync Social Network Contacts            1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  Accounts tab and then navigate to the  Accounts area    2  Tap Facebook and toggle the checkmark alongside the  desired fields    3  Choose the parameters to sync  ex  Sync Calendar   Sync Contacts  or Sync Gallery  and tap Syne now     Note  From the main Accounts and sync page you can also tap    Sync all to resync all accounts     Additional Contact Options  Sending an Email to a Contact    Note  Contacts must contain and email account and address  before you can use the S
229. expert witness fees  are  5 000 00 or  less   Small Claim    the arbitrator may  if you prevail  award  your reasonable attorney fees  expert witness fees and costs  as part of any award  but may not grant Samsung Electronics  Co  its attorney fees  expert witness fees or costs unless it is  determined that the claim was brought in bad faith  In a  Small Claim case  you shall be required to pay no more than  half of the total administrative  facility and arbitrator fees  or   50 00 of such fees  whichever is less  and Samsung  Electronics Co  shall pay the remainder of such fees   Administrative  facility and arbitrator fees for arbitrations in  which your total damage claims  exclusive of attorney fees  and expert witness fees  exceed  5 000 00   Large Claim    shall be determined according to AAA rules  In a Large Claim    390    case  the arbitrator may grant to the prevailing party  or  apportion among the parties  reasonable attorney fees   expert witness fees and costs  Judgment may be entered on  the arbitrator s award in any court of competent jurisdiction   This arbitration provision also applies to claims against  Samsung Electronics Co  s employees  representatives and  affiliates if any such claim arises from the licensing or use of  the Software  You may opt out of this dispute resolution  procedure by providing notice to Samsung Electronics Co  no  later than 30 calendar days from the date of the first  consumer purchaser s purchase of this device  To opt out   
230. f prompted to personalize your experience  follow the  on screen instructions     Using WatchON  To change channels   1  Sign into your Samsung account   2  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      watchon      3  From the top of the main screen  tap a  Remote  Control   This launches an on screen set of remote  control tabs  Choose from one of the following   e Easy remote  provides the most common used control  features  Scroll down to view additional functions     5     e  Set top box   displays customized control specific to your  configured set top box  Ex  satellite dish remote control  functions      TV  provides access to control functions specific to your TV    From the top of the main screen tap    Select Room  to choose from different receivers boxes   in different rooms  Ex  Living Room box  Bedroom box    etc     Press  Back  to return to the main menu     Locating your favorite programming     1   2     Sign into your Samsung account    From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt       watchov    From the main screen Tap  Combined View  to  reveal available media categories    Select an available category     or    Tap Guide to display on your TV an on screen listing of  available set top box shows     For additional information on the WatchON application   press  i and then select Help     WatchOn Settings  1  From the Home screen  tap Eg  Apps   gt    S  watcnon    2  Press l   and then select an available on screen  option   e Change Room  allows you to select a pr
231. f the screen  shows how much space is available on your device for  music and other files     Dim blue pins indicate songs or albums that you copied  directly from a computer to your device       Tap the dark pin next to each item you want to make    available offline or tap a blue pin to stop making it  available offline  You can switch to other views of your  library to make other kinds of items available offline as  well       Tap Done in the bar at the bottom of the screen     The Music application starts downloading the items to    your device     Multimedia 199    Music    The Music Player is an application that can play music files   The music player supports files with extensions AAC  AAC    eAAC   MP3  WMA  3GP  MP4  and M4A  Launching the  Music Player allows you to navigate through your music  library  play songs  and create playlists  music files bigger  than 300 KB are displayed     Playing Music   1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt         Music      2  Tap a library category tab to select the music category     Songs  Playlists  Albums  Artists  Music square  or  Folders    3  Scroll through the list and tap an entry to begin  playback     Note  The 5 1 channel sound effect works when earphones or    sound is connected through the headset jack only     200    4  Use any of the following Music player controls     EREHERERNSESADOES HAA    Pause the song   Start the song after pausing     Press and hold to rewind the song  Tap to go to  previous song     P
232. faster  The best way to keep using the device as a  HotSpot is by connecting to a Charger     To connect to the HotSpot    1  Enable Wi Fi  wireless  functionality on your target  device  laptop  media device  etc      2  Scan for Wi Fi networks from the external device and  select your device s Mobile HotSpot name from the  network list      The SSID name for your device s hotspot is determined by what  you entered into the Network SSID field    e You can change the name by tapping Configure  gt  Network  SSID and changing the entry    3  Select this HotSpot and follow your on screen  instructions to complete the connection     278    4  Launch your Web browser to confirm you have an   Internet connection   To change the Portable HotSpot password    1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      Mobile HotSpot     2  Tap Mobile HotSpot  gt  Configure    3  Tap the Security field and select WPA2 PSK    4  With security enabled  delete the previous password  and enter a new one into the Password field     Important  The more complex the password  the harder it will    be for intruders to break your security  It is  recommended that you not use names  birthdays   or other personal information     5  Tap Save to store the new settings     To mange connected devices     This feature allows you to provide MAC filtering on your  device  This is similar to a  VIP list  where only device on the  list are allowed access     1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      Mobile HotSpot    
233. formation about  the business  see coupons  public responses  and  more     For more information  refer to  Local  on page 231     Lookout Security    Lookout Security    provides mobile device specific  security features that are coupled with a minimal  performance hit     For more information  refer to  Lookout Security  on  page 231    Maps   Launches a Web based dynamic map that helps    you find local businesses  locate friends  view maps  and get driving directions     For more information  refer to  Maps  on page 232     Understanding Your Device     47    4    h     48    Messaging  Provides access to text and multimedia messaging   SMS and MMS      For more information  refer to    Creating and Sending  Messages    on page 131     Messenger   Allows you to bring groups of friends together into a  simple group conversation  When you get a new  conversation in Messenger  Google  sends an update  to your phone    For more information  refer to    Messenger    on page  160     Mobile HotSpot    Provides access to the Tethering and Mobile  HotSpot menu where you can use either the USB  tethering or Mobile HotSpot functionality     For more information  refer to    Mobile HotSpot    on  page 235           Music   Launches the built in music player that allows you  to play music files that you have stored on your  microSD card  You can also create playlists     For more information  refer to    Music    on page 200   My Files   Lets you view supported image files and text f
234. from the list     Choose Input Method l   1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt   Default    2  Select an input method    or   Tap Set up input methods to alter modify the available  input methods     Configure Google Voice Typing    1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input   Sor  From a screen where you can enter text  in a single  motion  touch and drag the Status bar down to the  bottom of the screen  then select z  Select input  method   gt  Set up input methods     2  Tap to   adjacent to the Google voice typing field     3  Select a language by tapping Choose input languages  area    4  Remove the check mark from the Automatic field  This  allows you to select additional languages    5  Select the desired languages    6  Activate Block offensive words to block recognition of  known offensive words or language   A blue check  mark indicates the feature is active     7  Tap Download offline speech recognition to enable speech  recognition via locally stored files so that even if you  are not connected to a network you can still use the  service     Changing Your Settings 325    Samsung Keyboard Settings        1     From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt      adjacent to the Samsung keyboard field      or    From within an active text entry screen  touch and hold   Input Methods   drag
235. g  feature  You must be on the cellular network to use the  manage feature     When you have two participants in a multi party session  it  might be necessary to place one of those participants on  hold so that a private conversation can be held with a single  caller  While you are in a multi party call     1  Press mI and then tap Manage conference call     2  Tap  lt   Split Caller  adjacent to the participants you  would like to split from the current multi line call  The  list displays the callers in the order they were dialed     Note  The Manage conference call option is not available for    multi party calls created while using the Wi Fi Calling  feature  You must be on the cellular network to use the  manage feature     3  Tap the participant to which you want to speak  privately   You can now talk privately to that person while the  other participants can continue to converse with each  other  If there is only one other participant  that person  is placed on hold    4  To return to the multi party call  tap the Merge icon  All  of the multi party call participants can now hear each  other     Call Functions and Contacts List 91    Dropping One Participant  1  Press   and then tap Manage conference call  gt   to the right of the number to drop   The participant is disconnected and you can continue  the call with the other participant     2  Tap  fis  to end your conversation with the remaining  caller    Call Waiting  You can answer an incoming call while you have a c
236. g and Deleting Screens    Your phone comes with seven screens  You can delete these  screens and then add them back later     Note  These screens can be deleted and re arranged     Important  Your phone can only contain at most seven screens    and at least one screen     To delete a screen  an  1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Edit page     2  Touch and hold  then drag the undesired screen up to  the Remove tab qup     3  Press to return to the main Home screen     To add a screen     1  From the Home screen  press Ir and then tap  Edit page   2  Tap nm  Add screen   The newly added screen  appears as the last page     3  Press to return to the main Home screen     Understanding Your Device 65    Rearranging the Screens      1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Edit page     2  Touch and hold a screen and then drag it into its new  location  Upper left is screen position  1 and  bottom right is screen last screen   Assigning a New Home Screen  1  From the Home screen  press        and then tap  Edit page  EE  2  Tap E The new Home screen then indicates this  C  Home screen  icon at the top of the selected  Screen     Sharing an App    The device s Applications menu now comes with a feature  that allows you to share information about your selected  applications with external users    1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps      2  Press I and then tap Share apps   3  Place a check mark alongside those applications you  wish to share information about and t
237. g inductive coupling with hearing aids operating in  telecoil mode    Hearing devices may also be rated  Your hearing aid  manufacturer or hearing health professional may help you  find this rating  Higher ratings mean that the hearing device  is relatively immune to interference noise    Under the current industry standard  American National  Standards Institute  ANSI  C63 19  the hearing aid and  wireless mobile device rating values are added together to  indicate how usable they are together  For example  if a    Health and Safety Information 375    hearing aid meets the M2 level rating and the wireless  mobile device meets the M3 level rating  the sum of the two  values equals M5    Under the standard  this should provide the hearing aid user  with normal use while using the hearing aid with the  particular wireless mobile device  A sum of 6 or more would  indicate excellent performance    However  these are not guarantees that all users will be  satisfied  T ratings work similarly     E  FM    cocco y    SS                376    The HAC rating and measurement procedure are described in  the American National Standards Institute  ANSI  C63 19  standard    HAC for Newer Technologies    This phone has been tested and rated for use with hearing  aids for some of the wireless technologies that it uses   However  there may be some newer wireless technologies  used in this phone that have not been tested yet for use with  hearing aids    It is important to try the different fea
238. ge 193     Play Music  Google Music     Launches the built in Google Music Player that  allows you to play music files that you have both  downloaded from Google Music and stored on   your microSD card    For more information  refer to  Play Music  on page  193     Understanding Your Device 49    S    LE       50    Play Store   Formerly known as the  Android Market   it provides  access to downloadable applications  games  music   and movies  The Play Store also allows you to provide  feedback and comments about an application  or flag  an application that might be incompatible with your  phone    For more information  refer to    Play Store  on page  242     POLARIS Office 5   This application is a Microsoft Office compatible  office suite  This application provides a central place  for managing your documents online or offline    For more information  refer to  POLARIS Office 5  on  page 245     S Health    S Health is a wellness application that allows you to  better manage your health by providing you with  relevant information     For more information  referto    S Health  on page 246     S Memo    This application allows you to create memos using  the keypad  your finger  or both  You can add images   voice recordings  and text all in one place     For more information  referto  S Memo  on page 246     S Translator   Allows you can easily translate words and phrases   verbal or text messages  into many different  languages    For more information  referto  S Translator
239. gency responder your location to the best of   your ability  and      Remain on the mobile device for as long as the emergency  responder instructs you    Navigation  Maps  directions  and other navigation data  including data  relating to your current location  may contain inaccurate or  incomplete data  and circumstances can and do change over  time  In some areas  complete information may not be  available  Therefore  you should always visually confirm that  the navigational instructions are consistent with what you see  before following them  All users should pay attention to road  conditions  closures  traffic  and all other factors that may    impact safe driving or walking  Always obey posted road signs     Emergency Calls    This mobile device  like any wireless mobile device  operates  using radio signals  wireless and landline networks  as well  as user programmed functions  which cannot guarantee  connection in all conditions  areas  or circumstances   Therefore  you should never rely solely on any wireless  mobile device for essential communications  medical  emergencies  for example   Before traveling in remote or  underdeveloped areas  plan an alternate method of  contacting emergency services personnel  Remember  to    make or receive any calls  the mobile device must be  switched on and in a service area with adequate signal  strength   Emergency calls may not be possible on all wireless mobile  device networks or when certain network services and or  mobile d
240. gister a Number as Spam 137  Reply 136  159  Thread Options 137  Threads 136  Message Search 139  Message threads 136  Messaging  Adding a Signature 141  Adding Attachments 134  Additional Text 135  Block Unknown Senders 141   143  Creating and sending 131  Creating and Sending Text  Messages 131  Current Message Options 133  Deleting a message 138    401    Draft 132  Google Mail 155  Icons on the Status Bar 130  Insert Smiley 133  Locked 132  Menu Options 132  Options 132  Scheduled Messages 132  Settings 139  Signature 141  Signing into Google Mail 155  Spam 132  Text Templates 144  Translate Text 134  Types of Messages 130  Viewing new 136   micro SIM Card 10  Changing Exisitng PIN 346  Importing and Exporting 126  Insertion 10  Lock 346  Removal 10  Setting Up Lock 346    402    microSD Card  Insertion 11  Removal 11  Microsoft Exchange 109  144  Missed Call  Viewing from Lock Screen 97  Mobile Data  Activate Deactivate 289  Set Data Limit 289  Usage 291  Mobile HotSpot 277  294  Activating 277  Allowed Devices 279  Changing Password 278  Connecting 278  MAC Filtering 279  Mobile HotSpots  Detect and Connect 290  Mobile Networks 290  Data Roaming 291  Mobile Data 291  Mobile Web 259  Entering Text in the Mobile Web  Browser 261    Navigating with the Mobile Web  259  Using Bookmarks 262  Mono  Audio Setup 324  Motion  Activate 56  333  Browse Image 333  Direct Call 333  Mute Pause 333  On 56  333  Overview 55  Settings 331  Smart Alert 333  Zoom 333  Mounting the SD card
241. gle Talk     Note  The Network confirms your login and processes  This    could take up to 5 minutes to complete     Messages 157    ChatON    Provides a global mobile communication service where you  can chat with more than 2 buddies via a group chat  Share  things such as pictures  videos  animation messages   Scribbles   audio  Contacts  Calendar entries  and Location  information     Important  The Samsung account manages the access  information  username password  to several  applications  such as Samsung Link  ChatON  and  Media Hub     For more information  visit  httos   web samsungchaton com        158    Registering with the Service    1     Confirm you have already logged in to your Samsung  account    From the Home screen  tap ae  Apps   gt  e   ChatON     Tap Sign in to log into your Samsung account    or    Tap Skip to continue without logging in     Read the on screen notification about data charges  and tap OK    Select a country code  enter your current phone  number to register with the service  and tap Done   Select either the Terms and conditions or Privacy policy  and read the on screen information  Tap Accept to  continue    Choose to receive the verification code via either SMS   text message  or Voice  answering machine call  to  your device     Note  If you opt to receive the verification code via SMS  this    information is sent directly to your device  Once  received  the Verification field is automatically filled in     8  Enter your real name and 
242. gt  TTY mode     3  Tap TTY Full  TTY HCO  or TTY VCO to activate the    feature  or TTY Off to deactivate the feature  Off is the  default setting     Blocking Mode    When Blocking mode is enabled  notifications for selected  features will be disabled  You will only receive notifications of  incoming calls from people on your allowed list     1     2     From the Home screen  press sl and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab     In a single motion touch and slide the Blocking mode  slider to the right to turn it on    Confirm the Blocking mode active icon appears in  the Status bar    Place a green check mark adjacent to those features  you would like to enable  Choose from  Disable  incoming calls  Disable notifications  Disable alarm and  timer  Disable LED indicator    Configure a timeframe for these features to be active   Remove the check mark from the Always field to  configure the From and To time fields     5  Tap Allowed contacts to assign those contacts that are    exempted from these rules  Choose from None  All  contacts  Favorites  or Custom  Allowed contacts will  then appear in the Allowed contact list     Power Saving Mode    This feature allows you both automatically set the phone to  use a power saving mode and configure additional power  saving options manually  all in an effort to conserve battery  power     1     From the Home screen  press      and then tap   Settings  gt   My device tab  Power saving   mode    In a single motion touch and slide the 
243. h an  empty area    2  Touch and hold an empty area of the screen    3  From the Home screen window  tap Apps and widgets  2 Apps     4  Scroll across the pages and in a single motion  touch  and hold an application to place a copy on the current  screen    To delete a shortcut    1  From the Home screen  touch and hold the desired  shortcut  This unlocks it from its location on the current  screen    2  Drag the shortcut over the Remove tab qup and  release it     Adding and Removing Primary Shortcuts    Note  You can change any of your primary shortcuts with the  exception of the Apps shortcut     To remove a primary shortcut    m From the Home screen  touch and hold the primary  shortcut you want to replace  then drag it to an empty  space on any available screen  The primary shortcuts  are now updated to show an empty slot     Understanding Your Device     67    To insert a new primary shortcut   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps      2  Locate your desired application  then touch and hold  the on screen icon to position it on a desired screen   For more information  refer to  Managing Shortcuts   on page 66     3  Locate the screen with the desired shortcut you want    to add as the new primary shortcut     4  Touch and hold the shortcut until it detaches from the    Screen   5  Inasingle motion  touch and hold the new shortcut   then drag it into the empty space within the row of    primary shortcuts  The new primary shortcut will now    appear on both the Home and Ext
244. h and hold a desired app until it  detaches from the panel  then carefully drag it to a new  location in the list of apps  Lift your finger or stylus off  the screen to let go of the app and drop it into its new  location     To remove a Multi window application     1   2     60    Activate the Multi window feature    Tap the tab to display the apps panel  containing the  scrollable apps     Tap the Edit button  located at the bottom of the list  to  reveal a staging area that can house any removed  applications from the Multi window panel     4     Tap Done once you have completed the removal  process     To restore a Multi window application     1   2     Activate the Multi window feature    Tap the tab to display the apps panel  containing the  scrollable apps     Tap the Edit button  located at the bottom of the list  to  reveal the staging area containing any previously  removed apps    Locate the desired application    In a single motion  touch and hold a desired app until it  detaches from the staging area  then carefully drag it  to a new location in the current list of apps     Using Multi Window to run multiple apps on the  same screen  Any of the apps found within the Multi window panel can be  run at the same time as a current on screen app   Once multiple apps are running on the same screen  you can  then choose to either swap their positions or maximize a  desired app     Note  Only applications found within the Multi window panel    can be active atop another c
245. he connection is  established a drive letter is assigned to the phone s  Storage device    5  To disconnect the new drive  simply remove the USB  cable from your device     Unmounting the SD card  Unmounting the SD card prevents corruption and damage to  the SD card while removing it from the slot    1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Storage  l   2  Tap Unmount SD card  gt  OK    3  After the    SD card will be unmounted    message  displays and the Mount SD card now appears in the  menu list  remove the SD card  For more information   refer to    Removing the microSD Memory Card    on  page 11    SD card Memory Status  To view the memory allocation for your external SD card    m From the Home screen  press        and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Storage      The available memory displays under both the Device  memory and SD card headings     Erasing Files from the SD card  To erase files from the SD card using the device    1  Ensure the SD card is mounted  _   2  From the Home screen  press    1 and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Storage  gt  Mount SD card    3  Tap Format SD card  gt  Format SD card  gt  Delete all to  format the SD card  The SD card formats and erases all  the data stored on it     Memory Card   73    Factory Data Reset    From this menu you can reset your phone and sound settings  to the factory default settings     1  From the Home screen  press ri and then tap  Settings  gt   Accounts tab   gt  
246. he events in a List view     Task  allows you to search for tasks       Tap ES  Create event  to create a new Calendar    event     or    Tap Today to display the current date indicated by a   blue box  then press          and select one of the   following options      Go to  displays a specific da     Delete  allows you to delete All events  All events before today   or an individual event      Search  allows you to search within your current events      Sync  synchronizes your current calendar events with your  available accounts  such as Gmail  Microsoft Exchange  ActiveSync  etc         Settings  displays a list of configurable settings     E          Applications and Development 217    Creating a Calendar Event    1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   te  31  Calendar    2  Within the Year  Month  Week  and Day tabs  ES   Create event  to create a new Calendar event   Calendar Settings    Using the Calendar settings you can select the day with  which you want the calendar to begin  You also select how  you want to view the calendar  by Month  Week  or Day or  determine how to manage events  notifications  sounds  and  defaults reminders     1   2   3     218    From the Home Screen  tap EH  Apps   gt  KT    Press Im Settings  7   Tap View styles and select an option      Tap Month view styles and select an option    Tap Week view and select a type    Tap First day of week and select either Local default   Saturday  Sunday or Monday    Tap Hide declined events to a
247. he phone to  self adjust and tap OK    or   Touch and slide the on screen slider to adjust the level  and tap OK   Assigning a Wallpaper  The Wallpaper settings option allows you to set the Wallpaper  for your Home screen  Lock screen  or both   1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Display  gt  Wallpaper   2  Select an available option to change its current  wallpaper     For more information  refer to    Managing Wallpapers    on  page 69     306    LED Indicator    This option allows you to turn on your LED lights for charging   missed events  and incoming notifications  The light will turn  on by default unless you turn them off   1  From the Home screen  press E and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  LED indicator   2  Tapthe following LED indicator options to turn them on  or off     Charging  LED lights up when the device is connected to the  charger     Low battery  LED lights up when the battery level is low     Notifications  LED lights up when you have missed calls   messages  or application events     Voice recording  LED lights up when you are recording voice   The LED only lights up when the screen is off     Sound Settings  From this menu you can control the sounds on the phone as  well as configure the display settings   m From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Sound   The following options display   Silent mode via Device Options Screen  Silent mode is convenient when
248. hin the Applications  Screens        The Application screens can be accessed by tapping ERE   Apps  from the Primary shortcuts area        Shortcuts can be removed from a screen and added back any  number of times     Understanding Your Device 41      Primary Shortcuts  are four shortcuts present throughout all of  the available screens and can be used to both navigate within the  device or launch any of the following functions        Phone N launches the phone related screen functions   Keypad  Logs  Favorites  and Contacts        Contacts E   launches the Contacts related screens   Phone  Groups  Favorites  and Contacts        Messaging   Ne   launches the Messaging menu  create new  messages or open an existing message string        Internet      launches the built in Web browser       Apps launches the Applications page   Tap  Apps  to access the Applications screens   While in the Applications screens  tap  Back  to easily  return to the Home screen     As you transition from screen to screen  a screen indicator   located at the bottom  displays the currently active panel     42    Home Screen Menu Settings   When on the Home screen  press   I and then select any of   the following menu options       Add apps and widgets allows you to quickly access the Widget  tab where you can then drag a selected widget to an available  area on a selected screen      Create folder allows you to create on screen folders to help  organize files of application shortcuts      Set wallpape
249. hin the Exchange account     Customized list allows you to enable which accoun  categories are displayed  For example  on Google coi                s currently    t  ntacts  you       can filter which Contact categories are shown  Frien  etc       Contacts    ds  Family     123    Adding more Contacts via Accounts  and Sync  When you synchronize applications such as Facebook   Twitter  MySpace  a corporate email account  or Google   using the Accounts and sync option synchronizes the data  from the selected account type with your Contacts list    1  From the Home screen  press m  and then tap  Settings  gt  A  Accounts tab  and then navigate  to the My accounts area    2  Tap Add account    3  Determine which type of account information you want  to synchronize with your Contact list  Selections are   Samsung account  ChatON  Dropbox  Email  Google   LDAP  Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync  or Sync apps with  Facebook    4  Tapan account type to add    5  Follow the prompts  The selected account type  synchronizes with your Contacts list    6  After synchronizing accounts you may want to link  contact information  For more information  refer to     Joining Contact Information  on page 117     124    To add Facebook content to your Contacts list     You can now add your Facebook contact information  such as  pictures  email  and phone numbers directly to your Contacts  list  All of their current contact information is then migrated  over to your phone  If a Contacts entry already 
250. his opens the image in the  preview window     place a colored border around the selected images     3  Select the remote storage location  ex  Dropbox    4  Selectthe target folder location and select Upload  The    device then confirms the available storage locations  and begin the process of uploading the selected  images     208    To upload a video on your device to Web storage     From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt     EN  Gallery      2  Select a folder location  ex  Camera  and touch and    hold a video to place a colored border around the  selected file       Tap  gt  Dropbox from the top of the Gallery    screen  The device then confirms the available storage  locations and begin the process of uploading the  selected video     Sharing Media via Samsung Link to a Target  Device    Important  Make sure all communicating devices are  connected to the same Wi Fi     1  Launch AllShare Play Samsung Link on the target  device  such as an Internet TV  Samsung Tablet  etc      2  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt         Samsung Link      Note  You must be signed in to your Samsung Account before    you can use this feature     3  Tap your device name from the Registered devices  area   4  Tap an available category tab  Pictures  Music  Movies    Files  or Info  and select a file    e A file with N  in the upper left indicates it is stored remotely  on a Web storage location  Selecting this media causes your  device to access the file currently stored on your servi
251. ia   3  Tap Select all to place a check mark alongside all  currently displayed Contact entries   4  Tap Done and select a delivery method     Bluetooth to transmit the contacts to another Bluetooth   compatible device     ChatON to send the contacts to selected buddies     Dropbox  if activated  is used to upload the entries to your  remote Dropbox Web storage location     Note  The Web storage Upload feature requires that you be  logged into your Samsung account prior to upload       Email to attach the contact cards to a new outgoing email   Exchange or Internet     Gmail to attach the contact cards to a new outgoing Internet   based email       Messaging to attach the contact cards to a new outgoing text  message      Wi Fi Direct to transmit the entries to another Wi Fi Direct  enabled device     Sending a namecard using Bluetooth    You must create a Contact prior to sending a namecard to a  recipient  For more information  refer to  Creating a Contact   on page 108   1  From the Home screen  tap B   2  Touch and hold the entry to reveal the on screen  context menu     3  Tap Share namecard via  gt  Bluetooth     Important  You must activate Bluetooth to use this feature     4  Tap the Bluetooth device in which to send this name    card  Bluetooth forwards the namecard to the recipient     Copying Contact Information  Copying Contact Information to the SIM Card  The default storage location for saving phone numbers to  your Contacts list is your phone   s built in memor
252. ia Audio      can hear the other person but they can t hear me         want to use my Bluetooth device only as a headphone  1  Verify Bluetooth is active   2  From the Bluetooth settings page  tap o  Settings    3  Toggle the Call audio field to activate de activate the  Bluetooth device s on board microphone   4  Toggle the Media audio field to activate de activate the  Bluetooth device s headset functions     Note  If callers can not hear you during a call while using a    paired Bluetooth headset  with built in microphone    verify the Call audio option is enabled within the entry s  Bluetooth Settings page     270    Disconnecting a Paired Bluetooth Device  Disconnecting a paired device breaks the connection  between the device and your phone  but retains the  knowledge of the pairing  At a later point when you wish to  reconnect the device  there is no need to setup the  connection information again    1  Verify your Bluetooth is active    2  From the Bluetooth settings page  tap the previously  paired device  from the bottom of the page     3  Tap OK to confirm disconnection     Note  Disconnections are manually done but often occur  automatically if the paired device goes out of range of  your phone or it is powered off     Deleting a Paired Bluetooth Device    Deleting a device from your list removes its  connection  record  and upon reconnection would require that you  re enter all the previous pairing information   1  Verify Bluetooth is active   2  From the Bluetoo
253. iar names     Tap Updates to update the application if new software  is available                    Changing Your Settings 329    Configuring Voice Input Recognition  This feature allows the device to correctly recognize verbal  input  uM  1  From the Home screen  press        and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input   2  Tap Voice search to configure the following      Language  choose a language for your voice input    Speech output  Sets whether you will use speech output  always or only when using hands free      Block offensive words  enable or disable blocking of  recognized offensive words from the results of your voice input  Google searches      Hotword detection  enable to being able to launch voice  Search by saying the word  Google       Download offline speech recognition  enables voice input  while offline      Personalized recognition  enables the improvement of  Speech recognition accuracy      Google Account dashboard  allows you to manage your  collected data     330      Bluetooth headset  records audio through a connected  Bluetooth headset   3  Press    gt  to return to the previous screen   Configuring Text to speech  This feature allows the device to provide a verbal readout of  on screen data such as messages and incoming caller  information  This action is called TTS  Text To Speech     1  From the Home screen  press   1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt   Text to speech options    2  Sele
254. ice tab  gt  Sound    2  Tap Dialing keypad tone to activate a tone when you  use on screen keys  A check mark displayed next to  these features indicates active status    3  Tap Touch sounds to activate a tone when you touch the  screen  A check mark displayed next to this feature  indicates active status    4  Tap Screen lock sound to activate a tone when you use  the Lock screen  A check mark displayed next to this  feature indicates active status    5  Tap Haptic feedback to activate the a vibration when  you press soft keys on certain screens  A check mark  displayed next to the feature indicates this feature is  active     Adapt sound    The Adapt sound feature allows you to customize your call  sounds     1     From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Sound  gt  Adapt Sound   Read the instructions and tap Start    Follow the on screen instructions to set up your  personal call sound     Changing Your Settings 309    Home Screen Mode    This application allows you to set your display to the  conventional layout of Standard mode or provide an easier  user experience for the first time smartphone users using  Easy mode     1     310    From the ji screen  press    and then tap    Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  E Home    screen mode      Tap the pull down Dropbox and select one of the   following options      Standard mode  provides conventional layout for the apps and  widgets on your home screens      Easy mode  provides easier us
255. iles  on both your internal storage and microSD card   Organize and store data  images  and more in your  own personal file folders  Files are stored to either the  internal storage or memory card in separate  user  defined  folders    For more information  referto    My Files    on page 236     Navigation  Launches a Web based navigation application     Caution  Traffic data is not real time and directions  may be wrong  dangerous  prohibited  or  involve ferries     For more information  refer to    Navigation    on page  238     e    i3    Optical Reader   Allows you to use your camera to identify text and  extract useful information    For more information  refer to  Optical Reader  on  page 240    Phone   Provides the ability to make or answering calls   access the Contacts list  which is used to store  contact information    For more information  refer to  Call Functions and  Contacts List  on page 75    Play Books   Provides access to read over 3 million ebooks on the  go     For more information  refer to  Play Books  on page  240     E    E         L       T    Play Magazines   With Google Play Magazines  you can subscribe to  your favorite magazines and have them available to  read on your phone at any time or any place    For more information  refer to  Play Magazines  on  page 241     Play Movies  amp  TV   Rent movies and TV shows on Google Play    and  watch instantly using the Google Play Movies app   For more information  refer to  Play Movies  amp  TV  on  pa
256. in the Play Music application     Displays when your device s GPS is on and  communicating     Displays when the external SD card  internal  microSD  has been disconnected  unmounted   from the phone and is now ready for either removal  or formatting     Displays when the External SD card is being  prepared for mounting to the device  This is  required for communication with the External SD  card     Displays when the microSD card has been  improperly removed or unexpectedly     Displays when storage within either the internal  location or the external SD card has reached its  capacity  It is recommended you either move   files off or delete them to make additional room     Understanding Your Device     37    E  Displays when Power saving mode is enabled     Displays when the Power saving alert notification  has been activated  You are then prompted to view  your current battery level     Displays when TTY device has been inserted     TTY    For more details on configuring your phone   s settings  see     Changing Your Settings    on page 280   Notification Bar   The Notification area indicates new message events  data   sync status  new messages  calendar events  call status    etc   You can expand this area to display the Notification   screen that provides more detailed information about the   current on screen notification icons    1  Touch the Status bar to reveal the Notifications tab  and   then drag the tab to the bottom of the screen to open  the Notifications panel 
257. ing feature        While Wi Fi Calling mode is active  the call button shows a  Wi Fi indicator    When Wi Fi Calling is disabled  the call button goes back to    show normal operation       In Call Options    Your device provides a number of features that are available  for use during a call           Personalized Call duration  call sound  Places a    call on hold  Dialer  Noise Extra volume  Reduction  Adds a S9 Bm Ends the  new call call  O A     Activates or        5m  mp                Activates or  Deactivates   Deactivates  speakerphone Mutes or Unmutes Bluetooth  the call Headset    Note  Noise reduction and Extra volume features are disabled  while using Wi Fi Calling     Adjusting the Call Volume  During a call  use the Volume keys on the left side of the  device  to adjust the earpiece volume    m During a call  press the Up volume key to increase the  volume level and the Down volume key to decrease the  level     or    Adjust the audio by enabling selecting an audio preset    Tap the on screen Personalize call sound button select   an equalizer setting for the incoming call      Enabled disabled via the Call settings menu  Call settings  gt   Personalize call sound   For more information  refer to     Configuring General Call Settings    on page 311     or    Quickly add more volume to the incoming audio by   tapping the on screen Extra volume button    From the Home screen  you can also adjust the ring volume  using these keys     Call Functions and Contacts Li
258. ing to the American Arbitration  Association  AAA  Commercial Arbitration Rules applicable to  consumer disputes  This arbitration provision is entered  pursuant to the Federal Arbitration Act  The laws of the State  of Texas  without reference to its choice of laws principles   shall govern the interpretation of the Limited Warranty and all  disputes that are subject to this arbitration provision  The  arbitrator shall decide all issues of interpretation and  application of this arbitration provision and the Limited  Warranty     382    For any arbitration in which your total damage claims   exclusive of attorney fees and expert witness fees  are   5 000 00 or less   Small Claim    the arbitrator may  if you  prevail  award your reasonable attorney fees  expert witness  fees and costs as part of any award  but may not grant  SAMSUNG its attorney fees  expert witness fees or costs  unless it is determined that the claim was brought in bad  faith  In a Small Claim case  you shall be required to pay no  more than half of the total administrative  facility and  arbitrator fees  or  50 00 of such fees  whichever is less  and  SAMSUNG shall pay the remainder of such fees   Administrative  facility and arbitrator fees for arbitrations in  which your total damage claims  exclusive of attorney fees  and expert witness fees  exceed  5 000 00   Large Claim    shall be determined according to AAA rules  In a Large Claim  case  the arbitrator may grant to the prevailing party  or  apport
259. ion  coverage  Bluetooth  4G 3G   Wi Fi communication  battery levels  GPS  etc      Home Screen is a customizable screen that provides information  about notifications and device status  and allows access to  application Widgets      Extended Home Screens extend beyond the current visible  screen width to provide more space for adding icons  widgets   and other customization features        There are six available extended screens  panels  each of  which may be populated with its own shortcuts or widgets   These screens share the use of the five Primary Shortcuts        The current screen is indicated at the bottom by a white  square  Up to seven  7  total screens are available     Note  Both the status bar and primary shortcuts are visible    across all screens        Google search is an on screen Internet search engine powered  by Google     Tap to access the Voice Actions feature where you  can verbally enter a search term and initiate an online search         Tap U  Voice Actions  to launch the function from within  this Google widget       Widgets are self contained on screen applications  not  shortcuts   These can be placed onto any of the available screens   Home or extended       Shortcuts are icons that launch available device applications  such as Camera  YouTube  Contacts  Phone  Email  Play Store   etc  These function the same as shortcuts on your computer        Although some may already be found on the Extended Home  screens  the majority can also be found wit
260. ion among the parties  reasonable attorney fees   expert witness fees and costs  Judgment may be entered on  the arbitrator s award in any court of competent jurisdiction   This arbitration provision also applies to claims against  SAMSUNG s employees  representatives and affiliates if any  such claim arises from the Product s sale  condition or  performance     You may opt out of this dispute resolution procedure by  providing notice to SAMSUNG no later than 30 calendar days  from the date of the first consumer purchaser s purchase of the  Product  To opt out  you must send notice by e mail to  optout sta samsung com  with the subject line     Arbitration  Opt Out     You must include in the opt out e mail  a  your name  and address   b  the date on which the Product was purchased    c  the Product model name or model number  and  d  the IMEI  or MEID or Serial Number  as applicable  if you have it  the IMEI  or MEID or Serial Number can be found  i  on the Product box    ii  on the Product information screen  which can be found  under    Settings      iii  on a label on the back of the Product  beneath the battery  if the battery is removable  and  iv  on the  outside of the Product if the battery is not removable    Alternatively  you may opt out by calling 1 888 987 4357 no  later than 30 calendar days from the date of the first consumer  purchaser   s purchase of the Product and providing the same  information  These are the only two forms of notice that will be  effecti
261. ion sensation as you  enter text using the keypad     Sound on keypress  tums on sounds generated by the Swype  application     Show helpful tips  turns on a flashing indicator for quick help     328      Auto spacing  automatically inserts a space between words   When you finish a word  just lift your finger or stylus and start  the next word      Auto capitalization  automatically capitalizes the first letter of  a sentence      Show complete trace  once enabled  sets wether or not to  display the complete Swype path    Pop up on keypress  once enabled  displays a character  above an on screen key while typing    Next word prediction  once enabled  predicts the next word in  your text string based on your current text entries     Note  If incorrect words are being entered as you type   disabled this feature     Reset Swype   s dictionary  once enabled  deletes any words  you have added to Swype s dictionary     Version  displays the software version information   5  Tap Language Options to activate and select the current  text input language  Default language is US English     Living language  allows you to automatically update Swype  with popular new words  Tap OK to continue the process     6  Tap Swype Connect to activate social media  personalization and configure data settings      Register now  allows you register for the Swype Connect  Service which allows you to backup your Swype dictionary and  sync your Swype dictionary across multiple devices        Follow the on
262. ion services  For more information   refer to  Location Services  on page 344     232    Enabling a Location source  Before you use Google Maps and find your location or search  for places of interest  you must enable a location source  To  enable the location source you must enable the wireless  network  or enable the GPS satellites     Important  The more location determining functions are  enabled  the more accurate the determination will  be of your position     1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Location services    2  Tap Use GPS satellites to enable the GPS satellite    3  Tap Use wireless networks to allow apps to use data  from sources such as Wi Fi and mobile networks to  provide a better approximation of your current location    4  Tap My places to enable the storage of your favorite  locations     To receive better GPS signals  avoid using your device in the  following conditions     inside a building or between buildings    e in a tunnel or underground passage    in poor weather    around high voltage or electromagnetic fields      in a vehicle with tinted windows    Opening Maps    1     From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt    Du  Maps     Tap the upper right My location button to find your   location on the map with a blinking blue dot    Locate the bottom row of the buttons to access   additional options      Search  allows you to search for a place of interest      Directions  displays navigation directions to a
263. ired headset  or through a wireless  Bluetooth stereo headset   Press the volume keys on the side of the device to activate    on screen volume control  then touch and drag on the scale  to set volume        Multimedia 195    Playing Music    1     Note  If you navigate away from the Now playing screen in the    From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    Qr  Play Music     Tap a song in your library to listen to it     or    While viewing a list of songs  tap P  Options  next to  a song and tap Play     While viewing a list of albums  artists  playlists  or    genres  tap P  Options  adjacent to the label and tap  Play     The Now playing screen opens and the song you  touched or the first song in the album or playlist starts  to play  The tracks in the current list play in order until  you reach the end of the list  unless you choose a  repeat option   Otherwise  playback stops only if you  stop it  even when you switch applications     Music application  the Now Playing bar appears at the  bottom of the screen     196    Displaying the Now Playing Screen  If you navigate away from the Now playing screen  to return  to the Now playing screen from other Music screens     m Tap the name of the current song in the Now Playing    bar     or    In a single motion  touch and drag  Music  notification icon  down from the Status bar and tap the  song title from the Notifications area  You can also  pause and resume playback and skip to the next song  in the panel  For more informati
264. is process is  similar to changing your password from time to time    1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen    2  Tap Screen lock    Retrace your current pattern on the screen    4  Tap Pattern and repeat steps 3   7 from the previous   section     302    Deleting the Screen Lock Pattern  1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen   2  Tap Screen lock   3  Retrace your current pattern on the screen   4  Tap None   Pattern options  Once an unlock pattern is enabled  additional options are  available     Lock screen widgets allows you to lock the widgets that are  displayed on your home screens     Make pattern visible allows you to see the pattern as you  draw it     Lock automatically allows you to set a time out for lock  Screen     Lock instantly with power key allows you to lock the screen  by pressing       e      What If   Forget my Pattern     If you forget your device s lock pattern  you can unlock your  device or reset it using your Google    Account credentials   When you enter the wrong unlock pattern too many times   you should see an option at the bottom of the screen that  says Forgot pattern  Follow these steps to use either your PIN  or email address     Important  You can only enter an incorrect lock pattern 5 times    before the device is locked     Important  If you are unsuccessful in retrieving your lock    pattern or unlocking your device  please conta
265. it incorporates a substantial margin of safety  to give additional protection to the public and to account for  any variations in measurements     SAR tests are conducted using standard operating positions  accepted by the FCC with the phone transmitting at its  highest certified power level in all tested frequency bands   Although the SAR is determined at the highest certified  power level  the actual SAR level of the phone while  operating can be well below the maximum reported value   This is because the phone is designed to operate at multiple  power levels so as to use only the power required to reach  the network  In general  the closer you are to a wireless base  station antenna  the lower the power output of the phone     Before a new model phone is available for sale to the public   it must be tested and certified to the FCC that it does not  exceed the SAR limit established by the FCC  Tests for each  model phone are performed in positions and locations  e g  at  the ear and worn on the body  as required by the FCC  For  body worn operation  this phone has been tested and meets  FCC RF exposure guidelines when used with an accessory  that contains no metal and that positions the mobile device a  minimum of 1 0cm from the body     Use of other accessories may not ensure compliance with  FCC RF exposure guidelines  The FCC has granted an  Equipment Authorization for this mobile device with all  reported SAR levels evaluated as in compliance with the FCC  RF exposure g
266. lect the connected   devices you would like to allow    Tap Not allowed devices list  then select the connected   devices you would like to not allow    Tap Download to  then select the destination of any   downloaded  shared  content  Choose from USB   storage  Device  or SD card     Changing Your Settings 297    9  Tap Upload from other devices  then select the actions  you ll take when you upload content from other  devices  Choose from either Always accept  Always  ask  or Always reject     Screen Mirroring    With feature enabled  you can wirelessly mirror what is  currently displayed on your device s screen with an external  TV via devices such as the AllShare Cast Hub       Note  Screen mirroring can only be done with a compatible  wireless TV or one enabled with the AllShare Cast Hub     For more information  refer to  AllShare Cast Hub  on page  210     1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Screen Mirroring    2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Screen Mirroring  slider to the right to turn it on  The slider color indicates  the activation status     298    Note  This feature allows a connection between your device    and the optional AllShare Cast Hub  via a shared Wi Fi  Direct connection  The AllShare Cast Hub then allows  the communicating TV to mirror what is being shown on  the device s display     For more information  refer to  AllShare Cast Hub    on page  210   Kies via Wi Fi  1  From the Home screen  press  
267. lected  enter your  group password and tap OK  Mobile AP is enabled    5  Tap one of the media items listed under the Share and  play content heading    6  Tapto select the items you want to share  indicated by  a checkmark   then tap Done or OK     7  Have your friends sign onto Group Play from their  devices  see below  and they can view your media  using you as a Mobile AP    Joining a group  A joiner is the participant of an already created group  You  can only view and interact with media shared by the leader  of an existing group    1  Connectto an active Wireless Access Point and confirm  your connection is this same Wi Fi as the group leader    2  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    Ea   Group Play     3  Tap Join group  Your device then scans for available  groups for you to join    4  Select a group to join  Once connected  you can then  select the shared content and interact with your  group s shared media    5  Press  re and select Help for additional information     Applications and Development 229    Help    Provides access to built in Help information   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      tte    2  Select an on screen topics for more information      New features  provides help on all of the new features and  applications such as Motion  Camera  Group Play  etc      Basics  provides basic information on using your device      Applications  provides information on how to use basic  applications like Contacts  Email  S Memo  Internet  Camera   etc   
268. lection mode       Select all  select the entire area of the current image    e Clipboard  copies the currently selected are to your device s  clipboard    5  Use the following editor controls to edit your picture      5     Previous  move to previous photo project   Next  move to next photo project     Cancel Delete  exits the current photo editing  Session     Save  stores the curerntly edited photo     Rotate  allows you to rotate a photo in all 4  directions  You can also mirror image a photo     g E    E BE    Crop  allows you to crop  cut out  an area of a  photo     Color  allows you to Auto adjust color  Brightness   Contrast  Saturation  Adjust RGB  Temperature   Exposure  and Hue of a photo     Effects  allows you to add various effects to your  photo     Portrait  allows you to apply various face  correction effects such as  Red eye fix  Airbrush  face  Face brightness  Out of focus  Beauty face   Funny face  or Spot healing     Sticker  allows you to place various pre created  on screen stickers atop your current image     Drawing  allows you to add draw directly on your  current picture by using either a brush pen or  eraser     Frame  places a pre created border style atop  your current image     6  Press CJ to access the following options       Save as  allows you to rename your current image and save it  to your gallery      Select image  allows you to select a new image for editing      Take picture  allows you to activate the camera and take a  new image for
269. less networks and displays them under  Wi Fi networks on the same screen    Connecting to a Wi Fi Network   1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi    The network names and security settings  Open  network or Secured with WEP  of detected Wi Fi  networks display in the Wi Fi networks section        2  Tap the network you wish to connect to     Note  When you select an open network you are automatically    connected     Connections 273    3  Enter a wireless password  if necessary   Manually Add a New Network Connection    4  Tap Connect  1  From the Wi Fi network screen  tap Add Wi Fi network   Wi Fi Status Indicators 2  Enter the Network SSID  the name of your Wireless  The following icons indicate the Wi Fi connection status  Access Point    p Displays when Wi Fi is connected  active  and 3  Tap the Security field and select a security option  This  T  communicating with a Wireless Access Point must match the current security setting on your target   WAP   WAP   ES Displays when Wi Fi is active and there is an 4  Enter your WAP s password if the WAP is secure   fg available open wireless network  5  Tap Connect to store the new information and connect  PS Displays when Wi Fi Direct is active and to the target WAP    J configured for a direct connection to another                           compatible device in the same direct Note  No prompt to enter the WAP key displays if this is the  communication mode  second time to connec
270. let  the camera automatically adjust the ISO for each of your shots       Anti Shake  compensates fo    r camera movement     Multimedia 167    168      Auto night detection  activates or deactivates the night    detection fe  e Save as  al  Camcorder     Video size   for higher q  memory     Video stabi    Settings     ature           GPS tag  al    ach a GPS location tag to    lows you to assign rich tone usage to an image     Select a resolution for videos  Use higher resolution  ality  Higher resolution videos take up more    lization  Activate or deactivate Optical Image  Stabilization     he photo  To improve    GPS signals  avoid shooting in locations where the signal may    be obstructed  such as between buildin    or in poor weather conditions  Your location may appear on    your photos       when you upload them to    gs or in low lying areas     he Internet     To avoid this  deactivate the GPS tag setting     e Review  set this option if you want to vi       you take it  Select a time value   Volume key  assigns a function to the volume key  Choose    from The zoom key           iew each picture after    The camera key  or The record key       Timer  Use this for delayed time shots  You can set the timer to  Off  2 sec  5 sec  or 10 sec    White balance  Select an appropriate white balance  so  images have a true to life color range  The settings are  designed for specific lighting situations  These settings are  similar to the heat range for white balance exposur
271. limited  Minutes used  while connected to the Wi Fi network count against available  rate plan minutes   The benefits of Wi Fi Calling include the following     Wi Fi Calling provides a coverage option to improve upon your   current in home coverage experience     Wi Fi Calling works anywhere there is a Wi Fi signal available    Important  A new micro SIM card must be installed within the    device prior to using this feature  Wi Fi must first  be active and communicating prior to launching  Wi Fi Calling     Note  This feature is active by default  If you are in an active    Wi Fi call and go out of range of your Wi Fi  the call will  be dropped     84    Activating Wi Fi mu  1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  femme  Connections tab      2  Locate the Wi Fi field  and in a single motion touch and  slide to the right to turn it on   The slider color indicates the activation status    3  Select a Wi Fi network from the list of available  networks  Follow the on screen instructions to  complete connection     F Wi Fi Connected  Displays when Wi Fi is connected  active  and    communicating with a Wireless Access Point     WAP    E Wi Fi Communication Issue    Y Displays when Wi Fi is active and there is an  available open wireless network     Note  To avoid international data roaming fees when using  Wi Fi calling when outside the United States  the Data  Roaming feature on your device must be turned off     Note  With certain rate plans  minutes used
272. llpaper  gt  Lock screen    Select a Wallpaper type      Tap Gallery to select from a user image stored in the camera  image gallery  crop the image  and tap Done      Tap Travel wallpaper to display recommended destination  images on your lock screen  Select a slideshow interval      Tap Wallpaper  scroll through the images  tap a wallpaper  image  then tap Set wallpaper     Section 3  Memory Card    Your device lets you use a microSD card  also referred to as a  memory card  to expand available memory space  This  secure digital card enables you to exchange images  music   and data between SD compatible devices  This section  addresses the features and options of your device s SD  functionality  The device has a USB SD card mode      microSD memory cards include capacities of up to 2GB      microSDHC    memory card types can range from 4GB to up to  326B      microSDXC    memory card types can include capacities greater  than 32GB   Using the SD Card  There are several methods for using the SD card   1  Connecting to your PC to store files  such as music   videos  or other types of files and media    2  To activate the camera  video  music player  and other  dependant media or applications     Important  Your device can support SDHC cards up to 64GB    capacity     SD card Overview    After mounting an SD card in the device you can use your  computer to access and manage the SD card     Important  If access to the external SD card is not available   download and install the
273. lls      Never use Cellular Network  Use only Wi Fi for calls    Do not use Cellular Network  even if available     Call Functions and Contacts List 85    7   8     9     10    Tap OK to save the setting  m   From the Home screen  press   1  and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks    Tap Wi Fi Calling slider to toggle off the feature  then  tap it again to reactivate the feature and re register  your device with the T Mobile Network       Confirm  J  Wi Fi Calling Ready  displays in the    Status Bar     Launching Wi Fi Calling    Note     86    Verify you are currently connected to a Wireless Access  Point     Ensure that the Wi Fi connected icon displays on the  status bar    Confirm EG  Wi Fi Calling Ready  displays in the  Status Bar    Use the phone Dialer  Logs  or Contacts list to make a  call    Go to the dialer and make a call  Make sure  amp    Wi Fi Calling in use  appears during the call        When    Action    Then       Displays on the  screen status  bar     You are connected to the  T Mobile network and can  make Wi Fi calls        Displays on the  screen status  bar     The Wi Fi calling feature is  active and in use within an  active call                 Doesnotdisplay   You are charged normal   on the screen  calling rate minutes  For more   status bar  information  refer to     Activating Wi Fi Calling    on  page 85    Displays on the   There is an error in the use or    screen status  bar        911 registration of the Wi Fi  Call
274. lored battery icon  You can also choose to display a  percentage value  Having a percentage value on screen can  provide a better idea of the remaining charge on the battery     m Press    gt   j and then tap Settings  gt   My device tab  gt  Display  gt  Display battery percentage     For more information  refer to    Display Settings    on page  304     Extending Your Battery Life    Active applications  light levels  Bluetooth usage  and GPS  functionality all act to drain your battery  The following is a  list of helpful tips that can help conserve your battery power     Reduce your backlight on time      Turn Bluetooth off when not in use      Turn Wi Fi off when not in use      Deactivate the GPS when not needed  Most applications using  this function will periodically query the GPS satellites for your  current location  each query drains your battery      Do not wait until your battery is completely depleted before  charging your device  Repeating this process of a complete  discharge and recharge can over time reduce the storage  capacity of any battery      Turn off Automatic application sync      Use the Power Saving feature to deactivate some hardware and  interface functions       Check the Battery use screen to review what features or functions  have been consuming your battery resources      Check the Running Services and close any unnecessary  applications     Getting Started 15      Use the Task Manager feature to end shutdown background  applications that are
275. m  large files directly to another compatible device that is in  direct contact  These files can be larger  such as Videos  HD  pictures  and other large files  You can beam images and  videos from your gallery  music files from your music player   and more     1     From the Home screen  press     1 and then tap  Settings Connections tab    Verify the NFC feature is active    Tap S Beam and make sure the feature is turned on    If not already active  in a single motion touch and slide  the S Beam slider to the right to turn it on    Complete the transfer process between the two  NFC enabled devices by placing them back to back     This feature can come in very handy to quickly share  pictures between users with compatible S Beam devices  For  more information  refer to  Using S Beam to Share Pictures   on page 175     Nearby devices    This option allows you to share your media files with nearby  devices using DLNA and connected to the same Wi Fi     1     Connect to a Wi Fi network  For more information  refer   to  Connecting to a Wi Fi Network  on page 273   From the Home screen  press     1 and then tap   Settings Connections tab Nearby devices    Tap the File sharing field to turn File sharing on  A green  check mark indicates the feature is active  Once active   do    Nearby devices  appears at the top of the screen    At the Nearby devices prompt  tap OK    Tap Shared contents  then check the media you would   like to share  Tap OK    Tap Allowed devices list  then se
276. m the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  About device  gt   Software update    Read the Software update information screen    3  Select an available option     Note  You configure the device s software update parameters       Cancel  Tap this option to cancel the operation      Wi Fi settings  Enable this option to only download available  updates via an active Wi Fi connection  If disabled  the device  will begin available downloads via its    T Mobile connection      OK  Tap this option to connect to the remote server  detect if  there is an available update  the begin the download over your  existing data connection       Software updates can include bug fixes  enhancements to   services  to the device or currently installed software              354    Section 12  Health and Safety Information    This device is capable of operating in Wi Fi mode in the 2 4  and 5 GHz bands  The FCC requires that devices operating  within 5 15 5 25 GHz may only be used indoors  not outside   in order to avoid interference with Mobile Satellite Services   MSS   Therefore  do not use this device outside as a Wi Fi  hotspot or in Wi Fi Direct mode outside when using the  5 15 5 25 GHz band   This section outlines the safety precautions associated with  using your phone  The terms  mobile device  or  cell phone   are used in this section to refer to your phone  Read this  information before using your mobile device   Exposure to Radio Frequency  RF   Signals  The
277. me field upper left  to open  the complete email account list page    e Selecting Combined view allows you to view all the emails for  your current accounts  managed by the application  to be listed  on a single screen    3  Select an email account and tap an email message     Refreshing Email messages    1   2     3     From the Home screen  tap ER  gt   9  Email     Select an email account  EN      f you are already in an email account  tap the account name  field  upper left  to open the complete email account list page     e Select an available email account     Tap  Refresh      Composing Email    1   2     From the Home screen  tap 8E  gt  Oo    Email    Tap  account name field upper left  to open  the complete email account list page    Tap Inbox  gt   Compose     Enter the recipient s email address in the To field      If you are sending the email message to several recipients   Separate the email addresses with a comma  You can add as  many message recipients as you want    Tap Add Cc Bcc to add additional carbon copy and blind   copy recipients      Use the Cc field to carbon copy additional recipients      Use the Bcc field to blind copy additional recipients     Tap the Subject field and enter the email subject        7     Note     10     Tap the email text field and compose your email   message      To add an attachment  such as image  video  audio  etc      tap Attach  from the top of the screen  and make a  category selection        Tap the file you wish to at
278. mendation of  or affiliation with the third party or its  products and services  You agree that Samsung Electronics  Co  shall not be responsible or liable  directly or indirectly  for  any damage or loss caused or alleged to be caused by  or in  connection with  use of or reliance on any such third party  content  products  or services available on or through any  such application  You acknowledge and agree that the use of  any third party application is governed by such third party  application provider s Terms of Use  License Agreement   Privacy Policy  or other such agreement and that any  information or personal data you provide  whether knowingly  or unknowingly  to such third party application provider  will  be subject to such third party application provider s privacy  policy  if such a policy exists  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO     DISCLAIMS ANY RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY DISCLOSURE OF  INFORMATION OR ANY OTHER PRACTICES OF ANY THIRD  PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER     11  Disclaimer of Warranty Regarding Third Party  Applications  SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO  DOES NOT  WARRANT OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS REGARDING  THE AVAILABILITY  USE  TIMELINESS  SECURITY  VALIDITY   ACCURACY  OR RELIABILITY OF  OR THE RESULTS OF THE  USE OF  OR OTHERWISE RESPECTING  THE CONTENT OF ANY  THIRD PARTY APPLICATION WHETHER SUCH THIRD PARTY  APPLICATION IS INCLUDED WITH THE PRODUCT  DISTRIBUTED BY SAMSUNG ELECTRONICS CO   IS  DOWNLOADED  OR OTHERWISE OBTAINED  USE OF ANY  THIRD PARTY APPLICATION IS DON
279. monitoring  Samsung   s Samsung Link makes  staying connected easy   Allows users to share their in device media content with  other external devices using DLNA certified    Digital Living  Network Alliance  Devices  These external devices must also  be DLNA compliant  Wi Fi capability can be provided to TVs  via a digital multimedia streamer     AllShare Samsung Link Definitions     Samsung Link   AllShare Play    Group Play    AllShare Cast   with Hub  accessory     This new feature builds on the  previous AllShare Play functionality  It  includes features such as Web storage  integration and social networking  integration  This is a Web service  thatrequires using a Samsung account     A subset feature of Samsung Link  this  allows you to mirror photos and  multimedia presentations with other  members of your current Wi Fi   group  Users must be on the same  Wi Fi and provide an access code to  join the group     This feature functions with an  external AllShareCast Hub to fully  mirror what is currently displayed on  your device to the external TV     Applications and Development 251    Important  You must first connect both of your communicating    devices to the same Wi Fi and be using an  active registered Samsung account prior to using  this application    For more information  refer to    Wi Fi settings    on  page 281    For more information  refer to    Creating a  Samsung Account    on page 21     Important  The Samsung account manages the access  information  use
280. n  refer to    Using WatchON    on page  189     YouTube  YouTube is a video sharing website on which users can  upload and share videos  and view them in MPEG 4 format    1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt     YouTube     2  Tapthe search field Q to search for specific videos   scroll down to browse through the main page  thumbnails  or scroll to the bottom to explore additional  options    3  To view a video  tap an available preview thumbnail or  tap the title link    To configure YouTube Settings   m Press   and then tap Settings and configure the  following parameters     General      High quality on mobile  when enabled  allows you to start all  videos in high quality mode while you are connected to a mobile  network       Caption font size allows you to set the font size used by  on screen captions  Choose from  Small  Medium  Large  or  Huge     Applications and Development 257        Uploads specifies network preferences for uploads        Content localization allows you to prioritize channels and  videos from a specific country or region        Improve YouTube allows you to anonymously send YouTube  information to help improve the application      Channel Feed Content       Sets the content that you want to appear within your channel   feed  All activity is the default option     Search       Clear search history allows you to clear previous YouTube  searches from showing up in the YouTube search box        Never remember history allows you to force YouTube 
281. n  tap    2  Tapan entry to view available options     Ve  Logs tab      Logs    Note  The Logs tab only records calls that occur while the  phone is turned on  If a call is received while it is turned  off  it will not be included in your calling history     Each entry contains the phone number  if it is available  and  Contacts entry name  if the number is in your Contacts      Indicates all outgoing calls made from your device     gt  going yl   Indicates any received calls that were answered    amp  y  K Indicates a missed call      Indicates any received calls that were rejected     Q Indicates auto rejected calls     Accessing Call log from The Notifications Area   1  Locate from the Notifications area of the Status  bar    2  Tap the Status bar to reveal the Notifications tab  and  then drag the tab to the bottom of the screen to open  the Notifications panel    3  Tap the Missed call entry to open the Logs screen   This list provides easy access to redial an entry  or you can  also choose to access two types of history entry lists  depending on how they are touched    Call logs   Caller Overview    Tap a contact entry name or number to reveal the Call options   Screen    e Create contact to save the number if it is not already in your  Contacts      View contact to view the Contact details for the current entry      Update existing to update an existing Contacts entry with the  current number      Call allows you to redial the entry by name or number      Send message
282. n on Non lonizing Radiation Protection     http   www  icnirp de      Health Protection Agency   http   www hpa org uk Topics Radiation       US Food and Drug Administration   http   www fda gov Radiation EmittingProducts   RadiationEmittingProductsandProcedures   HomeBusinessandEntertainment CellPhones default htm                 360    Specific Absorption Rate  SAR   Certification Information    Your wireless phone is a radio transmitter and receiver  It is  designed and manufactured not to exceed the exposure  limits for Radio Frequency  RF  energy set by the Federal  Communications Commission  FCC  of the U S  Government   These FCC RF exposure limits are derived from the  recommendations of two expert organizations  the National  Council on Radiation Protection and Measurement  NCRP   and the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers   IEEE   In both cases  the recommendations were developed  by scientific and engineering experts drawn from industry   government  and academia after extensive reviews of the  scientific literature related to the biological effects of RF  energy    The RF exposure limit set by the FCC for wireless mobile  phones employs a unit of measurement known as the  Specific Absorption Rate  SAR   The SAR is a measure of the  rate of absorption of RF energy by the human body  expressed in units of watts per kilogram  W kg   The FCC  requires wireless phones to comply with a safety limit of 1 6  watts per kilogram  1 6 W kg      The FCC SAR lim
283. nal Voice Call Settings  on page 315      Ringtones and keypad tones  allows you to manage your  device s ringtones and vibratory features  Choose from   Ringtones  Vibrations  Vibrate when ringing  and Keypad tones   used when the keypad is pressed       Personalize call sound  allows you to enable the personalize  call sound function within an active call  You can adjust the  audio by enabling selecting an audio preset  For more  information  refer to    Adjusting the Call Volume  on page  8r     312      Noise reduction  allows you to enable suppression of  background audio      Increase volume in pocket  enables the ringtone volume to be  increased when the device is in a pocket or bag      Voicemail service  allows you to assign the service      Voicemail settings  displays the settings for the voicemail      Sound  assigns your device s ringtone      Vibrate  configures the vibrate settings      TTY mode  allows you to configure the TTY settings  For more  information  refer to    TTY Mode  on page 320     Call rejection    1   2   3     From the Home screen  tap  3  Phone     Press      and then tap Call settings  gt  Call rejection   Tap Auto reject mode and tap one of the following  options    e All numbers  to reject all calls      Auto reject numbers  to reject all calls in your Reject list    Tap Auto reject list    Tap   to manually add numbers to the Reject list   Tap Unknown to create a check mark and automatically  reject all calls that are not in your Contact
284. nching applications that contain multimedia  files  music video   audio from both files will be played  simultaneously     Activating and Deactivating Multi window  To activate Multi window via the Notification screen     1     In a single motion  touch the Status bar to reveal the  Notifications tab  and then drag it to the bottom of the  screen to open the Notifications screen  1     From the Notification screen  tap  Open Grid  view  to display additional functions     Understanding Your Device     57    3  Tap the MultiWindow entry to activate the feature  2    The icon turns green when active     Note  Although the MultiWindow feature is now active   as shown via the Notifications screen   the user must  enable display the MultiWindow list is shown only by  using the Back button  This action is a one time event  during the initial access  After that  the MultiWindow list  is displayed whenever the feature in active via the  Notifications screen  2         58    To display the Multi window tab   1  Press and hold the Back key S    The Multi window tab  gt   appears  by default  on the left  side of the screen     Note  Initially open activation  the entire apps panel is briefly    displayed  then minimized to only show the tab     2  Tap the tab to open the application panel showing all  the available Multi window apps   To hide the Multi window tab     m Press and hold the Back key  S   This action hides  the Multi window tab from view     Repositioning the Multi Window 
285. nchronize   3  Tap rey within the adjacent account field to reveal the  account s synchronization settings screen   4  Tosynchronize only Contacts  toggle the active state of  the Sync Contacts field  A green check mark indicates  the feature is enabled     Note  The process of updating your Contacts tab can take    several minutes  If after 10 20 minutes  your list has not  been updated  repeat step 2 3     5  Your Contacts tab then reflects any updated Contact  information     Note  Syncing of contacts requires you are logged into your    Gmail and Corporate accounts via the device     Display Options  The Display options menu allows you to allows you to choose  which contacts to display  You can also choose to display  only contacts that have phone numbers     Note  Once a display filter has been selected  only those  Contact entries are shown until the All contacts option is  re selected     1  From the Home screen  tap Ey   Press   and then tap Contacts to display  S    N    elect any    of the following to filter according to the selection    e All contacts allows you to display all available Contacts    e Device lists those Contacts currently found only on your Phone   e SIM lists those Contacts currently found only on your SIM card   e Samsung account lists those Contacts currently found and    sync d within the Samsung account     e Google lists those Contacts currently found within the Google    account     Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync lists those Contac  found wit
286. nd other devices     Note  microSD memory cards include capacities of up to 2GB   microSDHC    memory card types can range from 4GB  to up to 32GB   microSDXC    memory card types can include  capacities greater than 32GB     Note  This device supports a memory card of up to a 64GB     The device comes in a 16GB model     1  Remove the battery cover    2  Locate the microSD card slot on the inside of the  device    3  Orient the card with the gold strips facing down    4  Carefully slide the microSD card into the card socket  until it clicks into place  For more information on how  to use the SD card see  Using the SD Card  on page 71    Important  Be sure to align the gold contact pins on the card    with the phone s contact pins     Ss  D gt   Incorrect  5       Removing the microSD Memory Card  1  Remove the battery cover   2  Firmly press the card into the slot and release it  The  card should pop partially out of the slot   3  Remove the card from the slot   4  Replace the battery cover     Getting Started 11    Battery    Before using your device for the first time  install the battery  and charge it fully     Important  Before removing or replacing the battery  make    sure the device is switched off  To turn the device  off  hold down the        e key until the power off  image displays  then tap Power off     Installing the Battery  1  Slide the battery into the compartment  1  so that the  tabs on the end align with the slots at the bottom of the  phone  making sure
287. nd then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Security   2  Tap Unknown sources to active this feature   Verify Apps  Allows you to block or warn yourself before installing apps  that can cause harm  mE  1  From the Home screen  press    I  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Security     2  Tap Verify apps to active this feature     Note  Enabling this feature can prevent installation of some    applications from the Play Store     Credential Storage  This option allows certain applications to access secure  certificates and other credentials  Certificates and  credentials can be installed to the SD card and password  protected  EN   1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Security    2  Tap Trusted credentials to display only trusted CA  certificates  A check mark displayed next to the feature  indicates secure credentials    3  Tap Install from device storage to install encrypted  certificates from the USB Storage location    4  Tap Clear credentials to clear the device  SD card or  phone memory  of all certificate contents and reset the  credentials password     Changing Your Settings 347    Application Manager    This device can be used for Android development  You can  write applications in the SDK and install them on this device   then run the applications using the hardware  system  and  network  This feature allows you to configure the device for  development     Warning  Because the device can be configured with system    software
288. ne    7  Tap Use 24 hour format  If this is not selected the device  automatically uses a 12 hour format    8  Tap Select date format and select the date format type     352    About Device  This menu contains legal information  system tutorial  information  and other phone information such as the model  number  firmware version  baseband version  kernel version   and software build number   To access phone information     m From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab  About device  The  following information displays      Software update  allows you to connect to the network and  upload any new phone software directly to your device  The  device automatically updates with the latest available software  when you access this option      Status  displays the battery status  the level of the battery   percentage   the Network connection  Signal strength  Mobile  network type  Service state  Roaming status  Mobile network  state  My phone number  IMEI number  IP address  Wi Fi MAC  address  Bluetooth address  Serial number  Up time  and  Device status             Legal information  This option displays information about  Open source licenses  Google legal information  as well as  License settings  This information clearly provides copyright  and distribution legal information and facts as well as Google  Terms of Service  Terms of Service for Android powered  Phones  and much more pertinent information as a reference   Read the information and terms  then
289. nection    1     338    prior to use     Log into your Samsung account and verify it is active   For more information  refer to  Creating a Samsung  Account  on page 21    Log into your external cloud storage solution  In our  case we are using a Dropbox account  For more  information  refer to  Dropbox  on page 224    From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt   Accounts tab   gt  Cloud   Confirm your Samsung account appears at the top of  the screen       Tap Sync settings  select which device parameters will    be synched  and tap Sync now  Choose from  Sync  Calendar  Sync Contacts  Sync Internet bookmarks   Sync Internet opened pages  and Sync Memo       Tap Backup or Restore to launch the feature       Backup  manually loads up the currently selected categories  and backs up the data to your cloud storage location  Tap  Backup to begin the manual backup process      Restore  allows you to retrieve your previously backed up data  from your Samsung account and then download it to your  device     Backup and Reset    Location settings  backup configurations  or reset the phone  to erase all personal data    m From the Home screen  press    f 1 and then tap  Settings  gt  INE  Accounts tab   gt  Backup and  reset    Mobile Backup and Restore  The device can be configured to back up your current  settings  application data and settings  _   1  From the Home screen  press I and then tap  Settings  gt  Accounts tab  gt  Backup and reset    2  Tap Back up my data 
290. networks to allow apps to use data  from sources such as Wi Fi and mobile networks to    provide a better approximation of your current location     Enabling My Places Eu  1  From the Home screen  press 11  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Location services   2  Tap My places to enable the storage of your favorite  locations     Security  The Security settings allow you to determine the security  level for your device   Encrypt Device  When enabled  this feature requires a numeric PIN or  password to decrypt your device each time you power it on  or encrypt the data on your SD card each time it is  connected  m  1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  Security   2  Tap Encrypt device  For more information  read the  displayed help screen   3  Tap Encrypt external SD card to enable the encryption  on SD card data that requires a password be entered  each time the microSD card is connected     Tip  Make sure your battery is charged more than 80 percent   Encryption may take an hour or more     Changing Your Settings 345    Setting up SIM Card Lock    Prevent another user from using your SIM card to make  unauthorized calls or from accessing information stored on    your SIM card by protecting the information using a PIN code     When enabled  your phone will ask for a PIN number each  time you use the phone  Using this option you can also  change your SIM PIN number   1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Mor
291. ng  an incorrect PIN2 code could cause the phone to  lock  Contact customer service for assistance     Changing the PIN2 Code    1   2     eon Pw    From the Home screen  tap X   Phone     Press   and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional  settings  gt  Fixed dialing numbers    Tap Change PIN2    At the prompt  enter your old PIN2 code    At the prompt  enter a new PIN2 code    Confirm your PIN2 code     Important  Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code  If your SIM card    does not  this menu does not display    The PIN2 code is provided by your carrier  Entering  the PIN2 incorrectly three times will cause the  device to lock  Contact customer service for  assistance     Changing Your Settings 317    Managing the FDN List    When    this feature is enabled  you can make calls only to    phone numbers stored in the FDN list on the SIM card     1   2     Important  Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code  If your SIM card    318    From the Home screen  tap  Phone     Press m and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional  settings  gt  Fixed dialing numbers    Tap Enable FDN    At the prompt  enter your PIN2 code and tap OK    FDN is enabled    Tap FDN list then press     1  and then tap Add contact  or edit the contacts that were stored     does not  this menu does not display    The PIN2 code is provided by your carrier  Entering  the PIN2 incorrectly three times will cause the  device to lock  Contact customer service for  assistance     Ringtones and keypad tones _  1  From the Home s
292. ng a  Stereo device    18  Tap the Mono audio field to enable stereo audio to be  compressed into a single mono audio stream for use  with a single earbud earphone    19  Tap the Turn off all sounds field to mute every sound  made by the device during taps  selections   notifications  etc     20  Tap Flash notification to allows you to set your camera  light to blink whenever you receive a notification     324    21     22     23     Enable the Assistant menu to allow you to improve the  device accessibility for users with reduced dexterity   Touch and slide the slider to the right to turn it on   Follow the on screen instructions    Tap the Tap and hold delay field to select a time interval  for this action  Choose from  Short  Medium  or Long   Enable Interaction control to allows you to enable or  disable motions and screen timeout  You can also block  areas of the screen from touch interaction  Touch and  slide the slider to the right to turn it on  Follow the  on screen instructions     Language and Input Settings  This setting allows you to configure the language in which to  display the menus  You can also set on screen keyboard  options    m From the Home screen  press  re and then tap  Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Language and  input    Language Settings  To set the language that the menus display on the phone    1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt   Language    2  Select a language and region 
293. ng account heading    Backing Up Settings to Google  You can use your Google account to back up apps  Wi Fi    Settings  gt  Accounts tab     passwords  and other data     2  Navigate to the My accounts area and then tap Add 1  From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt   account and select Samsung account  m  Gmail    3  Sign in to your Samsung account or tap Create new 2  Tap Existing if you have a Google account   account if you don t have one yet  The Inbox loads conversations and email   Follow the on screen instructions  er  4     the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt  Tap New if you do not have a Google account    Internet         Pat  3  Confirm that immediately after signing in to your     5  From the webpage  tap  Bookmarks   Google account  the Backup and restore screen is  Press E  and then tap Move to folder  displayed  7  Place a checkmark on those Bookmarks you want to 4  From within the Backup and restore screen  tap the  back up  then tap Done  checkbox next to Keep this phone backed up with my  8  Select a location or folder  The Bookmarks that you Google Account field   moved are now listed under the Samsung account 5  From the Home screen  press   and then tap    heading in your Bookmark list     342    Settings  gt  Accounts tab  gt  Backup and reset     6  Tap Back up my data to create a checkmark  This will  back up your app data  Wi Fi passwords  and other  settings    7  Your Google account should be listed under the Backup  option  If not  Tap Backup account 
294. ngs  For more    information  rel  page 315     er to    Configuring Call Forwarding    on         Auto area code  allows you to automatically prepend a specific    area code to al  e Call barring  b     International calls       Call waiting  n  another call     Auto redial  a    outbound calls     locks specific types of calls  All outgoing calls   etc        otifies you of an incoming call while you are on          omatically redial the dialed number if it is       unable to connect or the call is cut off       Fixed dialing Numbers  manages fixed dialing numbers  See  description below     Configuring  1  From the    Call Forwarding      Home screen  tap  Phone      2  Press    and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional  settings  gt  Call forwarding     featu    re is enabled     3  Tap an available option     Always forward  incoming calls are re routed to a secondary    number    hat you specify     Important  Call Forwarding is disabled when the Wi Fi Calling      Forward when busy  forwards all your calls to voicemail when    your phone is busy     Forward when unanswered  automatically forwards    voicemail      Forward when unreachable  automatically forwards    voicemail  off           number when the phone is not in service  or    Changing Your Settings    number when the phone is not answered  and  otherwise allows you to enter a voicemail number      0 your    D your  s turned          315    Using Auto Area Code  This feature prepends an area code to all outbo
295. o automatically upload videos and photos to your  own private album on Google    m From the Home screen  tap Ea  Apps   gt    Google     For more information  refer to    Google      on page 160     228    Group Play    This application lets you share documents  photos or music  in real time with other connected friends     Note  Group play is not the same as Screen mirroring which    requires a connection to a Wi Fi capable Samsung TV or  via the use of the AllShare Cast Hub    For more information  refer to    AllShare Cast Hub    on  page 210     Important  To share a Group Play  all users must be connected  to the same Wi Fi access point     1  From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt    5   Group Play     2  Read the various on screen information and tap OK to  continue    3  Follow the on screen tutorials     Creating a group  If you have media you want to share  create a group for other  users to join to and then share collaborate with what you are  sharing   The creator of the group is the leader and it the source of the  shared file  All other joined members can then interact with  the file being shared    1  Connectto an active Wireless Access Point and confirm  your other participants are also connected to this same  Wi Fi    2  From the Home screen  tap ERE  Apps   gt   E  Group Play     3  Tap the Set group password field to enable the function  which requires users to enter a password prior to  connecting to your new group    4  Tap Create group  If previously se
296. o prompt  tap Device  The contacts  on the SD card are copied to your phone     340    Backing Up Media to your PC    You can back up your pictures  videos  documents  and other  media to your PC  You can connect your device to a PC as a  removable disk and copy files back and forth between your  phone and PC  If you insert an SD card in the device  you can  also access the files directory from the SD card by using your  device as a memory card reader     1     Connect the USB cable to your device  then connect the  cable to your PC USB port  After a few seconds  a  pop up window displays on the PC when it is  connected with your device    On the PC pop up  click Open device to view files   Verify your device appears as a removable disk on your  PC  Once connected  you can access the Phone folder   internal phone memory  and the Card folder  SD card    Select the location where the files are that you would  like to copy to your PC  Phone or Card     Select the folders where the information is kept  This  would include folders such as DCIM  camera pictures  and videos   Pictures  Music  Playlists  Download  etc     Select the files that you want to copy and copy them   Control C   copy  to a folder on your PC  Control V    paste      Disconnect the USB cable from your phone and the PC     To copy files on your PC back to your phone  simply  reverse the procedure     Verify your images and videos are on your microSD card     1     From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt     IX 
297. o share the video via ChatON   Bluetooth  Dropbox  Email  Gmail  Google    Messaging   Picassa  Wi Fi Direct  or YouTube     Delete b    allows you to delete the current video   Choose either OK or Cancel      or     172    Touch and hold a listed video file to place a checkmark  alongside and then press l   for additional options       Slideshow  allows you to see your files in a slideshow or  access the slideshow settings       Copy  allows you to create a duplicate of the currently selected  file       Move  allows you to move a selected file to a new location       Rename  allows you to rename the filename of the currently  selected video       Details  displays video file information    or   With the video displayed on screen  but not playing    press i     for additional options       Favorite  tags the current video as a favorite file       Rename  allows you to rename the filename of the currently  selected video       Details  displays video file information       Settings  provide access to the Galley settings page  From this  page you can configure the SNS data management and Tag  options     Sharing Pictures   Pictures are the best way of remembering the moment  but   an even better treat is to share them with others    Two new features allow you to either instantly share a series   of pictures as they are taken or quickly share a picture   without using email or messaging      Share Shot is a great way to instantly share a series of pictures  among a group of use
298. o the Home screen     Using the Camera 3  Before you take a picture  use the Up and Down Volume    Taking Photos keys to zoom in or out  You can magnify the picture up  Taking pictures with your device s built in camera is as Bia UU percent     simple as choosing a subject  pointing the camera  then  pressing the camera key  Pinch the screen to zoom out or pinch outwards to    D zoom in   Note  When taking a photo in direct sunlight or in bright    conditions  shadows may appear on the photo  4  If desired  before taking the photo  you can tap    on screen icons to access various camera options and  1  From the Home screen  tap EHA  Apps     settings      Camera    Using the device s main display screen as a viewfinder   adjust the image by aiming the camera at the subject     Note  On your initial activation of the camera  firmware    configuration can take up to 1 minute  This is a one time  process     You can also tap the screen to move the focus to a  desired area of interest    Tap la   Camera  until the shutter sounds   The picture  is automatically Stored within your designated storage  location  page 162   If no microSD is installed  all  pictures are stored on the Phone   For more  information  refer to  Camera Options  on page 164     Multimedia 163    Note  Touch and hold  a to take a burst shot  These are  saved using a Fine image quality     Camera mode  Battery  Charge    Display Front  Facing Camera    Self portrait    Quick Settings    Storage Take    Picture
299. o the contact name to  indicate what type of account information is contained  in the entry     3  Press   and then tap Join contact    4  Tap the second contact entry  the entry in which to  link   The second contact is now linked with the first  and the account information is merged into one screen     Note  The information is still maintained in both entries  but    displays in one record for easier viewing when you link  the contacts     118    Unjoining a Contact    1   2     Note  Typically this is the same contact with a different name    3     From the Home screen  tap a    Tap a contact name  the account name from which you  want to unjoin an entry   This reveals the details for  entry     or account information     Tap the Connection area   Press l   and then tap Separate contact     Tap     next to the entry you want to unjoin and  select OK  The contacts are    unjoined    or separated  and no longer display in the merged record screen   Both contacts now go back to being separately  displayed     Marking a Contact as Default  When you use applications such as the Voice Dialer or other  messaging type applications  the application needs to know  which information is primary  default  in a contact entry list   For example  when you say  Call John Smith   if you have  three phone records for John Smith  the Voice dialer is  looking for the  default  number or entry   The Mark as default option marks one entry in a contact  record to use as the default  This comes in
300. o the location of your desired TV and  set top box    6  Follow steps 4 10 from page 189 to complete the  process      Apps   gt     Play Movies  amp  TV   This application allows you to connect to the Play Store   download a movie and then watch it instantly    Choose from thousands of movies  including new releases and  HD titles in the Play Store and stream them instantly on your  Android device    Movies  previously rented via the Play Store are automatically  added to your My Movies library across your devices    Learn more about Google Play Movies at   http   play google com about movies    1  From the Home screen  tap  BI Play Movies  amp  TV     2  Logon to your Google account if you have not already  done so  A list of videos sorted on the SD card displays  in the Video list    3  Following the on screen instructions for renting and  viewing movies    4  Tap the MOVIES tab to view movies you have rented    5  Tap the TV SHOWS tab to view shows you have rented    6  Tapthe PERSONAL VIDEOS tab to view movies you have  on your device or memory card         Apps   gt     For more information on using the Picture in Picture feature   for video playback  see  Using Picture In Picture  on   page 183    Play Music   Also known as Google Music  allows you to browse  shop    and playback songs purchased from the Play Store  The   music you choose is automatically stored in your Google   Music library and instantly ready to play or download    m Access the new music tab from wi
301. oard     Brilliant 4 99  HD Super AMOLED screen  1920 x 1080      1 9 gigahertz quad core processor     Delivering data speeds faster than the current 3G network  technology by using 4G LTE and High Speed Packet Access Plus   HSPA        Android 4 2 2  Jelly Bean Platform     Smart Switch    compliant  For more information  see  www samsungsmartswitch com      Support for Air View and Air Gestures         Wi Fi    Capability      WatchON       Rich TV experience with Infrared  IR  remote          Over 700 000 Apps available to download from the Google Play     Store and Samsung Apps     Access Movies  TV Shows  Music  Games  and Books with  Samsung Hub         Samsung Link   to share your media content across connected  devices  Cloud connectivity is enabled via the use of an external  Web storage service     Compliant with AllShare Cast Hub        13 Megapixel Camera and Camcorder with autofocus and digital  zoom     2 Megapixel Front Facing camera for Video Chat     Share Shot picture sharing functionality     S Beam file transfer technology     Share Shot camera sharing capable via multi connect Wi Fi  Direct connection     Bluetooth enabled     NFC compatible     Full Integration of Google Mobile    Services  Gmail  YouTube   Google Maps  Google Voice Search     Understanding Your Device 27      Multiple Messaging Options  Text Picture Video Messaging and  Google Talk        Corporate and Personal Email     Music Player with multitasking features      Pre loaded e reader 
302. oice button to  verbally speak the selected language  corresponds to  top field     2  Wait a few seconds until the on screen notification  shows  Speak in     then speak using the selected  language    3  Within a few seconds  confirm the translated text now  appears in the other translation field     4  Taptheselected           Speak  button to translate  using your selected input language and voice      Example  if trying to speak in English and get a Spanish  translation  tap the Speak  English  US   button and wait for  the text to appear on screen    5  Press re for additional options  Choose from  History    Favorite  Preset phrases  TTS speech rate  and Help    S Voice    Launches your phone s built in voice recognition system that  allows you to initiate several common tasks without having  to touch the phone  Features include  Call  Text  Navigate   Play music  Memo  and Driving mode     m From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt    S Voice      For more information  refer to  Using S Voice  on page 93        Applications and Development 249    Samsung Apps  Allows you to easily download an abundance of applications  that are directly compatible with your device  This includes  games  news  reference  social networking  navigation  and  more  Samsung Apps makes your Smartphone smarter     Note  Access to this feature requires that you already be  logged in to your Samsung account application  For  more information  refer to  Creating a Samsung  Account  on page 21   
303. on      Block pop ups  Prevents popup advertisement or windows  from appearing on screen  Remove the checkmark to disable  this function      Default storage  Allows you to set your default storage to  Device or Memory Card      Website settings  View advanced settings for individual  websites          Enable notifications  Allows website notifications  Select  Always on  On demand  or Off       Clear notifications  Deletes website notification access  information       Reset settings  Restores all settings to default     266    Bandwidth management      Preload web pages  Allows the browser to preload Web  pages  Choose from Always  Only on Wi Fi  or Never      Load images  Allows web page images to load along with the  other text components of a loaded website      Open pages in overview  Displays an overview of newly  opened web pages     Bluetooth    About Bluetooth  Bluetooth is a short range communications technology that  allows you to connect wirelessly to a number of Bluetooth  devices  such as headsets and hands free car kits  and  Bluetooth enabled handhelds  computers  printers  and  wireless devices  The Bluetooth communication range is  usually up to approximately 30 feet   Turning Bluetooth On and Off  To turn Bluetooth on       1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt  MANN  Connections tab    2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Bluetooth slider  to the right to turn it on   The slider color indicates the activation status  When  active
304. on  refer to   Notification Bar  on page 38     Tab Options  There are various options available from the various tabs     From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt   GP  Play Music        Select one of the following tabs and tap Im to access    an available option     PLAYLISTS  Play  Add to queue  Rename  Delete  or Keep on  device       RECENT  to display the most recently played songs and albums      ARTISTS  Play  Add to queue  Add to playlist  or Shop for artist       ALBUMS  Play  Add to queue  Add to playlist  More by artist  or  Shop for artist      SONGS  Play  Add to queue  Add to playlist  Shop for artist  or  Delete      GENRES  Play  Add to queue  Add to playlist  More by artist  or  Shop for artist     Options While Playing a Song  When you play a song  the Now playing screen displays   There are various options and controls available while a song  is playing   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      e  Play Music      2  Tap an album or song  EN  3  From the Now playing screen  press Im  Menu  to  display the following options     Equalizer  applies selected equalizer features such as   FX booster  Bass boost  and 3D effect     Clear queue  clears the current queue       Save queue  stores the current queue       Settings  Allows you to view and assign various music settings   and view different application specific information     Help  Provides an on screen series of related help topics   4  Tap P Add to playlist to add the song to a playlist    0r     Ta
305. on instructions specific to your  Wireless Access Point  EM   2  From the Home screen  press    1 and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi    3  Press  r   then tap WPS push button    4  Once the connection is complete  confirm the external  router now appears in the Wi Fi list as connected     WPS PIN Entry    If a WPS Push Button does not work  there is an alternative  WPS connection method where you would use a device  generated PIN number to establish the connection  This  number is then entered into your WAP   s WPS client PIN field  to complete the connection   To pair your device using WPS PIN           1  From the Home screen  press       and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi   2  Press    then tap WPS PIN entry   3  Write down the generate PIN number and enter it into  your Wi Fi Router   s client PIN field   4  Once the connection is complete  confirm the external  router now appears in the Wi Fi list as connected        Changing Your Settings 285    Wi Fi Direct Setup and Settings    You can configure your device to connect directly with other  Wi Fi capable devices  This is an easy way to transfer data  between devices  These devices must be enabled for Wi Fi  direct communication  This connection is direct and not via a  HotSpot or WAP   A Displays when Wi Fi Direct is active and   J configured for a direct connection to another  compatible device in the same direct  communication mode   p     Displays when Wi Fi Direct is active an
306. on page 72   Removing Music Files   1  From the Home screen  tap EA      Music     2  Tap the Songs tab    3  Touch and hold a song entry to reveal the on screen  context menu    4  Tap Delete OK  The music file s  is deleted      Apps   gt     Samsung Link    This application wirelessly synchronizes your Samsung  device with your TV  streams content and even keeps tabs on  who calls or sends text messages with real time  on screen  monitoring  Samsung s Link makes staying connected easy   Allows users to share their in device media content with  other external devices using DLNA certified   Digital Living  Network Alliance  Devices  These external devices must also  be DLNA compliant  Wi Fi capability can be provided to TVs  via a digital multimedia streamer     Important  You must first connect both of your communicating    devices to the same Wi Fi and be using an  active registered Samsung account prior to using  this application    For more information  refer to  Wi Fi settings  on  page 281    For more information  refer to  Creating a  Samsung Account  on page 21     Note  For more information on defining the various features    definitions on page 251     Important  The Samsung account manages the access  information  username password  to several  applications  such as Samsung Link  Chat On  and  Samsung Hub     1  Confirm you have already logged in to your Samsung  account    2  From the Home screen  tap      Samsung Link     3  If prompted with an on screen notific
307. on the phone or on the web     m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    Talk    For more information  refer to  Google Talk  on page 157   TripAdvisor    With the TripAdvisor  you can plan and have your perfect trip   With over 75 million reviews and opinions by travelers  it is  easy to find the best hotels  restaurants  and fun things to do   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    TripAdvisor    2  Sign in with your Samsung Account if you have not  already done so   3  Follow the on screen instructions to use TripAdvisor   4  Press   for additional options     Video    The Video player application plays video files stored locally   m From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt   o  Video    For more information  refer to  Using Video  on page 182   Visual Voicemail  Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of people who  left a voicemail message  and listen to the any message they  want without being limited to chronological order   m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   2e  Visual Voicemail      For more information  refer to  Visual Voicemail  on page  23     Voice Recorder  The Voice Recorder allows you to record an audio file up to  one minute long and then immediately send it as a message   1  From the Home screen  tap ERE  Apps   gt    Voice Recorder    2  Tap  9   Record  to record an audio file     3  Tap  m   Stop  to stop recording  The file  automatically saves to the Voice list     4  Tap Q  Pause  to pause the recording of an audio  file     5  Tap
308. ons  Sparks in such areas could cause an explosion    374    or fire resulting in bodily injury or even death  Users are  advised to switch the mobile device off while at a refueling  point  service station      Users are reminded of the need to observe restrictions on the  use of radio equipment in fuel depots  fuel storage and  distribution areas   chemical plants  or where blasting  operations are in progress  Areas with a potentially explosive  atmosphere are often  but not always  clearly marked  They  include below deck on boats  chemical transfer or storage  facilities  vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas  such as  propane or butane   areas where the air contains chemicals  or particles  such as grain  dust  or metal powders  and any  other area where you would normally be advised to turn off  your vehicle engine    When your Device is Wet    Do not turn on your device if it is wet  If your device is  already on  turn it off and remove the battery immediately  if  the device will not turn off or you cannot remove the battery   leave it as is   Then  dry the device with a towel and take it  to a service center     FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility  HAC   Regulations for Wireless Devices    The U S  Federal Communications Commission  FCC  has  established requirements for digital wireless mobile devices  to be compatible with hearing aids and other assistive  hearing devices    When individuals employing some assistive hearing devices   hearing aids and cochlear implants 
309. ons to launch the    associated application  Sub Menu items       Understanding Your Device 63    Using Context Menus  Context menus  also called pop up menus  contain options  that apply to a specific item on the screen  They function  similarly to menu options that appear when you right click  your mouse on your desktop computer   m Touch and hold an item on screen to open its context  menu     Join contact    Share contact via message Context  Add to favorites Menu    Add to group     Add to reject list  Share namecard via  Print contact info    Add shortcut to home       64    Accessing Recently Used Applications    1  Press and hold to open the recently used  applications window     Note  This recent applications screen also provides access to  the Task manager     2  A pop up displays the six most recently used  applications   3  Tapan icon to open the recent application     Customizing the Screens    You can customize the Home screens  panels  to display the  Widgets  Shortcuts  Folders  or Wallpapers  For example  one  screen could contain the Music Player shortcut and other  forms of media  while another screen might contain  communication apps such as Gmail     You can customize your Home screen by doing the following     Adding  Deleting  and Rearranging screens    Assigning a New Home screen    Adding and Removing Primary Shortcuts    Sharing Application Information    Managing Shortcuts    Adding and Removing Widgets    Changing the Background  Wallpapers   Addin
310. ontact  begins the process of adding the new number  to your Contacts list      Delete thread  deletes the currently selected message thread      Add to spam numbers  adds the current sender to a spam list   ny new texts from this sender are automatically blocked     To access additional Bubble options     Touch and hold the message bubble within an active   message conversation to display the following options      Delete message  deletes the currently selected message  bubble from the thread      Copy message text  copies the currently selected message  bubble from the thread      Lock Unlock message  locks or unlocks the currently selected  message bubble from being accidentally deleted      Forward  allows you to forward the currently selected message  bubble to an external recipient      Copy to SIM  copies the currently selected message bubble as  a single text message within the SIM card          View message details  displays details for the currently  selected message bubble      Translate  translates the text from the currently selected  bubble into a desired language                 Messages 137    Deleting Messages  Deleting a single message thread  1  From the Home screen  tap  gt  ae  2  Touch and hold a message from the Messages list   then select Delete thread   3  Atthe prompt  tap OK to delete or Cancel to exit   Deleting multiple message threads  1  From the Home screen  tap wu   2  Press IS and then tap Delete threads   3  Tap each message thread you want 
311. ooks you have previously selected between your  Books account and your device    3  Tap to begin searching for both free and paid  ebooks    4  Follow the on screen prompts to download the ebook  to your device     Play Magazines  With Google Play Magazines  you can subscribe to your  favorite magazines and have them available to read on your  device at any time or any place   1  From the Home screen  tap  E  Play Magazines    2  Logon to your Google account if you have not already  done so  For more information  refer to  Signing into  Your Google Account  on page 20   3  Atthe Welcome  display  tap the shop icon O to  browse the full catalog      Apps   gt     4  Read the Google Play Terms of Service and tap Accept     5  Sweep the screen to the left or right to view  Categories  Featured  Top Selling  and New Arrivals    6  Tap a magazine to see more information and  subscribe    7  Follow the on screen instructions to subscribe to a  magazine     Play Movies  amp  TV    This application allows you to connect to the Play Store   download a movie and then watch it instantly     Note  You must logged into your Google account prior to using  this feature     Learn more about Google Play Movies at   http   play google com about movies   m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   Bj  Play Movies  amp  TV   A list of videos sorted on the  SD card displays in the Video list        For more information  refer to  Play Movies  amp  TV  on page  193     Applications and Development
312. or may  replace the Product with a rebuilt  reconditioned or new  Product    Repaired replaced cases  pouches and holsters will be  warranted for a period of ninety  90  days  All other repaired   replaced Products will be warranted for a period equal to the    380    remainder of the original Limited Warranty on the original  Product or for ninety  90  days  whichever is longer  All  replaced Products  parts  components  boards and  equipment shall become the property of SAMSUNG  Except to  any extent expressly allowed by applicable law  transfer or  assignment of this Limited Warranty is prohibited    What must you do to obtain warranty service    To obtain service under this Limited Warranty  you must  return the Product to an authorized phone service facility in  an adequate container for shipping  accompanied by the  sales receipt or comparable proof of sale showing the  original date of purchase  the serial number of the Product  and the seller s name and address     To obtain assistance on where to deliver the Product  please  call SAMSUNG Customer Care at 1 888 987 4357  If  SAMSUNG determines that any Product is not covered by this  Limited Warranty  you must pay all parts  shipping  and labor  charges for the repair or return of such Product    You should keep a separate backup copy of any contents of  the Product before delivering the Product to SAMSUNG for  warranty service  as some or all of the contents may be  deleted or reformatted during the course of warrant
313. ore applications     Warning  Not all web applications are safe to download  In  order to protect your phone and data  use the Play  Store to install web applications  For more  information  refer to    Downloading a New Google  Application    on page 242     Connections 271    PC Connections    You can connect your device to a PC using an optional PC  data cable using various USB connection modes     Media device  MTP   allows you to transfer media files in  Windows  or using an Android file transfer on a Mac     Camera  PTP   allows you to transfer photos using the camera  software  and transfer any files onto a PC that does not  support MTP     Kies  allows you to manage music  movies and photos  You  can also backup precious contacts and calendars  download  apps and podcasts and automatically upgrade device  firmware  Kies conveniently syncs your life across all your  devices     Note  To sync your device to your computer it is highly  recommended that you install Samsung Kies which is  available at http   www samsung com kies  for Windows   Mac         272    Note  If you are a Windows XP user  ensure that you have  Windows XP Service Pack 3 or higher installed on your  computer  Also  ensure that you have Samsung Kies 2 0  or Windows Media Player 10 or higher installed on your  computer     Connecting as a Storage Device    You can connect your device to a PC as a removable disk and  access the file directory  If you insert a memory card in the  device  you can also ac
314. os from friends and much more   1  From the Home screen  tap   Flipboard    2  Swipe up to get started  select some on screen  categories and tap Done to create a new profile    or      Apps   gt     Tap Tap to sign In to log into your previously created  profile     3  Follow the on screen instructions     Gallery    The Gallery is where you view photos and play back videos   For photos  you can also perform basic editing tasks  view a  slideshow  set photos as wallpaper or caller image  and  share as a picture message     m From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt     KK  Gallery      For more information  refer to    The Gallery    on page 181   Gmail    Google Mail  Gmail  is a web based email service  Gmail is  configured when you first set up your phone  Depending on  your synchronization settings  Gmail can automatically  synchronize with your Gmail account on the Web        From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   M Gmail   For more information  refer to    Using Google Mail    on page  155     Applications and Development 227    Google  Use Google Search to search the Web   m From the Home screen  tap  Apps  9   Google  and enter the search text    or   Tap on the Google Search bar and say the search  information     Google    Google  makes messaging and sharing with your friends a  lot easier  You can set up Circles of friends  visit the Stream  to get updates from your Circles  use Messenger for fast  messaging with everyone in your Circles  or use Instant  Upload t
315. otSpot connectivity is a wireless version of this  same functionality and allows you to provide Internet  connectivity to multiple devices      Apps   gt     Important  The Mobile HotSpot service cannot be active when    device is connected to Wi Fi  Please disconnect  your Wi Fi connection prior to active this service     Note  You must have a tethering plan on your account in order    to use the Mobile HotSpot  You cannot use data on the  device while using Mobile HotSpot     To activate the Mobile HotSpot service   1  From the Home screen  tap     Mobile HotSpot       Apps   gt     From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt   eam  Connections tab   gt  More  networks  gt  Tethering and Mobile HotSpot    2  Ina single motion touch and slide the Mobile HotSpot  slider to the right to turn it on    3  Read the on screen notification regarding data use and  tap OK    4  Edit the Network SSID name and then write it down    5  Enable the Broadcast network name  SSID  field if you  would like to broadcast your SSID name to nearby  devices    6  Verify the Security field is set to WPA2 PSK    Enter a new password then write it down       Additional options include SHow password and Show advanced  options    8  Tap Save to store the new settings     Connections 277    9  Confirm the Mobile HotSpot active icon E appears  at the top of the screen     Note  By default  the connection is not secured     Note  Using your Mobile HotSpot drains your device s battery    much 
316. ou make a mistake  tap         once to delete a  single digit   Touch and hold _  to delete all digits        Tap ES     Pause Dialing   You can dial or save phone numbers with pauses for use with   automated systems  such as voicemail or financial phone   numbers     2 Second Pause automatically sends the next set of numbers  after a two second pause  This is indicated in the number string  as a comma      p  1  From the Home screen  tap  s and use the  on screen keypad to enter the phone number    2  Press    and then tap Add 2 sec pause  This feature  adds an automatic two second pause    3  Use the keypad to enter the additional numbers that  will be dialed automatically after the second pause     Tip  You can create pauses longer than three seconds by  entering multiple 2 second pauses     4  Tap EM     Wait Dialing  Inserting a Wait into your dialing sequence means that the  phone waits until it hears a dial tone before proceeding with  the next sequence of numbers     Wait sends the next set of numbers only after tapping Yes  This is  indicated in the number string as a semicolon         Note  Do not add multiple Waits     to a number string as this  will continue to prompt you after each sequence     1  From the Home screen  tap N and use the  on screen keypad to enter the phone number    2  Press l   and then tap Add wait  This feature causes  the phone   to require your acceptance before sending  the next set of entered digits    3  Tap EU    4  Once prompted to Sen
317. ound noise      Dynamically equalizes and adjusts voice volume to optimize your calling experience  so you can hear clearly and don t need to speak louder to  overcome surrounding noise     The noise suppression technology is built in and already enabled in your new mobile phone  So it s ready to provide unsurpassed  voice clarity with every call     Table of Contents    Section 1  Getting Started                            Understanding this User Manual               Battery Cover                000000 ee eee  Baltery  1  senescere E  Extending Your Battery Life                 Initial Device Configuration                 Switching the Device On or Off              Restarting the Device                      Locking and Unlocking the Device            Creating a New Google Account              Signing into Your Google Account            Retrieving your Google Account Password      Confirming the Default Image and Video   Storage Location              ssssuu   Creating a Samsung Account                Voice Mail              0 00 cece eee  Visual Voicemail               00 cee  Task Manager                 200000  Google NOW           00  c eee eee ees    Section 2  Understanding Your Device      27  Features of Your Device                   27  FFODEVIOW  5t ette oe rcd 28  Back VIEW usus cin Santee beoe eee dues 30  Side  VIBWS  ts sedie here aha    31  Device Display           sssssesseeeese 32  Status Bar oo    eee E 32  Function KeyS            0000 cece 40  Home Screen  
318. our face is not recognized  choose an unlocking  method  Pattern or PIN     300    Face unlock options  Once Face unlock is enabled  additional options are  available      Lock screen widgets allows you to lock the widgets that are  displayed on your home screens      Improve facial recognition allows you to improve your  device s face matching capability by capturing your face in  different lighting  with or without glasses  and bearded or  clean shaven  Follow the on screen instructions    Presence check requires that you blink when using the Face  unlock feature  This will increase the security of the feature    Lock automatically locks the screen 5 seconds after the  screen tums off      Lock instantly with power key once enabled  instantly locks  the screen after pressing the power key              Using Face and Voice Unlock    This feature used facial recognition to unlock your phone   This feature is less secure than PIN  Pattern  and Password  locks and can be bypassed by someone else who looks  similar to you     1     From the Home screen  press ml and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen    Tap Screen lock  gt  Face and voice    Read the on screen notification and tap Next    From the About Face Unlock screen  tap Set it up  gt   Continue    Follow the on screen instructions    Once prompted to speak and unlock command  tap  and repeat the phrase four times    Once complete  tap Done     Setting an Unlock Pattern    Creating a screen unlock patte
319. p        gt  P  gt  Add to playlist to add the song to    a playlist     The Now playing screen contains several buttons that you  can tap to control the playback of songs  albums  and    playlists     Tap to go back to the previous song  Touch and  hold to scan backward through the current song   Tap to resume playback     Tap to pause playback     Tap to advance to the next song  Touch and hold to  scan forward through the current song     Multimedia 197    A    AMNA     PF    When Shuffle mode is enabled via Show Options   songs play in random order  When disabled    as shown   songs play in the order they appear  in List view  Also visible when EI is tapped     When Shuffle mode is enabled via Show Options   songs play in random order  When enabled   songs play in random order  Also visible when    EI is tapped     Tap to repeat the current song   repeat all songs  or disable repeat mode   Also visible when EI is tapped     Creating a Playlist    1     198    From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    G  Play Music     Tap an album or song list and play a song    Tap HB  gt  P adjacent to the song name and  select Add to playlist     4  Tap New playlist   gt  Playlist name field to enter a name    for the playlist     5  Tap OKto save the new playlist   Adding Songs to Playlists    1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   e  Play Music     2  Tapan album or song list and play a song    3  Tap El  gt  P adjacent to the song name and  select Add to playlist    4  Select the d
320. picture  tap anywhere on the screen to different folder  display them  d     f      Print  allows you to print the current image on a compatible  2  The following options are available at the top of the Samsung printer   Screen      Rename  allows you to rename the current file     Share via  lt    allows you to share the picture via ChatoON      Set as  allows you to assign the current image as a Contact  Group Play  Bluetooth  Dropbox  Email  Flipboard  Gmail  photo  Home screen  Lock screen  or Home and lock screens   Google   Messaging  Picasa  S Memo  and Wi Fi Direct      Buddy photo share  allows you to share the current image    Edit  ri allows you to edit the current image  Launches the with active ChatON buddies   Photo Editor application  For more information  refer to     Rotate left  allows you to rotate the view of the current image in   Editing a Photo  on page 179  a counterclockwise direction         Rotate right  allows you to rotate the view of the current image    Delete T   allows you to delete the current picture  in a clockwise direction     Multimedia 169        Crop  provides an on screen box that allows you to crop the  current picture  Tap Done to update the image with the new  dimensions or tap Cancel to ignore any changes        Detect text  launches the Photo Reader application that can  then detect text within the new photo        Scan for nearby devices  scans for nearby DLNA compliant  devices that can receive or display the current image     
321. port  services related to the Software provided to you  if any   Samsung Electronics Co  and its affiliates may use this  information solely to improve their products or to provide    customized services or technologies to you and will not  disclose this information in a form that personally identifies  you    5  UPGRADES  This EULA applies to updates  supplements  and add on components  if any  of the Software that  Samsung Electronics Co  may provide to you or make  available to you after the date you obtain your initial copy of  the Software  unless we provide other terms along with such  upgrade  To use Software identified as an upgrade  you must  first be licensed for the Software identified by Samsung  Electronics Co  as eligible for the upgrade  After upgrading   you may no longer use the Software that formed the basis for  your upgrade eligibility    6  SOFTWARE TRANSFER  You may not transfer this EULA or  the rights to the Software granted herein to any third party  unless it is in connection with the sale of the mobile device  which the Software accompanied  In such event  the transfer  must include all of the Software  including all component  parts  the media and printed materials  any upgrades  this  EULA  and you may not retain any copies of the Software   The transfer may not be an indirect transfer  such as a  consignment  Prior to the transfer  the end user receiving the  Software must agree to all the EULA terms     Warranty Information 385    7  EXPORT REST
322. pping the phone or the  battery  especially on a hard surface  can potentially cause  damage to the phone and battery  If you suspect damage to the  phone or battery  take it to a service center for inspection       Never use any charger or battery that is damaged in any way       Do not allow the battery to touch metal objects  Accidental  short circuiting can occur when a metallic object  coin  key   jewelry  clip  or pen  causes a direct connection between the     and   terminals of the battery  metal strips on the battery   for  example when you carry a spare battery in a pocket or bag   Short circuiting the terminals may damage the battery or the  object causing the short circuiting     Important  Use only Samsung approved batteries  and  recharge your battery only with  Samsung approved chargers which are  specifically designed for your phone     WARNING     Use of a non Samsung approved battery or charger may  present a risk of fire  explosion  leakage  or other hazard   Samsung s warranty does not cover damage to the phone  caused by nonSamsung approved batteries and or chargers       Do not use incompatible cell phone batteries and chargers   Some websites and second hand dealers not associated with  reputable manufacturers and carriers  might be selling  incompatible or even counterfeit batteries and chargers   Consumers should purchase manufacturer or  carrier recommended products and accessories  If unsure about  whether a replacement battery or charger is compati
323. pplication manager  gt   Downloaded     2  Tapthe third party application  and from the 4  Onits initial launch  navigate the application to begin          Application info screen  tap Uninstall  use   POLARIS Office 5   New  creates a new office document   Polaris Office Mobile for Android is a Microsoft Office   Recent documents  provides a scrollable list of recently  compatible office suite  This application provides a central accessed documents   place for managing your documents online or offline    Menu  provides access to Settings and Help   The application can also open Adobe PDF  Portable   Samples  provides access to sample Word  PowerPoint  and  Document Format  files  Excel files    1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt  e File Browser  allows you to search on your device and SD card  r  POLARIS Office 5   for compatible documents    2  From the Registration screen  enter your Email   Form type  allows you to quickly access your documents  information  if desired  and tap Register to complete based on file type  Each type is separated into several available  the process  tabs located at the bottom of the screen  such as  Word  Excel       or    PowerPoint  Other  and PDF    Tap Skip to ignore this registration  The main Polaris e Favorites  allows you to list only those documents tagged as  Office screen displays  Favorite    3  Follow the on screen instructions to use Polaris Office    View Together  once connected to the same Wi Fi  you can   share or coll
324. pplications that were not properly closed or  shutdown and are still active but minimized  The Task  Manager not only lets you see which of these applications  are still active in the background but also easily lets you  choose which applications are left running and which are  closed     Note  The larger the number of applications running on your  phone  the larger the energy drain on your battery     Task Manger Overview Shutting Down an Currently Active Application    m Press and hold     Home  and then tap 5 m Press and hold    Home  and then tap El   Task manager   This screen contains the following  End all   tabs   ior     Active applications display those currently active applications 1  Press and hold    Home  and then tap 5  running on your phone   Task manager      Downloaded displays any installed packages or applications 2  From the Active applications tab  tap End to close  from the Play Store that are taking up memory space  Tap selected applications     Uninstall to remove them from your phone      RAM  which displays the amount of current RAM  Random  Access Memory  currently being used and allow you to Clear  Memory      Storage displays a visual graph indicating the available and  used space within the System storage  USB storage  and  external SD card     Tap End all to close all background running  applications     Getting Started 25    Google Now  Google Now   recognizes a users    repeated actions  performed on the device  including access of common  lo
325. provides haptic  feedback for actions   and SoundBack  plays sounds for  various actions   Also lets you enable use of the power key to  end calls  mu   1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap    Settings  gt   My device tab   gt  Accessibility     Note  Initially  it might be necessary to download accessibility  applications from the Play Store     2  Select the Auto rotate screen field to activate this  feature which automatically rotates an available  screen    3  Tap Screen timeout to timeout the accessibility feature  after a defined amount of time     4  Tap Lock automatically to lock the screen automatically       alter a selected ammount ot limo  Important  TalkBack can collect all of the text you enter     except passwords  including personal data and  credit card numbers  It may also log your user    Note  The Lock automatically function is only available if your            interface interactions with the device     device is already using the screen lock feature     10  Tap the Font size field to change the size of the fonts  used on the device within menus  options  etc    Choose from  Tiny  Small  Normal  Large  or Huge     methods you can use to answer and end a call  11  Enable Magnification gestures to use exaggerated    7  Tap Show shortcut allows you to press and hold gestures aug i triple tapping  double pinching  and    dragging two fingers across the screen         Power End  to use the accessibility shortcut  under the Device options screen  12  T
326. pted  separate the two devices     Camera Gallery Options    The Gallery is where you can access the Gallery of stored  camera images     1     From the Home screen  tap dE  Apps   gt  bx   Gallery      Select a folder location  ex  Camera  and tap an image  to open it     or    Touch and hold an image to place a box around the file  and select multiple files     or    Tap the upper right camera to begin taking pictures  that are placed in this folder     or    Tap the on screen image to use additional image menu    options  For more information  refer to  Pictures and  Videos Image Viewer Options  on page 169     Sharing a Gallery Image to a Target Device    Important  Make sure all communicating devices are    connected to the same Wi Fi     Launch Samsung Link on the target device  such as an  Internet TV  Samsung Tablet  etc        From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt  PX   Gallery      Note  You must be signed in to your Samsung Account before    3   4     you can use this feature     Open a selected image    Tap  Stream to connected devices  and select an  available target device to begin streaming    On a target device  ex  Internet TV  select the  on screen Allow button to continue     Note  At this stage your device is requesting access to share    media with the external source     Multimedia 177    6     Confirm  AllShare Controller enabled  appears in    the Notification area at the top of the device to indicate  you are using your device as the media source   
327. ptions after a lock mode is  enabled      Lock screen widgets allows you to lock the widgets that are  displayed on your home screens      Shortcuts sets shortcuts to appear at the bottom of the Lock  screen  Touch and slide the slider to the right to turn it on      Unlock effect sets the effect you receive when unlocking the  phone  You can select None  Ripple effect  or Light effect      Help text shows help information on the Lock screen      Wake up in lock screen requires that you say a command to  wake up your phone      Set wake up command designates your wake up  commands  Tap Set wake up command and follow the  on screen prompts to create a new verbal command                    Changing Your Settings 299    Using Swipe  This feature is the least secure locking method and only  requires that a user swipe the screen to unlock the device   1  From the Home screen  press        and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen   2  Tap Screen lock  gt  Swipe   Using Face Unlock    This feature used facial recognition to unlock your phone   This feature is less secure than PIN  Pattern  and Password  locks and can be bypassed by someone else who looks  similar to you     1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen    2  Tap Screen lock Face unlock   Read the on screen notification and tap Next     4  From the About Face Unlock screen  tap Set it up  gt   Continue     5  Follow the on screen instructions     6  If y
328. put  Motions and gestures  Smart screen  Air  view  and Voice control     MW Accounts     Accounts  This tab provides both the ability to create and  modify your accounts  ex  Samsung account   Email  etc    configure Cloud functionality  and  access Backup and reset features               This tab provides access to the remaining set of    device settings not listed under the other three tabs     These include Location services  Security   Application manager  Battery  Storage  Date and  time  and About device     Note  The settings for your device are described below using    the order in which they appear in the Settings menu   Functions found under the Connections tab are listed  first  followed by My device  Accounts  and More tabs     Wi Fi Settings  This section describes the Wi Fi settings  For more  information  refer to    Wi Fi    on page 273     Activating Wi Fi m  1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  WA  Connections tab      2  In a single motion touch and slide the Wi Fi slider to the  right to turn it on BE  The device scans for  available in range wireless networks and displays  them under Wi Fi networks on the same screen    Wi Fi settings  Once set up for Wi Fi connectivity  your device automatically  uses Wi Fi  when available  for all your mobile services    1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab 2 Wi Fi        2  Press      and then tap Advanced  Configure the  settings as desired     The avail
329. r    222    tap in the search field to locate a city     To assign DST settings     1   2   3     Locate a desired city from the World clock list   Touch and hold a city and select DST settings   Select a DST setting  Automatic  Off  or 1 hour     If Daylight Savings Time is selected  a sun symbol  appears next to the World Clock city listing     Stopwatch    This feature allows you to capture elapsed time while letting the  stopwatch keep running     1     go Pen    From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt     amp   Clock   gt  Stopwatch tab    Tap Start to start the stopwatch counter    Tap Lap to begin the lap time counter    Tap Stop to stop the counter    Tap Restart to restart the lap counter  You can have  multiple lap times    Tap Reset to reset the counter     Setting a Timer    1     5     From the Home screen  tap um  Apps   gt     S  Clock   gt  Timer tab    Tap the Hours  Minutes  or Seconds field and use the  on screen keypad to enter the hour  minute  or  seconds  The timer plays an alarm at the end of the  countdown    Tap Start to start the timer    Tap Stop to stop the timer or Reset to reset the timer  and start over     Tap Restart to resume the timer counter     Configuring a Desk Clock    This feature lets you activate an on screen clock that can be  viewed when the device is docked     Note  You might have to scroll across the tabs to locate the    From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps  9   SO   Clock   gt  Desk clock tab  The default Desk clock  is display
330. r  bag or in the air bag deployment area  If wireless equipment is  improperly installed and the air bag inflates  serious injury could  result      Switch your mobile device off before boarding an aircraft  The use  of wireless mobile devices in aircraft is illegal and may be  dangerous to the aircraft s operation  Check with appropriate  authorities before using any function of a mobile device while on  an aircraft      Failure to observe these instructions may lead to the suspension  or denial of cell phone services to the offender  or legal action  or  both      While using your device  leave some lights on in the room and do  not hold the screen too close to your eyes      Seizures or blackouts can occur when you are exposed to flashing  lights while watching videos or playing games for extended  periods  If you feel any discomfort  stop using the device  immediately     378      Reduce risk of repetitive motion injuries  When you repetitively  perform actions  such as pressing keys  drawing characters on a  touch screen with your fingers  or playing games  you may  experience occasional discomfort in your hands  neck  shoulders   or other parts of your body  When using your device for extended  periods  hold the device with a relaxed grip  press the keys lightly   and take frequent breaks  If you continue to have discomfort  during or after such use  stop use and see a physician       f your device has a camera flash or light  do not use the flash or  light close to the
331. r  computer and your new device appears in the list of  registered DivX devices     Important  There is no special registration or configuration  necessary to playback DRM free DivX movies   Registration of your device is only required for  playback of protected DivX material     Samsung Hub    Samsung Hub makes it easy to find  sample  and purchase  movies  TV shows  books  games  and music  in one user   friendly location  With hundreds of titles available   entertaining your family on the go has never been easier   You can rent or purchase your favorite content and watch  from any location  Samsung Hub is your gateway to mobile  entertainment     You must have an active Samsung Account to purchase and  rent content via Samsung Hub     Note  Samsung Hub usage is based on service availability   Important  You must be using an active Wi Fi 4G LTE  connection to preview and download a media file     The internal memory acts as a storage location for  your downloaded rental or purchase     Multimedia 185    Important  The Samsung account manages the access  information  username password  to several  applications  such as Samsung Link  Chat On  and  Samsung Hub     Creating a New Samsung Hub Account  Before you can rent or buy media  you must first create an  account  Enter the required information    1  Confirm you have already logged in to your Samsung  account    2  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt   6  Samsung Hub     3  When prompted to connect via mobile networks  
332. r Contact sharing  option to all so that your entire Contacts entries are sent as a  group and not as multiple single files  If all your entries are  selected only a single file is sent     Note  Your destination device must support this feature or no    entries will be received by the external device         Send individual namecards allows you to set your default to  send individual contacts one at a time  Even if you select all your  entries  each is sent individually     Groups    This feature allows you to add a new or existing contact to a  call group  This group can be one of the already present  groups  Family  Friends  or Work  or a user created group     Creating a New Caller Group    1     From the Home screen  tap B  gt   Groups  tab      Press I and then tap Create   Tap the Group name field and use the on screen  keypad to enter a new group name  For more    information  refer to  Text Input Methods  on page 98     Tap Group ringtone and select a ringtone for the group   Selections are  Default ringtone  Ringtones  select from  available ringtones  or Add  to navigate your device and  select an existing audio file     Tap Message alert and select a message alert ringtone  to be associated with this group    Tap Vibration pattern and select a unique vibration  pattern either from an available list or Create your own   This pattern is then associated with this group    Tap Add member to add Contacts to the new group     9     From the available list of contacts  t
333. r Settings 335    Voice control  The Voice control settings allow you to set up voice  commands to control your device   1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Voice control   2  Verify the feature is active by tapping BEN  at the  top of your screen to activate Voice control   3  The following options are available  Tap an option to  create a checkmark and activate the feature     Incoming calls  allows you to answer or reject calls using the  commands Answer and Reject     ChatON  allows you to answer or reject calls using the  commands Answer and Reject     Alarm  allows you to stop or snooze an alarm by using the  commands Stop and Snooze     Camera  allows you to take pictures using the voice  commands Smile  Cheese  Capture  or Shoot     Music  allows you to control your Music player using the voice  commands Next  Previous  Pause  Play  Volume Up  and  Volume Down           336    Vote  If you set the alert type for calls or alarms to vibration   voice control will not be available     Add Account    This menu allows you to set up  manage  and synchronize  accounts  including your Google and email accounts   Adding an Account m   1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt   Accounts tab     2  Navigate to the My accounts area and then tap Add  account and select one of the account types    3  Use the keyboard and follow the prompts to enter your  credentials and set up the account    4  Agreen circle will appe
334. r allows you to assign the current wallpaper for the  Home screen  Lock screen  or Home and lock screens  Choose  from Gallery  Live wallpapers  or Wallpapers      Edit page allows you to add or remove extended screens from  your device  You can have up to six extended screens  one Home  screen and six Extended screens       Search displays the Google Search box that you can use to  search for a key term online      Settings provides quick access to the device s settings menu       The Settings menu can also be accessed by pressing  C    and then tapping EA  gt  Settings     Applications  The Application menu provides quick access to the most  frequently used applications  Applications display on each of  the three panels on the Applications screens     Important  Once you log into your Google account  All  previously downloaded apps should now be  populated within the Application screens     Application Screen Menu Settings    When on the Apps screen  the following menu options are  available     1  Press and then tap E  Apps      2  Press l je and then select from the following options     Play Store  provides quick access to the Play Store  page 242      Edit allows you to organize your current applications by moving  them around the screen  edit or delete existing Apps folders     Create folder  allows you to create an application folder where  you can better organize and group desired apps       Uninstall  allows you to uninstall a user downloaded  application  Only thos
335. r off           Restarting the Device  1  Press and hold        e  Power End  until the Device  options screen appears     2  Tap Restart   2     Locking and Unlocking the Device  By default  the device screen locks when the backlight turns  off   m Place your finger on the screen and swipe the glass in  any of the directions shown unlock the device     Note  You can choose to configure lock settings to prevent  unauthorized use of your device  For more information   refer to    Security    on page 345     Creating a New Google Account  You should create a Google    Account when you first use  your device in order to fully utilize the functionality  This  account provides access to several device features such as  Gmail   Talk   and the Google Play Store  applications   Before you are able to access Google applications  you must  enter your account information  These applications sync  between your device and your online Google account   To create a new Google Account from your device   1  From the Home screen  tap S  Play Store    2  Read the introduction and tap New to begin   3  Follow the on screen instructions to create a Google  Account    or   If this is not the first time you are starting the device   tap Ea  gt  IVA   Gmail      Note  If you already have a Google account  you only need to  sign in     Getting Started     19    To create a new Google Account from the Web     1     From a computer  launch a Web browser and navigate  to www google com    On the main pag
336. r then  drag it to resize the desired window        To split the current applications   1  With the two applications shown in a split screen  tap  the Border bar to show the on screen icons   2  Tap the desired application area  top or bottom    3  Locate and tap mn  Maximize the app   The current  apps are the both maximized   To close a selected application   1  With the two applications shown in a split screen  tap  one of the two on screen apps to select it   2  Tapthe Border bar to show the on screen icons   3  Locate and tap   x    Close the app   The current app is  close and the remaining app is maximized     Menu Navigation Using Sub Menus    You can tailor the device s range of functions to fit your needs Sub menus are available from within most screen and  using both menus and applications  Menus  sub menus  and applications   features are accessed by scrolling through the available 1  Press     A sub menu displays at the bottom of the  on screen menus  Your device defaults with seven screens  screen    Navigating Through the Application Menus 2  Tap an available on screen option     There are three default Application Menu screens available   As you add more applications from the Play Store  more  screens are created to house these new apps     1  From the Home screen  tap Eis  Apps   The first  Application Menu screen displays     To close the Applications screen  press    Home    2  Sweep the screen to access the other menus        3  Tap any of the on screen ic
337. r to  Notification Bar  on page  38     or    From the Home screen  tap bad then tap the new  message to view its contents  The selected message  displays on the screen     Tap to play a multimedia message      To pause playback of the multimedia message  tap NI     In a single motion  touch and drag up or down the page  to scroll through the message  if additional pages were  added      Message Threads    Sent and received text and  picture messages are  grouped into message  threads  Threaded messages  allow you to see all the  messages exchanged  similar  to a chat program  and  displays a contact on the  Screen     Message threads are listed in  the order in which they were  received  with the latest  message displayed at the  top     To reply to a text message   1  From the Home screen   tap W     2  While the message is    Current Recipient My Text    03 11 2013 Thu       Gwertyutltogp    Parana       Tieixevbunm E    Sym 44    Reply Bubble  Text Message Thread    ws    open  tap the Enter message field and then type your    reply message     3     Compose your reply    Your texts are colored Blue and your caller s replies are  Yellow   Tap   RA   or   Press    and then select one of the available  message options  page 132          Send  to deliver your reply              To access message thread options     From the main Messaging screen  touch and hold the   message to display the following options    e View contact  displays the Contact s Overview page      Add to c
338. rack  the account      Always Cc Bcc myself allows you to include your own email  address in either the CC  Bcc  or None fields  Lets you always  receive a copy of outgoing emails      Forward with attachments    ets you include attachments  when forwarding an email             Show images  allows you to view embedded images located  within the body of the currently displayed email      Auto download attachments  allows the device to  automatically download email attachments when an active  Wi Fi connection is detected  This process speeds up the  process of downloading an emails attachments for offline  review by not using a 3G or 4G LTE network connection          Auto resend times enables the phone to resend an outgoing  email a specified number of times if delivery fails   The default is 3 auto resends      Folder sync settings allows you to configure the sync settings  for various folders such as Inbox  Drafts  Outbox  etc       Period to sync Calendar assigns a period for your phone to  sync calendar events  Choose from  2 weeks  1 month   3 months  6 months  or All calendar    e Empty server trash  allows you to delete your email account s  trash bin remotely    Sync Contacts synchronizes the contacts between your device  and the remote exchange server    Sync Calendar synchronizes your exchange calendar entries  between your device and the remote exchange server    Sync Task synchronizes your exchange tasks entries between  your device and the remote exchange server  
339. re     Voicemail  You can view your voicemail number from this menu    1  From the Home screen  tap ay  Phone     2  Press l   and then tap Call settings  gt  Voicemail  service    3  If an additional voicemail service is in use  other than  carrier   tap Voice settings to now view your selected  voicemail number and information    Sound   Device Ringtone  This option allows you to assign your default device ringtone    1  From the Home screen  tap W  Phone     2  Press    and then tap Call settings  gt  Sound    3  Select a ringtone and tap OK     Changing Your Settings 319    Vibrate  This option allows you to activate a vibration for an incoming  call   1  From the Home screen  tap  Phone    2  Press   and then tap Call settings   3  Tap the Vibrate field to toggle the feature on or off   TTY Mode    A TTY  also known as a TDD or Text Telephone  is a  telecommunications device that allows people who are deaf   hard of hearing  or who have speech or language disabilities   to communicate by telephone    Your device is compatible with select TTY devices  Please  check with the manufacturer of your TTY device to ensure  that it is compatible with digital cell phones    Your phone and TTY device will connect via a special cable  that plugs into your phone s headset jack  If this cable was  not provided with your TTY device  contact your TTY device  manufacturer to purchase the connector cable     320    From the Home screen  tap  Phone      Press m and then tap Call settings  
340. re interested in  and tap the name     3  Read the application descriptions      Apps   gt     Important  If the selected application requires access to data    4     Note  Use caution with applications which request access to    5     or control of a function on your device  the Play  Store displays the information the application will  access    Tap OK if you agree to the conditions of the  application  Once you tap OK on this screen you are  responsible for using this application on the device  and the amount of data it uses  Use this feature  with caution     Tap Install  gt  Accept  amp  download     any personal data  functions  or significant amounts of  data usage times     If prompted  follow the on screen instructions to pay  for the application    Check the progress of the current download by  opening the Notifications panel  The content download  icon n appears in the notification area of the status  bar     7  Onthe main Play Store screen  press m and then  tap My Apps  tap an installed application in the list  and  then tap Open     Tip  The newly downloaded applications display in the  applications list and are shown in alphabetical order if the  View Type is set to Alphabetical grid or Alphabetical list  or  at the end of the list if View type is set to Customizable  grid     Note  A data plan is required to use this feature  Charges may    apply  Please contact your service provider for further  details     Applications and Development 243    Launching an Ins
341. reason and  your screen is locked  the number of missed calls are  displayed on the Lock screen immediately after a call is  missed     1   2     Press       o  Power End  to reactivate the screen   Touch and drag the button  with the number of missed  calls on it  anywhere on the screen  The Logs tab is  then displayed     Call Functions and Contacts List    97    Section 5  Entering Text    This section describes how to select the desired text input  method when entering characters into your device  This  section also describes the predictive text entry system that  reduces the amount of key strokes associated with entering  text    Your device comes equipped with an orientation detector that  can tell if the phone is being held in an upright  Portrait  or  sideways  Landscape  orientation  This is useful when  entering text    Your device also provides several on screen keypad text  entry options to make the task of text entry that much easier     Text Input Methods    There are three text input methods available    e Google voice typing  provides a voice to text interface       Samsung keyboard  default   an on screen QWERTY  keyboard that can be used in both portrait and landscape  orientation       Swype  is enabled so as you can enter text as you swipe  across the on screen keyboard  Instead of tapping each  key  use your finger to trace over each letter of a word     98    The on screen QWERTY keypad works the same in both  portrait and landscape mode    Selecting the
342. received  including  interference that may cause undesired operation    Note  This equipment has been tested and found to comply  with the limits for a Class B digital device  pursuant to part  15 of the FCC Rules  These limits are designed to provide  reasonable protection against harmful interference in a  residential installation  This equipment generates  uses and  can radiate radio frequency energy and  if not installed and  used in accordance with the instructions  may cause harmful  interference to radio communications    However  there is no guarantee that interference will not  occur in a particular installation  If this equipment does  cause harmful interference to radio or television reception   which can be determined by turning the equipment off and  on  the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference  by one or more of the following measures     362      Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna    e Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver       Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from  that to which the receiver is connected      Consult the dealer or an experienced radio TV technician for help     Commercial Mobile Alerting System   CMAS     This device is designed to receive wireless emergency alerts  from the Commercial Mobile Alerting System   CMAS    which may also be known as the Personal Localized Alerting  Network   PLAN     If your wireless provider has chosen to  participate in CMAS PLAN  alerts ar
343. recordings Wo  etc        It name is Voice  your        Noise reduction  allows you to activate deactivate background  noise suppression       Recording volume  allows you to assign the ambient noise  quality of your current location so the device can better detect  audio  Choose from High or Low       Channel  allows you to assign recording mode to either Mono  or Stereo       Skip interval  allows you to assign a skip length     End  allows you to exit the application   Voice Search  Launches the Google Now application that is used for voice  to text Internet searching   1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt    Voice Search    2  When prompted  speak into the built in microphone   3  Use the on screen options to find a matching search  term        VPN Client    This is a full featured VPN Client that provides support for the  latest IPSec VPN standards and provides interoperability with  support for all major VPN Gateways   1  From the Home screen  tap   VPN Client   2  Follow the on screen instructions to configure the VPN  Client     Options include  Add VPN Connection or My VPN Connections   WatchON    With the WatchON application  you can use your device as a  remote control for your TV      Apps   gt     Note  Access to this feature requires that you already be  logged in to your Samsung account application  For  more information  refer to  Creating a Samsung  Account  on page 21     m From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt     G  WatchON      For more informatio
344. rediction results better  By enabling  you can choose from the following personalization    io make  this feature  features       Learn from Facebook allows you to log into your current    Facebook account and add used text to your perso  dictionary   e Learn from Gmail  allows you to sign in to your exi  account from where your style and existing contac       nal       isting Gmail  information          is added to your personal dictionary  Helps recognize familiar    names     Learn from Twitter allows you to sign into your exi  account and add used text to your personal diction    sting Twitter  ary       Learn from Messaging allows your device to learn your       messaging style by using your Messaging informal          ion       Learn from Contacts updates predictive style by learning your    Contacts style     Changing Your Settings    327      Clear remote data allows you to delete your anonymous data  Stored on the personalization server     Clear personal data removes all personalized data entered by  the user   4  Press    to return to the previous screen   Swype Settings  To configure Swype settings     1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Language and input  gt   65  adjacent to the Swype field    2  Tap How to Swype to view an on screen manual for  Swype   3  Tap Gestures to view an on screen reference page  related to Gesture usage   4  Tap Preferences to alter these settings     Vibrate on keypress  activates a vibrat
345. reen  tap 8E  gt M  Gmail    2  Tap an existing email message  m    Messages 155    Refreshing Gmail Mail    m From within the Gmail message list  tap 5  Refresh     at the bottom of the screen to refresh the screen  send  and receive new emails  and synchronize your email  with the Gmail account     Other Gmail Options    1     From the main Gmail screen  tap Q  Labels  at the  bottom of the screen to set up and manage Labels for  your Gmail messages    From the main Gmail screen  tap Q  Search  at the  bottom of the screen to search through your Gmail  messages     Composing a Gmail Message    1   2     3     From the Home screen   z  gt M   Gmail      From the Gmail Inbox  tap ee  Compose  at the  bottom of the screen to create a new message   Enter the recipients Email address in the To field     Tip  Separate multiple recipient email addresses with a  comma     156    7     Press E and select Add Cc Bcc to add a carbon or  blind copy    Enter the subject of this message in the Subject field   Tap the Compose email field and begin composing your  message    Once complete tap  gt   Send      Viewing a Gmail Message    1     From the Gmail Inbox  tap a message to view the  following options located at the bottom of the screen   e Archive  J  archives the selected Email       Delete      deletes the currently selected Email      Labels G  assigns a label to the current Email      Mark as Unread Ez  tags the current message as unread  and returns you to the Google Mail Inbox 
346. reen real time map functionality    Navigation Map options  Once on the map screen  you can access the following  features     Destination  returns you to the previous Navigation options  screen     Search by voice  Speak your destination instead of typing     Layers  allows you to switch map views    e Traffic view   available only in selected areas  Real time traffic  conditions are displayed over roads as color coded lines  Each  color represents how fast the traffic is moving      Satellite  Maps uses the same satellite data as Google Earth   Satellite images are not real time  Google Earth acquires the  best imagery available  most of which is approximately one to  three years old          Parking  displays parking information relative to your current  location     Gas stations  displays gas station location relative to your  current location     ATMs  amp  banks  displays ATM and Bank locations relative to  your current location     Restaurants  displays restaurant and eatery locations relative  to your current location   While on the map screen  press   1 to access additional  options  ERE    Set destination  returns you to the navigation options screen  where you can access a destination by either Speaking  Typing  or  selecting from a Contacts entry or Starred Place     Search  manually search for a destination address  place  name  of business  or even a type of business     Layers  allows you to switch map views  See previous  description     Settings  provides acc
347. ress and hold to fast forward the song  Tap to  go to next song   Volume control     Volume control showing volume muted    Plays the entire song list once    Replays the current list when the list ends   Repeats the currently playing song    Shuffles the current list of songs randomly   Songs play in order and are not shuffled    Lists the current playlist songs    Displays the current song in the player window     Assign the current song as a Favorite     Streams the current music file to another device  via Samsung Link     Making a Song a Phone Ringtone    1     Note  Additional Set as options include Caller ringtone and    From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    o  Music     Tap the Songs tab    Touch and hold a song from the list to reveal the  on screen context menu    Tap Set as Phone ringtone    Choose a starting point for the ringtone to start playing  from  Select either From the beginning or Auto  recommendations  you can allow the application to  choose the best part to start from      Alarm tone     Music Options    The Music settings menu allows you to set preferences for  the music player such as whether you want the music to play  in the background  sound effects  and how the music menu  displays     With the application displayed and playing a song    press x and select one of the following options      Via Bluetooth  scans for devices and pairs with a Bluetooth  headset      Share music  allows you to share music with others via the  Group Play application 
348. restarting rented Media Content does not  extend the available viewing time     188    Using WatchON    Important  Before initiating use  verify you have an active  Internet connection available  either mobile  network or Wi Fi connection      Note  Before beginning your initial WatchON application setup     confirm your TV is turned off     For more information  refer to www samsungwatchon com   Initial Configuration  1  Sign into your Samsung account   2  From the Home screen  tap Eg  Apps   gt    S  matenon        Note  If you are not connected to an active Wi Fi  you may be    prompted to continue the set up process via a mobile  network  Click Connect to proceed     3  Select your desired country for your TV Guide s source  listing and tap Next     4  Enter your current zip code and tap Done  This zip code  must correspond to the location of your desired TV and  set top box    5  From the Find your TV service screen  select a service  provider from the available channel listing    6  From the Choose your TV Brand screen  tap your TV s  manufacturer name    e  f you have a brand of TV not listed or you are using a projector   Select from one of the following two options  Choose from  either Other TV Brands or   Have a Projector    7  Aim your device at the TV and tap      Power  to  confirm the set up process completed successfully and  the correct TV IR codes were selected     Note  The process of the initial TV activation can take up to 10    seconds  Please do not pres
349. results  To learn how to properly control  motions  tap ERR  Apps  Settings My device tab   gt  Motions and gestures  When tapped  each entry  comes with an on screen tutorial     e Air gesture  Allows you to control your device by performing  motions above the sensor  without touching the device       Motion  Allows you to control your device using natural  movements  on the screen       Palm motion  Allows you to control your device by touching the  screen with your entire hand      Gyroscope calibration  Allows you to properly calibrate your  device s touch screen     Changing Your Settings 331    To activate Air gesture  c  1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures   2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Air gesture slider  to the right to turn it on   3  Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At least one feature must be activated before Air gesture    can be activated     4  Tap Learn about sensor and icon field to review  on screen information about the Air gestures sensor  and related icon    5  Ina single motion  slide a feature s activation slider to  the on position  fS     The following is a description some of the most commonly   used gestures      Quick glance  Once enabled  you can move your hand over the  air gesture sensor  located above the on screen clock at the  upper right  to temporarily activate preview window that can be  used to display selected user enabled information su
350. right to turn it on    Tap S Beam and make sure the feature is turned on    If not already active  in a single motion touch and slide  the S Beam slider to the right to turn it on    On the source device  containing the desired image or  video   tap  Apps   gt  x  Gallery     Locate and tap the selected image to open it in the  preview window     Multimedia 175    Important  Neither device must be in Lock mode or displaying    the Lock screen  They must both be active and  unlocked  It is recommended that the target device  be on the Home screen     7  Placethe two active NFC enabled devices back to back  to begin     Note  If the Touch to beam screen does not appear on the  Source device     Pull them apart    Verify the image is visible in the preview window on  the source device  providing the file     Place them together again    8  From the Touch to beam screen  tap the reduced image  preview to begin the transfer  After a few seconds   depending on file size  the recipient with then see the  transferred file displayed on their screen     176    To share multiple pictures via S Beam    1  On the source device  containing the desired image or  video   tap  Apps   gt  XR  Gallery     2  Locate the selected folder    3  Touch and hold the first image and place a check mark  on it and all desired images    4  Placethe two active NFC enabled devices back to back  to begin    5  From the Touch to beam screen  tap the reduced image  preview to begin the transfer    6  When prom
351. righter  clearer pictures in low light   settings without the use of the flash              Image viewer  allows you to access the Image             Multimedia 165    n          166    Effects Downloads  provides access to pre installed  and downloaded effects  Default effects include   No effect  Vignette  Grey scale  Sepia  Vintage  Faded  color  Turquoise  Tint  Cartoon  Moody  Rugged  Oil  pastel  and Fisheye     Camcorder button  shoots a video when pressed     Camera button  takes a photo when pressed in  Camera mode     Mode button  allows you to select from different  camera modes     Storage location Connection Status  indicates the  device is connected to an adapter and the current  storage location for images  Phone or Memory card   on the device     Quick Settings    Tap at the top of the display to quickly change Camera  settings  Not all of the following options are available in both  still camera and video camera modes  The available options  vary by mode       n  Zo         LFF    Camera settings  configure Camera settings   Flash  activate or deactivate the flash     Night detection  use this activate deactivate night  detection     Voice control  activate or deactivate the voice control  to take photos     Recording mode  select a resolution for videos   Choose from  Normal  Limit for MMS  Slow motion  or  Fast motion     Share functions  activate or deactivate the sharing  options  Choose from Off  Share Shot  Buddy photo  share  ChatON phot share  or Remot
352. rmanent storage media of one computer  and use the Software on a single computer or a mobile  device at a time  and you may not make the Software  available over a network where it could be used by multiple  computers at the same time  You may make one copy of the  Software in machine readable form for backup purposes  only  provided that the backup copy must include all  copyright or other proprietary notices contained on the  original     2  RESERVATION OF RIGHTS AND OWNERSHIP  Samsung  Electronics Co  reserves all rights not expressly granted to  you in this EULA  The Software is protected by copyright and  other intellectual property laws and treaties  Samsung  Electronics Co  or its suppliers own the title  copyright and  other intellectual property rights in the Software  The  Software is licensed  not sold    3  LIMITATIONS ON END USER RIGHTS  You may not reverse  engineer  decompile  disassemble  or otherwise attempt to  discover the source code or algorithms of  the Software   except and only to the extent that such activity is expressly  permitted by applicable law not withstanding this limitation    or modify  or disable any features of  the Software  or create  derivative works based on the Software  You may not rent   lease  lend  sublicense or provide commercial hosting  services with the Software    4  CONSENT TO USE OF DATA  You agree that Samsung  Electronics Co  and its affiliates may collect and use  technical information gathered as part of the product sup
353. rn increases security on the  phone  When you enable the User visible pattern field  you  will draw an unlock pattern on the screen whenever you  want to unlock the phone s buttons or touch screen  When  you activate the User tactile feedback field  you feel vibration  as feedback while drawing the pattern    The feature is now paired with a backup PIN code that acts  as a backup to the pattern lock  If you forget your pattern   you can regain access to the device by entering a PIN code     Note  Make sure the Require Pattern field is activated     1     From the Home screen  press    1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Lock screen    Tap Screen lock Pattern    Read the instructions then tap Next    Draw your pattern by touching your first on screen  point  Then  without removing your finger from the  screen  drag your finger over adjacent points until the  gray trace line overlaps each point and they are  highlighted with a green circle     Changing Your Settings 301    5  When you have connected at least four dots in a  vertical  horizontal or diagonal direction  lift your finger  from the screen and tap Continue    6  Confirm the new pattern by redrawing it and then  tapping Confirm  The Unlock pattern is set    7  Enter the backup PIN code and tap Continue    8  Reenter the PIN to reconfirm the previous entry and  tap OK    Changing the Screen Lock Pattern  This feature allows you to change the previously stored  unlock pattern and update it if necessary  Th
354. rname password  to several  applications  such as Samsung Link     1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt   o  Samsung Link     2  If prompted  read the on screen message about  network charges and tap OK to continue and return to  the main screen    3  If prompted  tap Sign in to log into your Samsung  account     252    Note  If the main screen still shows a Sign in box  close the    application and restart it     4  Tap Start and follow the on screen prompts   For more information  refer to    Samsung Link  on page 205   Settings  This icon navigates to the sound and phone settings for your  phone  It includes such settings as  display  security   memory  and any extra settings associated with your phone   m From the Home screen  tap EHE  Apps   gt       Settings     or   From the Home screen press   and then tap  Settings     For more information  refer to    Changing Your Settings    on  page 280     Story Album    With Story Album  you can create a digital Album of your  story in media  Special moments will be on a timeline  and if    you wish  you can have your album published as a hard copy     1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    Story Album     Read the introductory information and tap Next   Tap Start to begin your Story Album    Follow the on screen instructions     Press  j and then tap Help for additional  information     IPN    T Mobile My Account    This application provides you online access to account  information such as your current activity  
355. rnb seb meth 335  VOICG COTILEOL user tts 336    Add Account                 00c0e cues 336    SIMPLE 338  Backup and Reset                       339  Backing up Your Data Before Factory Reset     339  Location Services                       344  SITE REESE ECRIRE kins 345  Application Manager                      348  Battery Usage          ssssssesssssss 351  SD Card  amp  Device Storage                 351  Date and Time    0 6  eee 352  About Device    2 2 0    cece eee eee 352  Software Update                   0055 353    Section 12  Health and Safety    Information                        ern 355    Exposure to Radio Frequency  RF  Signals       355  Specific Absorption Rate  SAR  Certification    Information             0 00 cece ee eee 360  FCC Part 15 Information to User            362  Commercial Mobile Alerting System  CMAS   362  Smart Practices While Driving              362  Battery Use and Safety                   364    Samsung Mobile Products and Recycling    365  6    UL Certified Travel Charger                367  Display   Touch Screen                   367  GPS amp AGPS                    sssus  368  Emergency Calls  as ssis nianna 369  Care and Maintenance                    370  Responsible Listening                    371  Operating Environment                   373  FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility  HAC   Regulations for Wireless Devices          375  Restricting Children s Access to Your  Mobile Device                  0004 376  FCC Notice and Cautions 
356. rs  The best example for this feature is  having multiple users instantly sharing each others pictures at a  company or family gathering  As each person takes a separate  picture with their own device  they are all pooled together and  instantly appear in each user s Gallery    No more  Email your pictures to me later   Each person walks out  of the event with all the pictures taken by everyone    This method of image transfer requires that both devices have  Wi Fi Direct active and be paired prior to use     Note  You can only share a shot with other external users who    also have their Wi Fi Direct feature active       S Beam Transfer uses the NFC  near Field Communication   feature found on your device to transmit large files directly to  another compatible device by direct touch    This method of image transfer requires NFC and S Beam to be  enabled prior to use    For more information  refer to  Using S Beam to Share  Pictures  on page 175     Enabling Share Shot    Share shot is a Wi Fi Direct group sharing feature where  multiple users can Wi Fi connect their devices and then all  share each others pictures in real time  This is really useful  in group events  ex  family gathering or company party   where you don t want to have to email everyone later and  make sure you all can share your pics at a later date   For more information  refer to  Wi Fi Direct Setup and  Settings  on page 286   The general process is      Enable Wi Fi Direct communication      Pair your de
357. rted and  notified of you have missed any calls or messages      Zoom  Once enabled  you must be on a screen where content can  be zoomed  In a single motion  touch and hold two points on the  display then tilt the device back and forth to zoom in or out       Browse an image  Once enabled  touch and hold a desired  on screen image to pan around it  Move the device left or right to  pan vertically or up and down to pan horizontally around the large  on screen image      Mute pause  Once enabled  mute incoming calls and any playing  sounds by turning the device display down on a surface  This is  the opposite of the Pickup to be Notified Gesture    To activate Palm Motion  u      1  From the Home screen  press    1  and then tap  Settings  gt  My device tab  gt  Motions and gestures    2  Ina single motion touch and slide the Palm motion  slider to the right to turn it on    3  Read the on screen notification and tap OK     Note  At least one feature must be activated before Palm  motion can be activated     4  Inasingle motion  slide a feature   s activation slider to    the on position   REN      The following is a description some of the most commonly  used gestures     Changing Your Settings 333      Capture screen  Once enabled  you can capture any  on screen information swiping across the screen  In a single  motion  press the side of your hand on the screen and swipe form  left to right  The image is then copied to the clipboard        Palm Swipe to  Screen Capture     
358. s  allows you to force the screen to  turn off during an active call     Call alerts  allows you to assign call alert tones and activate  call alerts and vibration       Call vibrations  vibrates the phone when the called party  answers  Choose from  Answer vibration or Call end vibration            Call status tones  assigns sounds settings during the call   Choose from  Call connect tone  Minute minder  and Call end  tone            Alerts on calls  selects whether alarm and message   Notification is turned off during a call     Call accessories  allows you to assign headset settings during   incoming calls        Automatic answering configures the device to automatically  answer and incoming call when a headset is detected        Automatic answering timer configures the time delay before  the device automatically accepts the incoming call     Changing Your Settings     311        Outgoing call conditions configures the connected Bluetooth  device to make outbound calls within one of two settings  Even  when device locked or Only when device unlocked      Wi Fi Calling  Allows you to both activate deactivate the Wi Fi   Calling feature and configure its settings  For more information    refer to  Wi Fi Calling  on page 84     Vote  If the Wi Fi Calling feature is active and connected  the    Call forwarding feature is greyed out and inaccessible       Additional settings  allows you to configure additional call  Settings  For more information  refer to  Configuring  Additio
359. s list     Set reject messages    1   2     From the Home screen  tap   N  Phone     Press  11  and then tap Call settings  gt  Set up call  rejection r messages    Tap    to manually add a reject message     or    Tap one of the pre written messages to be displayed  when you want the call to be rejected  You can edit the  message if desired     4     Tap Save to save the reject message     Answeringlending calls    1   2     From the Home screen  tap   Cl Phone     Press    and then tap Call settings  gt    Answering ending calls    Select any of the following options      The home key answers calls allows you to press   to  answer the phone      Voice control allows you to answer incoming voice calls using  voice      The power key ends calls allows you to press the power key  to end the current call     Changing Your Settings 313    Turn off screen during calls  This option turns on the proximity sensor during calls so that  your phone will know to turn the screen off to save power    1  From the Home screen  tap  Phone     2  Press 11  and then tap Call settings  gt  Turn off screen  during calls to create a check mark and enable the  feature    Call alerts I   1  From the Home screen  tap a3  Phone     2  Press   1  and then tap Call settings Call alerts    3  Tap Call vibrations to enable your phone to vibrate  when the called party answers the phone        Choose from  Answer vibration or Call end vibration    4  Tap Call status tones to set the sound settings during a
360. s of related  queries and popular websites in the address bar as you type      Preload available links before opening  allows you improve  performance when loading pages      Remember form data  Allows the device to store data from  any previously filled out forms  Remove the checkmark to  disable this function       Remember passwords  Stores usernames and passwords for  visited sites  Remove the checkmark to disable this function      Delete personal data  allows you to delete all personal data  such as Browsing history  Cache  Cookies and site data   Passwords  Auto fill data  and Location access    Accessibility      Text scaling  allows you to preview the text size  scale the text  Size using a slider bar  set the zoom amount on double tap  and  minimize the font size using a slider bar      Force zoom  allows you to override the website s request to  control zoom      Text encoding  adjusts the current text encoding      Fullscreen  allows you to use Fullscreen mode to hide the  Status bar      Text booster  allows you to boost the text size on PC websites  to make it easier to read    Content settings                Accept cookies  Allows sites  that require cookies  to save and  read cookies from your device     Enable location  Allows websites to request access to your  location   Connections 265      Enable JavaScript  Enables Javascript for the current Web  page  Without this feature  some pages may not display  properly  Remove the checkmark to disable this functi
361. s the button again     8  If the TV turned on  tap Yes   If the TV did not turn on after tapping      Power   and waiting 10 seconds  tap No or Retry     Multimedia 189    9  From the Choose Your TV Tuner screen  select the entry  that corresponds to your current channel control  method      Cable Satellite STB PVR DVR  selected when changing  channels is done via a receiver box  Channels are not changed  via the TV remote but rather through the receiver box      My xxx TV  selected when a signal is fed directly into the TV  and no box is used  Channels are changed directly on the TV by  using the TV remote and not a box s remote     Note  Try matching your current channel selection method     10  Select the Satellite Box Brand from the available list   For example  DirectTV     e  f your brand does not appear in the list  tap Other Satellite  Box Brands and follow the on screen instructions     Important  You must configure your set top box for IR  communication with your device  If you do not  select More Info   below and follow the on screen  instructions you may not be able to properly use  the application     190    11  When prompted to Enable IR  tap More Info   to learn  how to configure your set top box to receive and  respond to IR controls    12  Only after completing the IR setup process and  programming your box  press  S   Back      Note  This IR programming of your set top box is a one time    process and once successful should not need to be  repeated     13  I
362. screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   Ream  More tab   gt  Battery  The battery  level displays in percentage    2  From the upper right tap  Refresh  to update the  list     or   Tap an entry to view more detailed information     Note  Other applications may be running that affect battery    use     SD Card  amp  Device Storage  From this menu you can view the memory allocation for the  memory card as well as mount or unmount the SD card   For more information about mounting or unmounting the SD  card  see  Using the SD Card  on page 71   To view the memory allocation for your external SD card   m From the E Screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  ILE  More tab   gt  Storage   The available memory displays under the Total space  and SD card headings     Changing Your Settings 351    Date and Time  This menu allows you to change the current time and date  displayed  ESS  1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  Date and time   2  Tap Automatic date and time to allow the network set  the date and time     Important  Deactivate Automatic date and time to manually set    the rest of the options     3  Tap Set date and use the plus or minus icons to set the  Month  Day  and Year then tap Set    4  Tap Set time and use the plus or minus icons  set Hour   and Minute  Tap PM or AM  then tap Set    5  Tap Automatic time zone to allow the network set the  time zone information automatically    6  Tap Select time zone  then tap a time zo
363. select  either Cancel or Connect    4  If notified your Samsung account is not yet active or  verified  tap OK  You must be signed in to your  Samsung account to use the application s various  features     186    Tip  In some cases it might be necessary to sign in to your    Samsung account via the application   Press  rei and then select Sign in     Note  Your Samsung Hub account is managed by the Samsung    account application  This application manages your user  profile information     Using Samsung Hub  The main Samsung Hub screen provides an overview of all  the available categories on one page such as  Music  Video   Books  and Games  The overview page also displays recently  added media that you can rent or purchase   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt   Dg  Samsung Hub      The OVERVIEW screen  landing page  displays an main access  for all available categories and recently available content for    purchase or rental     Scroll across the screen to select from the following 4  Depending on the content  you can either purchase                 available pages  rent  or stream the content directly from the product    MUSIC  displays featured Music content available for purchase  detail page   stream from the Music store  amp  Radio  This page also allows you 5  Choose a payment method  then follow the on screen  to search for new content  or navigate directly to the Music instructions   store page by clicking on the  Music  link at the top of the Samsung Hub Notices
364. ser window displays     262    To exit from the incognito window    1  From your browser window  tap  Windows     2  Scroll across the available windows and locate the  incognito window  The incognito icon appears in  the upper left of the new browser window while you  are in this mode    3  Tap e next to the incognito listing to delete this  window     Using Bookmarks  While navigating a website  you can bookmark a site to  quickly and easily access it at a future time  The URLs   website addresses  of the bookmarked sites display in the  Bookmarks page  From the Bookmarks page you can also  view your Most visited websites and view your History   1  From the webpage  tap  Bookmarks    The Bookmarks page displays   2  Press 1 to display the following options   e List Thumbnail view  Select Thumbnail view  default  to view  a thumbnail of the webpage with the name listed  or select  List view to view a list of the bookmarks with Name and URL  listed       Create folder  Creates a new folder in which to store new  bookmarks      Delete  Erases selected bookmarks    e Change order  Rearranges the current bookmarks      Move to folder  Selected bookmarks are moved to a selected  folder      Tap a bookmark to view the webpage  or touch and   hold a bookmark for the following options      Open in new window  Opens the webpage in a new window      Edit bookmark  Allows you to edit the name or URL of the  bookmark  For more information  refer to  Editing  Bookmarks  on page 263      
365. settings     and may vary from your device  depending on the  software version on your device  and any changes to the  device s Settings     Unless stated otherwise  instructions in this User Manual  start with the device unlocked  at the Home screen     All screen images in this manual are simulated  Actual    displays may vary  depending on the software version of  your device and any changes to the device s Settings     Getting Started     7    Special Text   Throughout this manual  you ll find text that is set apart from   the rest  These are intended to point out important   information  share quick methods for activating features  to   define terms  and more  The definitions for these methods   are as follows      Notes  Presents alternative options for the current feature  menu   or sub menu      Tips  Provides quick or innovative methods  or useful shortcuts      Important  Points out important information about the current  feature that could affect performance      Warning  Brings to your attention important information to  prevent loss of data or functionality  or even prevent damage to  your phone     Text Conventions    This manual provides condensed information about how to  use your phone  To make this possible  the following text  conventions are used to represent often used steps      gt  Arrows are used to represent the sequence of  selecting successive options in longer  or  repetitive  procedures     Example  From the Home screen  press          Menu   gt 
366. slider to the right   to turn it on    Tap the following options to create a check mark and   conserve power      CPU power saving  allows you to limit the maximum  performance of the CPU      Screen power saving  allows you to lower the screen power  level     Changing Your Settings 321    e Tum off haptic feedback  allows you to turn off vibration when  you tap or touch the screen   4  Tap Learn about Power saving mode to learn about  various ways to conserve battery power   When the power gets low  confirm E appears at the top of  the screen  This indicates the power saving mode is active   Accessory  This menu allows you to select the Audio output mode when  using a car or desk dock   1  From the jd screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  Wu  My device tab  Accessory   2  Tap Dock sound to play sounds when inserting or  removing the phone from the dock   3  Tap Audio output mode to use the external dock  speakers when the phone is docked   4  Tap Desk home screen display if you wish to show the  desk home screen when the device is docked   5  Tap Automatic unlock if you are using a phone cover  and you want your phone to unlock when you open the  COVer     322    6  Tap Audio output to set your Audio output to Stereo or  Surround   Accessibility Settings   This service lets you enable and disable downloaded  accessibility applications that aid in navigating your Android  device  such as TalkBack  uses synthesized speech to  describe the results of actions   KickBack  
367. st     87    Adjusting Noise Reduction  During a call it may be necessary to adjust the noise  reduction feature  Activating this feature can improve the  quality of your conversation by reducing ambient noise   1  Tap W   Noise reduction off  to toggle the status  and activate the feature   2  Tap Bd  Noise reduction on  to toggle the status  and deactivate the feature   Personalizing the Call Sound Setting  During a call it may be necessary to adjust the sound of the  incoming call by selecting an audio equalizer setting for the  current call   1  Tap e  Personalize call sound      2  Confirm the option is enabled Qe     Note  If prompted to enable the feature via the Call settings    menu  go to Call settings  gt  Personalize call sound   3  Select an available option     Choose from  Adapt Sound  Soft sound  Clear sound   and Off     88    Placing a Call on Hold  You can place the current call on hold whenever you want  If  your network supports this service  you can also make  another call while a call is in progress   To place a call on hold   1  Tap Hold to place the current call on hold   2  Tap Unhold to activate the call that is on hold     To make a new call while a call is in progress   1  Enter the new phone number that you wish to dial or  look it up in Call history   2  Once connected  tap Add call to dial the second call     3  Dial the new phone number and tap ES  To switch between the two calls   m Tap Swap   The previous In call number turns gray and displa
368. t battery charge level  Icon  shown is fully charged     Displays when the current battery is 100 percent  charged andthe Display battery percentage option  is enabled within the Settings  gt  My device tab  gt   Display menu     Displays your battery is currently charging     Understanding Your Device 33    EE EB EE    oo  R    Displays your current battery charge level is  low  Charge   28    15       Displays your current battery charge level is  very low  Charge   15    5       Shows your current battery only has up to 4   power remaining and will soon shutdown    Charge   4    1       Displays when connected to the EDGE network     Displays when your phone is communicating with  the EDGE network     Displays when connected to the 3G network  3G  indicator is only seen when roaming     Displays when your phone is communicating with  the 3G network  3G indicator is only seen when  roaming     Displays when connected to the HSPA  network     Displays when your phone is communicating with  the HSPA  network     5  mO    E E  EJ EH EL EJ F3 3 S    Displays when your phone is communicating  with the 4G LTE network     Displays when the phone has detected an active  USB connection and is in a USB Debugging mode     Displays when there is a new text message     Displays when an outgoing text message has  failed to be delivered     Displays when an incoming text message  content has failed to be downloaded     Displays when there is a new voicemail message     Displays when there
369. t location  This application allows you  to launch a file if the associated application is already on  your phone  ex  MP4      m From the Home screen  tap Eu  Apps   gt     i  My Files     Note  Navigation in this viewer works on a hierarchy structure    with folders  subfolders  etc     Note  The application lets you view supported image files and    text files on both your internal storage and microSD  card     236    Opening and Navigating within Files  DCIM is the default location for pictures or video taken by the  device  These files are actually stored in the DCIM folder  location   To open files   1  From the Home screen  tap ER  Apps   gt   E58  My Files    2  Tapa folder and scroll down or up until you locate your  selected file     Home tab A allows you to back up to the root directory     e Uptab allows you to back up into a higher directory      Press      and then tap View by to change the way the files  are displayed on screen  Choose from  List  List and details   or Thumbnail    e Press    for these additional options  Select all    Create folder  Search  View by  Sort by  and Settings        To navigate     1     Tap All files  gt  Device storage SD memory card to see   the contents of either device or your internal SD card    The following folders may display      ShareShot  displays the files shared via a group share shot  Session      Alarms  this folder contains any alarm files you may have      Android  the Android folder stores files that are used in 
370. t to a previously accessed or  Displays when Wi Fi Direct is active and secured wireless network  The WAP key is required  communicating when the device is reset using factory default settings     Displays when Wi Fi is being used as a Mobile  HotSpot feature is active and communicating         2     274    Deactivating Wi Fi Wi Fi Advanced Settings    1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap The Wi Fi settings   Advanced menu allows you to set up  Settings Connections tab  many of the device s Wi Fi services  including   2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Wi Fi slider to the   Setting the Wi Fi sleep policy  left to turn it off    Viewing the device s MAC Address   0r    Configuring use of either a DHCP or Static IP  Activate and Deactivate Wi Fi from the Notification bar  To access the Wi Fi Advanced Settings menu                               1  From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Note  Use of wireless data connections such as Wi Fi and Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi     Bluetooth can reduce battery life and use times   2  Press I and then tap Advanced     Manually Scan for a Wi Fi Network  1  From the Home screen  press 11  and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi   2  Inasingle motion touch and slide the Wi Fi slider to the  right to turn it on   3  Tap Scan     Connections 275    USB Tethering    This option allows you to share your device s mobile data  connection via a direct USB connection between your device  and a single 
371. tach       Tap     to delete the attached file     If you attach an image to your email  you have the option  to resize it prior to delivery  Choose from  Original     Large  70    Medium  30    or Small  10    Once    chosen  tap either Always or Just once     Tap B  Save  to store a draft of the current email  on your device so that you can come back later and  continue the email    Tap  Delete  to discard the current email   Once complete  tap  Send      Messages 147    Configuring Email Settings    1     2   3   4    148    From the Home screen  tap   Select an account    Press ml and then tap Settings  gt   lt Account gt     Alter any of the following settings      Email notifications  Activates the email notification icon to  appear within the Notifications area of the status bar when a  new email  Gmail  etc   is received      Select ringtone  Plays a selected ringtone when a new email  message is received      Vibrate  Activates a vibration when a new email message is  received      Sync Email  enables automatic email synching between your  device and the remote server      Sync schedule  allows you to control the email sync schedule  on both Peak and Off Peak times      Size to retrieve emails  configures the incoming email size  allowed to pass through to your phone automatically without  user interaction  Emails with attachments larger than  configured will have to be retrieved manually     EE  gt      Email                   Signature  Lets you attach a customized
372. take a video  use the Volume control  buttons to zoom in or out  You can magnify the video up  to x4  400 percent      Note  Use either the Up and Down volume keys or spread     pinch the screen to zoom in or out  For more  information  refer to    Navigating Through the Screens     on page 53       Tap the Video key     to begin shooting video  The  red light will blink while recording      Tap anywhere on the screen to re focus the camera on  that object  The camcorder auto focuses on the new  target area      To capture an image from the video while recording   tap     This feature is not available while the  anti shake feature is activated       Tapthe Stop key   x  to stop the recording and save    the video file to your Camera folder    or   Tap the Pause key     to pause the recording   Once the file has been saved  tap the image viewer        Play  to playback your video for review   Press to return to the viewer        Multimedia 171    Accessing Videos  When you shoot a video  the file is saved in the Camera  folder  You can view your videos immediately or view them  anytime in the Camera folder   1  From the Home screen  tap EH  Apps   gt   ES  Gallery    2  Select a folder location and tap a video icon to begin  video playback   3  Tap   gt    Play  to begin video playback    o   Touch and hold the video icon from the main Gallery to  select the video  indicated by a colored border  and  display the following video menu context options     Share via E allows you t
373. talled Google  Application  1  From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps    2  Tapthe newly installed application  This application is  typically located on the last Applications page   Unknown sources    This feature can be used for Android application  development  The feature allows developers to install  non Play Store applications    m From the Home screen  press m and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Security Unknown sources   Unknown sources displays a check mark to indicate it  is active     Note  If Unknown sources is disabled  those applications    without a certificate will not be allowed to download to  your device     244    Manage applications  This feature allows you to manage and remove installed  applications  You can also view the amount of memory or  resources used as well as the remaining memory and  resources for each of the applications on your device and  clear the data  cache  or defaults   m From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Application manager   Clearing application cache and data  1  From the Home screen  press   and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Application manager   2  Tap an application in which to clear the cache or data   3  Tap Force stop  Uninstall  Clear data  Clear cache  or  Clear defaults   Uninstalling third party applications  You can uninstall any application you downloaded and  installed from the Play Store     1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  A
374. tap     Register storage   gt  Sign in to your desired service   Choose from  SugarSync  Dropbox  or SkyDrive   epe  Press    and then tap Settings  gt  Registered storage   gt     Register storage      3  Follow the on screen instructions to register or log into  your Cloud service     4  Once the process is successfully completed  the Web  storage icon or name appears in the Web storage area  of the main screen    5  From the main screen  select a connected device and  then tap on the media that you would like to share    e Afile with IN  in the upper left indicates it is stored remotely  on a Web storage location  Selecting this media causes your  device to access the file currently stored on your services     Servers     To de register Web storage service   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt       Samsung Link   gt  DEVICES  amp  STORAGE   Press     t and then tap Settings  gt  Registered storage   Deregister     2  Select a current storage service and tap OK     Multimedia 207    Sharing files via Web Storage  Files can be uploaded to a Web storage location by either  login into the service and sharing a folder on your computer  with the storage location or sharing files  images  and videos  from your device   To upload an image on your device to Web storage     1     Note  To select multiple images  touch and hold an image to    From the Home screen  tap ES  Apps   gt     X  Gallery      Select a folder location  ex  Camera  and open an  image by tapping it once  T
375. tap  0K    Adding Your First Chat On Buddy   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      craton    2  Tap  amp   Add buddy  and choose a search method      Phone number B   to search by Country code and phone  number      Search by ID Q   to search by using a known samsung  account ID    3  Select a country code if it differs from yours    4  Enter the information and tap Q  Search   Once the  recipient is matched  their entry appears in the Results  area    5  Tap    Add  and confirm your new buddy appears  in the Buddies tab     Note  For more information  press    Settings  and tap  General  gt  Help     Using ChatON for Chatting   1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt      Craton     2  Tap the Buddies tab and select a buddy to initiate your  chat    3  Enter your message using the on screen text entry  method    4  Tap Send    To reply to a ChatON message    1  While the chat session is active  tap the Enter message  field and then type your reply message    2  Compose your reply   Your texts are colored Blue and your buddy   s messages  are white    3  Tap Send to deliver your reply     Messages 159    Deleting a single message bubble    1     From the Home screen  tap       Chaton      ERR  Apps   gt     2  Launch a chat session to reveal the message string   3  Touch and hold a message bubble  then select Delete   Google     Google  makes messaging and sharing with your friends a  lot easier  You can set up Circles of friends  visit the Stream  to get updates from 
376. te  The Presidential alert can not be disabled       Emergency notification preview  allows you to play a sample  emergency alert tone  Tap Stop to cancel the playback   Signature settings    Add signature  when enabled  this feature allows you to create  a signature at the end of your outgoing text messages     Signature text  allows you to enter a desired signature for your  message   Spam message settings    Spam settings  when enabled  allows you to configure  available spam settings such as       Add to spam numbers  allows you to manually enter and  assign a phone number as being sent from a spam source       Add to spam phrases  allows you to assign a specific text  phrase as belonging to a spam message  Ex  Dear friend         Block unknown senders  when active  automatically blocks  incoming messages from unknown sources or blocked  numbers     Emergency Alert Configuration    This device is designed to receive wireless emergency alerts  from the Commercial Mobile Alerting System  CMAS   which  may also be known as the Personal Localized Alerting  Network  PLAN   If your wireless provider has chosen to  participate in CMAS PLAN  alerts are available while in the  provider s coverage area  If you travel outside your provider s  coverage area  wireless emergency alerts may not be  available  For more information  please contact your wireless  provider    Emergency Alerts allows customers to receive  geographically targeted messages  Alert messages are  provided by the 
377. te a feature  for  example  you press the Lock key to lock and unlock the device      Tap  Use a brief touch to select items on the display or to enter  text on the virtual QWERTY keyboard  For example  touch an  Application icon to open the application  A light touch works best      Touch and hold  Touch and hold an icon or key to open the  available options  or to access a pop up menu  For example   touch and hold from the Home screen to access a menu of  customization options     Understanding Your Device     53      Flick  Move your finger in lighter  quicker strokes than swiping   This finger gesture is always used in a vertical motion  such as  when flicking through contacts or a message list      Swipe or slide  Quickly drag your finger vertically or horizontally  across the screen  This allows you to move the area of focus or to  scroll through a list  For example  slide your finger left or right on  the Home screen to scroll among the seven panels      Drag  Press and hold your finger with some pressure before you  start to move it  Do not release your finger until you have reached  the target position      Rotate  Automatically change the screen orientation from portrait  to landscape by turning the device sideways  For example  rotate  to landscape orientation when entering text  to provide a larger  keyboard  or when viewing web content to minimize scrolling      Pinch   Pinch  the screen using your  thumb and forefinger to zoom out when  viewing a picture or a We
378. te the Spam settings option   4  Tap Block unknown senders  A green check mark  indicates the feature is active     Block unknown senders  when active  automatically blocks  incoming messages from unknown sources or blocked  numbers     Messages 143    If an incoming message is designated in coming from an  unknown sender  it is automatically assigned as spam and is  now located in your Spam folder   Accessing Your Spam Folder  Any message assigned as spam is automatically placed with  your Spam messages folder   1  From the Home screen  tap M   i  2  Press I and then tap Spam messages   Text Templates  This screen displays your available text message reply  templates  This is a readily accessible list of both default and  user defined text snippets that can be used to quickly reply  to incoming messages   1  From the Home screen  tap wu     2  From the Messaging list  press Ir and then tap  Text templates  m  3  Tapa message to immediately insert it into your  current message conversation     144    To create your own text template   1  From the Home screen  tap ww   2  From the Messaging list  press   r  and then tap  Text templates  E    3  Tap  Create text template    4  Entera new text string and tap Save   Using Email   Email  or Internet Email  enables you to review and create  email using several email services  You can also receive text  message alerts when you receive an important email  Your  phone s Email application lets you access and manage  multiple email acco
379. ted  automatically to your voicemail  Choose from      Off  disables the auto rejection feature      All numbers  enables the features for all known and unknown  numbers  including those contacts that are not assigned to the  rejection list      Auto reject numbers  automatically rejects all entries assigned  to the Reject list Blacklist     Adding numbers to the rejection list  Entries can be added to the list via either the Contacts menu  or via the Auto reject list menu  The Contacts menu option  assigns all numbers for an individual as rejected  The Auto  reject list allows to assign individual numbers   To assign multiple numbers as rejected via Contacts   1  From the Home screen  tap  Contacts    2  Locate an entry and tap it to open the Contact  Overview Screen  page 117    3  Press ra and then tap Add to reject list  All phone  numbers associated with this entry are then added to  the reject list     80    To assign single number as rejected   via Auto reject list     1   2     4     From the Home screen  tap  3    Press ml and then tap Call settings  gt  Call rejection   gt  Auto reject list    Tap    Create  and either enter the phone number  or select a Contact from your Logs or Contacts list   Tap Save to complete the assignment     International Calls    1     From the Home screen  tap and then touch and  hold   O   until the device shows         on screen   Use the on screen keypad to enter the country code     area code  and phone number                    If y
380. tering a passcode     To pair your device with another Bluetooth device    1  Verify Bluetooth is active    2  From the Bluetooth settings page  tap the Visibility field   shown by the device name    Your device must be visible to successfully pair with an  external device  This is shown by a green check mark    3  Tap Scan  Your device displays a list of discovered in   range Bluetooth devices    4  Tap a device from the list to initiate pairing    5  Enter the passkey or PIN code  if needed  and tap OK     6  The external device must accept the connection and  enter your device s PIN code   Once successfully paired to an external device   displays in the Status area     Note  Due to different specifications and features of other  Bluetooth compatible devices  display and operations  may be different  and functions such as transfer or  exchange may not be possible with all Bluetooth   compatible devices     Important  If callers can not hear you during a call while using    a paired Bluetooth headset  with built in  microphone   verify the Call audio option is enabled  within the entry s Bluetooth Settings page     Connections 269    Configuring Bluetooth Device Settings    Some connected Bluetooth devices are capable of more than  just functioning as a headphone  but also have built in  microphones for picking up voice  Although both functions  are detected by the device and activated  there might be  times when you need to change or update these settings for  Phone and Med
381. ternet  To perform an Internet search using keywords    1  From within the Google search application  tap the  Google search field  enter the keyword s  to search  using the on screen keypad    2  Tap the entry from the list of search results that are  displayed    3  Tapalink to view the website     Adding and Deleting Windows  You can have up to eight Internet windows open at one time   To add a new window   1  From your browser window  tap  Windows   gt   E  1   New window    2  Anew browser window displays     Note  The number of currently open windows is displayed at  the bottom of the Windows screen     3  Scroll across the screen to view the currently active  windows and tap an entry to launch the selected  Internet window    To delete an existing window    1  From your browser window  tap  Windows     2  Scroll across the available windows and locate your  target window    3  Tap ie next to the listing to delete the window     Connections 261    Going Incognito  The incognito feature allows you to view Internet sites  outside of the normal browsing  Pages viewed in this  incognito window won t appear within your browser history  or search history  and no traces  such as cookies  are left on  your device     Note  Any downloaded files will be preserved and will stay on    your device after you exit the incognito mode     To add a new incognito window   1  From your browser window  press t   and select  Incognito mode   2  Atthe information prompt  tap OK   3  Anew brow
382. th settings page  tap o  Settings    gt  Unpair to delete the paired device     Sending Contacts via Bluetooth    Depending on your paired devices  settings and capabilities   you may be able to send pictures  Contact information  or  other items using a Bluetooth connection     Note  Prior to using this feature  Bluetooth must first be  enabled on both your phone and the external device  and  the recipient s device must be visible     1  Verify your Bluetooth is active and your phone is  visible    2  From the Home screen  tap E  B  Contacts     3  Touch and hold the entry from the list to display the  on screen context menu    4  Tap Share namecard via  gt  Bluetooth and select a  paired external Bluetooth device     Note  The external Bluetooth device must be visible and  communicating for the pairing to be successful     5  ABluetooth share notification displays in your  notifications list     Enable Downloading for Web  Applications    Important  Before you can download a web application you  must insert an SD into the phone and enable the  Unknown sources feature  enables downloading    For more information  refer to  Installing the  microSD Memory Card  on page 11  Also  see   Mounting the SD Card  on page 72    1  From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings  gt   More tab   gt  Security  gt  Unknown  sources check box    2  Tap OK to allow install of non Play Store applications   Tap again to remove the check mark and disable the  installation of non Play St
383. the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt   Tethering and Mobile HotSpot     For more information  refer to    USB Tethering    on page 276     For more information  refer to    Mobile HotSpot    on page  277     294    VPN settings    The VPN settings menu allows you to set up and manage  Virtual Private Networks  VPNs      Note  Before using VPN  you must first set up a screen unlock  PIN or password  For more information  refer to     Security    on page 345     Adding a VPN    Before you add a VPN you must determine which VPN  protocol to use  PPTP  L2TP IPSec PSK  L2TP IPSec RSA   IPSec Xauth PSK  IPSec Xauth RSA  IPSec Hybrid RSA     Important  Before you can use a VPN you must establish and  configure one     1  From the Home screen  press      and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt  VPN    2  If prompted  read the screen lock information and  follow the on screen steps to setup an unlock PIN or  password     3  Tap E  add VPN network      4  Inthe form that appears  fill in the information provided  by your network administrator   5  Tap Save     Note  Similar setup process can be used for all available VPN    types     Connecting to a VPN m  1  From the Home screen  press 11  and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  More networks  gt  VPN   2  Tap the VPN entry you want to connect to   3  Enter any requested credentials into the pop up that  opens   4  Tap Connect   Edit a VPN  1  
384. the Samsung  keyboard is to use the on screen keys you have other  options     Note  To access settings  touch and hold the Input Methods    button   then tap Fey  Settings  then select it from  the available options     1  From within an active message  tap the text input field  to reveal the on screen keyboard    2  Tap  Input Methods  to use the default Voice  typing input method to convert your spoken words to  on screen text     or  E  Touch and hold to select from other input  methods such as       Handwriting to launch an on screen handwriting area that can  be used to convert on screen patterns  text  to text    e Clipboard to launch the device s clipboard area from where  you can select a current clipboard item to place in your current  message     104      Optical Reader to the camera and have the built in Optical  Reader application recognize text      Settings to access the Samsung keyboard settings menu      Keyboard alignment to detach the on screen keyboard so that  you can manually dock it anywhere on the current text entry  screen  Selecting the feature again redocks the keyboard into  its original location using the original size    Changing the Text Input Mode in Keyboard  1  Froma screen where you can enter text  tap the text  input field to reveal the on screen keyboard   2  With Samsung keyboard as your text entry method   select one of the following text mode options      Abc   to use alphabetic characters from the on screen  keyboard  In this mode  the
385. the call       Touch and drag the Reject call with message tab upward  and tap a predefined rejection message or tap Create new  message to create a new custom outgoing response     Pressing the Volume down button mutes the ringer        If the incoming call is from a number stored in your Contacts   the entry s name is displayed  You may also see the caller s  phone number  if available     Touch and drag  upward to reject  with a message    Touch and   slide in any   direction to  answer the Touch and slide  call in any direction    to reject the call       Create new message      Answering a call with Air Gesture    1  Verify the Air Gestures feature is on and Air call accept  is active  For more information  refer to    Using Motions  and Gestures    on page 55   2  Atthe incoming call screen  wave your hand over the  screen to accept the incoming call   e  f active  the Air call accept icon   W appears at the top of  the incoming call screen   Managing Reject Calls  This feature allows you to categorize both known and  unknown callers as rejected contacts  These Contacts are  then added to you Rejection list which can be managed for  individual entries from within the Contacts list or as a whole  from the Call rejection screen       1  From the Home screen  tap Kg   2  Press     and then tap Call settings  gt  Call rejection     Call Functions and Contacts List 79    3  Tap the Auto reject mode field to configure your  automatic rejection settings  Rejected calls are rou
386. the map     Make available offline  allows you to store map related  information locally on your device and access it even when  device is offline        the      Settings  allows you to select the following additional options       Display  allows you to enable disable the Zoom Buttons  Scale    Bar  and Bubble action         Offline and cache  allows you to set options to pre fetch map    tiles when not using Wi Fi and to clear the cache that holds    the    map tiles  Choose from  Automatic caching  Clear all map titles     or Clear My Places cache            Location settings  lets you access and configure the location    settings            Sign in  allows you to sign into your current Google account     234        Labs  this is a testing ground for experimental features that  aren t ready for primetime  They may change  break or  disappear at any time  Click on a Lab to enable or disable it        What s New  provides access to the Play Store from where you    can update the application manually         About  displays general information about Google maps such          as Version  Platform  Locale  Total  Free memory  etc       Feedback  allows you to provide    data sent  Total data received     application feedback         Terms  Privacy  amp  Notices  displays the Terms and Conditions        Privacy Policy  or Legal Notices in       information from the pop up menu       Help  provides help information      ormation  Select the desired    Messaging  This application
387. thin your Play Store   application    The Music application contains a music player that plays   music and other audio files that you copy from your computer    1  From the Home screen  tap  Apps   gt    Qv  Play Music    The Music app searches both your online library and  your device s internal storage for music and playlists   this can take from a few seconds to several minutes   depending on the amount of new music added since  you last opened the application  It then displays a  carousel view of your new and recent music  organized  by album     Multimedia 193    If prompted  follow the on screen instructions to link  your current account to Google Play Music       Tapan on screen account to add it or select Add    account to use a new account       Atthe free songs screen  select either Get free songs or    Skip      Get free songs are downloaded via either the Internet or Play  Store      Follow the on screen download and installation instructions    Swipe left or right to browse through your new and   available music  Music  albums  and artists are   grouped into categories       Tap an on screen album to open it and begin playback     Return to the Library screen from most other screens  in the Music application by tapping the Music  application icon  Music notification icon  at the  top left of the Application bar     Changing Library View  You can change the way you view the contents of your  library    1  From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt   Qr  Play Music    
388. tilt angle  Tap the adjacent  field to the right of the Smart scroll field to activate the feature   With Smart scroll  the screen will scroll depending on the  phone s tilt angle once your eyes have been detected    Air view       With the Air view feature  you can hover your finger over the  screen and Air view features will be displayed  For example   you can hover your finger over a scheduled item in your  calendar to see more details  Hp  1  From the Home screen  press I and then tap  Settings My device tab Air view     2  Tap the ON OFF icon at the top of your screen to    activate Air view  Sg     3  The following options are available  Tap an option to  create a checkmark and activate the feature     Information preview  allows you to see information previews   extended text  and enlarged images when you hover your  finger over the screen     Note  It is recommended that the Information preview function    be enabled if using Air view       Progress preview  allows you to preview a scene or show  elapsed time when you hover your finger over the progress bar  while watching a video      Speed dial preview  allows you to see the contacts and their  Speed dial numbers when you hover your finger over them in  your contacts list      Webpage magnifier  allows you to see magnified links on  webpages when you hover your finger over them      Sound and haptic feedback  allows you to play sound and  feel vibration when you hover your finger over Air view items     Changing You
389. to       Drama  Use this to take a series of photos of a moving object Focus area  displays the area of the image used as the  and then merge them together into one image  main focus area  If the image is too close  the square      Animated photo  Use this to create a picture in which a few will turn red   ind static objects move by animating objects detected by E Self portrait  allows you to set the front camera so  the device  you can take pictures of yourself         Rich tone  HDR   Use this to take photos with richer colors and    contrasts by merging images taken at different exposure levels  FrontCamera  allows you toactivate both the frontand    x       Eraser  Saves the best of 5 taken pictures and removes any  Q rear cameras     passers by  Quick Settings  activates the Quick Settings menu      Panorama  Use this to take wide panoramic photos  Press the x   bar from where you can select several additional   Shutter button to take a photo  and then move the camera in settings For more information  refer to    Quick   any direction  When the blue frame aligns with the preview Settings    on page 166              screen  the camera automatically takes another shot in the   panoramic sequence  To stop shooting  press the Shutter button viewer and the various viewing options for a   again  selected picture  The last picture you took  will be      Sports  Use this to take fast action photos  displayed as a thumbnail in the Image viewer icon       Night  Use this to take b
390. to create a backup of your current  phone settings and applications    3  Tap Backup account to assign the account being  backed up    4  Tap Automatic restore to assist in the re installation of  a previously installed application  including  preferences and data      5  Tap Factory data reset to reset your device and sound  settings to the factory default settings  For more  information  refer to    Factory Data Reset    on page  343    6  Tap Collect diagnostics to collects diagnostic data for  troubleshooting use  For more information  refer to     Collect Diagnostics    on page 343     Backing up Your Data Before Factory  Reset  Backing Up Your Contacts using an SD card    Before initiating a factory reset  it is recommended that you  backup your personal data prior to use     Important  If you choose to back up contacts to your SIM card   all information other than name and number is lost   Therefore  it is recommended that you back up  contacts to your SD card     Changing Your Settings 339    To export a Contact list to your microSD card   1  From the Home screen  tap  Contacts    2  Press  E and then tap Import Export   3  Tap Export to SD card  gt  OK  The contacts will be stored  in a  vcf file on your SD card   For more information  refer to  Export Import  on page  126   To copy contacts from an SD card back to your device   1  From the Home screen  tap  Contacts    2  Press       and then tap Import Export  gt  Import from  USB storage   3  At the Save contact t
391. to delete  A check  mark displays beside each selected message   4  Tap Delete   5  Atthe prompt  tap OK to delete or Cancel to end the  process     138    Deleting a single message bubble  1  From the Home screen  tap es   2  Open a message to reveal the message string   3  Touch and hold a message bubble  then select Delete  message   4  At the prompt  tap OK to delete or Cancel to exit   Deleting multiple message bubbles  1  From the Home screen  tap    2  Open a message to reveal the message string   3  Press ml and then tap Delete messages   4  Place a check mark on the individual bubbles targeted  for deletion or choose Select all   5  Tap Delete to erase or Cancel to exit     Message Search  You can search through your messages by using the  Message Search feature   1  From the Home screen  tap P   2  Press l   and then tap Search   3  Use the on screen keypad to enter a word or phrase in  which to search  then tap Q     4  All messages that contain the entered search string  display   Messaging Settings  To configure the settings for text messages  multimedia  messages  Voice mails  and Push messages   1  From the Home screen  tap 9   2  Press m and then tap Settings   The following Messaging settings are available     General settings    Delete old messages  deletes old messages when the limit is    reached  rather than overwriting them     Text message limit  allows you to set a limit on how many text  messages are allowed in one conversation       Multimedia messag
392. to never  store search history information        SafeSearch filtering allows you to configure block settings for  videos containing restricted content  This option blocks these  videos from appearing within your search results  Choose from   Don t filter  Moderate  or Strict      Preloading       Preload subscriptions allows you to preload  or go get videos  while on Wi Fi and charging  your subscription videos        258        Preload watch later allows you to enable the preload function  on selected videos so you can watch them later  Read the data  usage information and tap OK to accept the terms     Note  Preloading YouTube videos will use some of your  device s storage space and may result in additional  charges if your Wi Fi plan is not unlimited       About      Help provides answers to most YouTube questions       Feedback allows you to provide user feedback to YouTube       Google Mobile Terms of Service      YouTube Terms of Service      Google Mobile Privacy Policy      YouTube Privacy Policy      Open source licenses      App version displays the software version for the current   YouTube application   To watch a high quality video   m Press   I   and then tap Settings  gt  General  gt  High  quality on mobile     Section 10  Connections    Your phone is equipped with features that allow you to  quickly connect to the Web     Internet  Your device is equipped with a Google browser to navigate  the mobile Web  This section explains how to navigate the  browser an
393. tom message field  enter a message then tap   gt   Send    From the Messenger screen  tap Learn more for more  detailed information     Messages    161    Section 8  Multimedia    This section explains how to use the multimedia features of  your device  including the Camera Camcorder  Music Player   Samsung Link  and how to manage your photos  images and  sounds     You can take photographs and shoot video by using the  built in camera functionality  Your camera produces photos in  JPEG format     Important  Do not take photos of people without their  permission   Do not take photos in places where cameras are  not allowed   Do not take photos in places where you may  interfere with another person s privacy     Note  An SD card is no longer needed to take pictures or shoot    video since there is already built in storage     162    Assigning the Default Storage  Location    Important  Too many users can overlook this storage location  until something goes wrong  It is recommended  that you verify this location or change it before  initiating the use of the camera or camcorder  features     1  From the Home screen  tap EE   Apps   gt  ie    Camera   i   2  Press   and then tap Settings  gt   and scroll down to the Storage entry    3  Tap this entry and select the desired default storage  location for newly taken pictures or videos  Choose  from  Device or Memory card      Settings     Note  It is recommended that you set the option to Memory    card     4  Press C  to return t
394. tromagnetic energy  such as is found  in X rays and gamma rays  can ionize biological tissues   lonization is a process where electrons are stripped away  from their normal locations in atoms and molecules  It can  permanently damage biological tissues including DNA  the  genetic material    The energy levels associated with radio frequency energy   including both radio waves and microwaves  are not great  enough to cause ionization of atoms and molecules   Therefore  RF energy is a type of non ionizing radiation   Other types of non ionizing radiation include visible light   infrared radiation  heat   and other forms of electromagnetic  radiation with relatively low frequencies     While RF energy does not ionize particles  large amounts can  increase body temperatures and cause tissue damage  Two  areas of the body  the eyes and the testes  are particularly  vulnerable to RF heating because there is relatively little  blood flow in them to carry away excess heat     356    Research Results to Date  Is there a connection  between RF and certain health problems   The results of most studies conducted to date say no  In  addition  attempts to replicate and confirm the few studies  that have shown a connection have failed   The scientific community at large therefore believes that the  weight of scientific evidence does not show an association  between exposure to Radio Frequency  RF  from cell phones  and adverse health outcomes  Still the scientific community  has supported a
395. ts  each  account creates a separate contact entry in the Contacts list   If one of your contacts  Amy Smith  has a regular email  account that you maintain in Gmail  but also has a Facebook  account under her maiden and married name  as well as a  Video  chat account  when you merge those accounts into  your Contacts list you can join all of her entries and view the  information in one record     Joining contact information makes sending messages easy   You can select any account email address or information all  from one screen  versus searching multiple  individual  screens to locate the desired account information     Next time you synchronize your device with your accounts   any updates contacts make to email account names  email  addresses  etc  automatically update in your contacts list     Contacts 117    1  From the Home screen  tap nm    2  Tapa contact name  the name you want to link to  another entry  to reveal the Contact entry s Overview  Screen     Important  It is the first contact image that is displayed for  both  and the first contact s name that is used   For example  If Amy  original entry  is joined with  Julie  second entry   Julie seems to disappear and  only Amy remains  Tap the Amy entry  showing the    Note  Typically this is the same contact with a different name Amy image  to view both     or account information     5  Tapthe main linked contact to view the contact  information you linked  The contacts and information  displays with an icon next t
396. tures of this phone  thoroughly and in different locations  using your hearing aid  or cochlear implant  to determine if you hear any interfering  noise  Consult your service provider or the manufacturer of  this phone for information on hearing aid compatibility  If you  have questions about return or exchange policies  consult  your service provider or phone retailer     Restricting Children s Access to Your  Mobile Device   Your mobile device is not a toy  Do not allow children to play  with it because they could hurt themselves and others     damage the mobile device  or make calls that increase your  mobile device bill     Keep the mobile device and all its parts and accessories out  of the reach of small children     FCC Notice and Cautions  FCC Notice    The mobile device may cause TV or radio interference if used  in close proximity to receiving equipment  The FCC can  require you to stop using the mobile device if such  interference cannot be eliminated  Vehicles using liquefied  petroleum gas  such as propane or butane  must comply with  the National Fire Protection Standard  NFPA 58   For a copy  of this standard  contact the National Fire Protection  Association    Cautions    Any changes or modifications to your mobile device not  expressly approved in this document could void your  warranty for this equipment and void your authority to  operate this equipment  Only use approved batteries   antennas  and chargers  The use of any unauthorized  accessories may be d
397. type    Tap Save to store and update the entry     Deleting Contacts    1   2     Important  Once Contacts list entries are deleted  they cannot    be recovered     From the Home screen  tap EB i  Touch and hold a contact name from the list and select  Delete  gt  OK     Contact List Options  From the Home screen  tap B  Press     The following options display     1   2       Delete  allows you to delete 1 or more of your contacts       Import Export  imports or exports contacts to or from the USB  storage location  SIM card or SD card  you can also send  namecards via methods such as Bluetooth  ChatON  Email     Gmail  Messaging  or      Merge accounts  allows you to merge all of your curren    Contact entries with ei    account  If several of your contacts are from other external  sources  this allows you to    back them up    or copy them to    Wi Fi Direct        ither your active Google or Samsung       your Samsung account  Tap OK to continue or Cancel to exit       Accounts  allows you    Samsung account  ChatON  Google  LDAP  or Microsoft    Exchange ActiveSync   synchronize all of you  accounts  For more in  Contacts    on page    to add and manage mobile accounts on    This option also allows you to manually  current contacts with their respective  formation  refer to    Synchronizing  122           e Speed dial setting  al    lows you to set up speed dialing       Send message email  al    lows you to send a text  picture    message or an email using your Google ac
398. uch as Wi Fi Calling  can be  unlocked by using the new micro SIM card    To use this new micro SIM card  call or contact T Mobile  customer service for more information     This card contains the necessary information for identifying  and authenticating the user to the IMS  IP Multimedia  Subsystem      Getting Started 9    Installing and Removing the SIM card  This device uses a different type of SIM card called a  micro    SIM      Slot     Other larger SIM cards will not function or fit within this    To install the SIM card     1     10       Carefully slide the micro SIM card into the SIM card  socket until it clicks into place     Correct    Micro SIM card   Make sure that the card   s gold contacts face into the  phone and that the upper left angled corner of the card  is positioned as shown     To remove the micro SIM card   1  Remove the battery cover   2  Carefully place your fingernail into the end of the micro  SIM slot and push the card slightly out   3  Carefully slide the card out of the micro SIM card  socket     Note  If the card is not inserted correctly  the device will not    detect it and no service will be available  If this happens   turn off the device  remove the card  and reinstall the  card in the correct orientation     Installing the microSD Memory Card  Your device supports an optional  external  microSD   memory cards for storage of media such as music  pictures   video and other files  The SD card is designed for use with  this mobile device a
399. uetooth  or other wireless devices    Exposure to very loud sound has also been associated in  some studies with tinnitus  a ringing in the ear    hypersensitivity to sound  and distorted hearing  Individual  susceptibility to noise induced hearing loss and potential  hearing problem varies  Additionally  the amount of sound  produced by a portable audio device varies depending on the  nature of the sound  the device settings  and the headphones    that are used  As a result  there is no single volume setting   that is appropriate for everyone or for every combination of   sound  settings  and equipment    You should follow some common sense recommendations   when using any portable audio device      Always turn the volume down before plugging the earphones into  an audio source      Set the volume in a quiet environment and select the lowest  volume at which you can hear adequately      Be aware that you can adapt to higher volume settings over time   not realizing that the higher volume may be harmful to your  hearing      When using headphones  turn the volume down if you cannot  hear the people speaking near you or if the person sitting next to  you can hear what you are listening to      Do not turn the volume up to block out noisy surroundings  If you  choose to listen to your portable device in a noisy environment   use noise cancelling headphones to block out background  environmental noise  By blocking background environment noise   noise cancelling headphones should
400. uidelines  This mobile phone has a FCC ID  number  A3LSGHM919  Model Number  SGH M919  and the  specific SAR levels for this mobile phone can be found at the  following FCC website http   www fcc gov oet ea     The SAR information for this device can also be found on  Samsung s website  http   www samsung com sar        SAR information on this and other model phones can be  accessed online on the FCC s website through http     transition fcc gov oet rfsafety sar html  To find information that  pertains to a particular model phone  this site uses the phone  FCC ID number which is usually printed somewhere on the  case of the phone  Sometimes it may be necessary to  remove the battery pack to find the number  Once you have  the FCC ID number for a particular phone  follow the  instructions on the website and it should provide values for  typical or maximum SAR for a particular phone  Additional  SAR information can also be obtained at  http   www fcc gov encyclopedia specific absorption rate sar   cellular telephones           Health and Safety Information 361    FCC Part 15 Information to User    Pursuant to part 15 21 of the FCC Rules  you are cautioned  that changes or modifications not expressly approved by  Samsung could void your authority to operate the device     This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules   Operation is subject to the following two conditions   1  This  device may not cause harmful interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference 
401. umber                 82 Synchronizing Contacts                   122  Speed Dialing              0 0 0 cece eae 82 Display Options                    008  123  Wi Fi Calling 2 0 0 0    00 0 cece eee e eee 84 Adding more Contacts via Accounts  In Call Options                      00   87 ana  SYNC oos oboedire neris 124  Using S Voice               cece eee 93 Additional Contact Options                 125  LOGS TaD odsta niati E ko ee 94 GROUPS de serrer rd ER eie 127   Section 5  Entering Text                              98 The Favorites Tab                  0 08  129  Text Input Methods                  0005 98 Section 7  Messages                                 130  Selecting the Text Input Method             98 Types of Messages                 005  130  Entering Text Using Swype                 99 Creating and Sending Messages            131    2    Message Options                 0005 132    Viewing Newly Received Messages         136  Deleting Messages             sssueusse 138  Message Search                      139  Messaging Settings                     139  Assigning Messages as Spam             142  Accessing Your Spam Folder              144  Text Templates                  00005 144  Using Email               0 00000000  144  Microsoft Exchange Email  Outlook          150  Using Google Mail                      155  Google Talk          60 0 0 00 eee eee 157  161175110  essit ree 158  Google    onnon ennenen ennnen 160  Messenger             000 000s ee eee 1
402. umber cannot be assigned to this slot     3  Press m and then tap Change order   4  Tap the current entry then tap the new target speed  dial location     Note  Tapping 2 existing speed dial locations causes the  entries to switch positions     5  Tap Done  to store the change   6  Press to return to the previous screen     Removing a Speed Dial Entry  1  From the Home screen  tap K Keypad tab   2  Press i      and then tap Speed dial setting    3  Touch and hold a existing on screen speed dial  location and select Remove from the context menu   epe  Press     and then tap Remove  Tap an entry and  select  x   Remove entry   Select either Done     to complete the deletion  or Cancel  to exit      4  Press    to return to the previous screen     Making a Call Using Speed Dial  You can assign a short cut number to a phone number in the  Contacts List for speed dialing    1  From the Home screen  tap  3    2  Touch and hold a previously created speed dial location   numbers 2 100  or 1 if you are dialing voice mail  until  the number begins to dial    3  If you are not certain of the speed dial location  tap  Ww  gt      gt  Speed dial setting and tap a speed  dial number to view the assigned phone number           Call Functions and Contacts List 83    Wi Fi Calling  Wi Fi Calling is a free feature for T Mobile customers using  this device with the new SIM card  Wi Fi Calling is an  excellent solution for coverage issues in and around the  home or wherever cellular coverage is 
403. unctions  adds additional search shortcuts to the places screen     Lookout Security    Lookout Security    provides mobile device specific security  features that are coupled with a minimal performance hit   Lookout Mobile Security provides key security options that  are unique to the mobile market  Along with the antivirus and  anti malware tech  there s a lost and stolen phone locator  service  an application privacy adviser  and a backup service     1     From the Home screen  tap  9  Lookout Security    Tap Next    Read the on screen descriptions and activate those  desired features  Tap Next to progress to the next  Screen   Tap Done to complete the setup    Create a Lookout account by entering an email address  and account password    Re enter the password and tap Start Protecting     ERE  Apps   gt     Applications and Development   231    Maps  Google Maps allow you to track your current location  view  real time traffic issues  and view detailed destination  directions  There is also a search tool included to help you  locate places of interest or a specific address  You can view  locations on a vector or aerial map  or you can view locations  at the street level     Important  Before using Google Maps you must have an active    data  3G 4G LTE  or Wi Fi connection  The Maps  application does not cover every country or city     m From the Home screen  tap E  Apps   gt   2a  Maps      Important  For best results  it is recommended that you enable    all of your locat
404. und calls   When enabled  the designated prefix is always added before  your dialed numbers   Ex  If you were using 999 as your area code  555 5555  would be dialed as 999   555 5555   1  From the Home screen  tap  Phone    2  Press     and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional  settings     3  Tap Auto area code  enter a new prefix  and then tap  OK     Call Barring  Configures the device to barr  prevent  selected outbound  calls  a  1  From the Home screen  tap  Phone    2  Press   and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional  settings     3  Tap Call barring and select from the available settings   Choose from  All outgoing calls  International calls  Intl     calls except home  All incoming calls  or Incoming  when roaming     316    Call Waiting    1   2     From the Home screen  tap  Phone     Press ml and then tap Call settings Additional  settings    Tap Call waiting to enable disable the on screen    notification of new incoming call during an active call     Fixed Dialing Numbers  Fixed Dial Number  FDN   allows you to restrict outgoing calls  to a limited set of phone numbers    Enabling FDN    1   2     3   4     Important  Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code  If your SIM card    From the Home screen  tap Ww  Phone     Press     and then tap Call settings  gt  Additional  settings  gt  Fixed dialing numbers    Tap Enable FDN    At the prompt  enter your PIN2 code and tap OK     does not  this menu does not display    The PIN2 code is provided by your carrier  Enteri
405. unning  applications  m  1  From the Home screen  press      and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Applications manager   2  Tap DOWNLOADED  RUNNING  or ALL to display memory  usage for that category of applications   The graph at the bottom of the Downloaded tab shows  used and free device memory  The graph at the bottom  of the Running tab shows used and free RAM     Downloaded  Displays apps you have downloaded onto your device    1  From the Home screen  press     1  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Applications manager    2  Tap the DOWNLOADED tab to view a list of all the  downloaded applications on your device    3  To switch the order of the lists displayed in the  Downloaded tabs  press   1  and select Sort by size or  Sort by name  l    4  Tap an application to view and update information  about the application  including memory usage  default  settings  and permissions     Running Services  The Running services option allows you to view and control  currently running services such as Backup  Google Talk  SNS   messaging   Swype  and more    1  From the Home screen  press    1  and then tap  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  Application manager    2  Tap the RUNNING tab to view all currently active and  running applications  This tab also shows the total RAM  being used by these currently active applications    3  Tapa process and select Stop to end the process and  stop it from running  When you stop the process the  service or application will no longer run
406. unt    on page 21     6  Atthe Got Google  screen  choose either Yes to log into  your existing Google account or No to continue    e  f you selected Yes  on the Sign in screen  enter your current  Google Email and Password information and tap  D  Next    e Tap OK to agree to the Google legal agreements    e If prompted to enable purchases  tap Set up credit card and  enter your credit card information and click Save    e Click Skip to continue without entering this information    7  If you indicated that you did not have a current Google  account  then at the Make it Google screen  choose  either Get an account to create a new account or  Not now to continue     8  Select deselect the desired Google  amp  location services  and tap     Next      Note  Enabling Google location services can drain battery  power     9  When prompted  enter a First and Last name then tap   3  Next   This will help to identify this as your  device    10  When prompted with the Dropbox activation screen     you can choose to either  Create account  Sign in   Disclaimer  or tap Skip to continue     Note  For more information  refer to  Dropbox  on page 224     11  From the Learn about key features screen     Tap an available field to display an on screen tutorial   e Turn on a feature by sliding the activation slider to the ON    position  BM     12  Tap Next     Getting Started     17    13  Accept the current device name       Tap the Device name field and use the on screen  keyboard to rename yo
407. unts simultaneously in one convenient  location   There are currently three main types of email accounts on  your phone  Gmail  Internet based email  Gmail  Yahoo  etc      and Microsoft Exchange  Corporate email or Outlook      To send and receive email messages through an ISP  Internet  Service Provider  account  or if you wish to use your device  to access your corporate email through a VPN  Virtual Private  Network   you will first need to set up an IMAP or POP  account        MAP  Internet Message Access Protocol    This protocol is  frequently used in large networks and commercial settings   IMAP4 is the current standard       POPS  Post Office Protocol    This protocol is supported by most  ISPs  Internet service providers  and common among consumer  applications  POP3 is the current standard       Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync   This protocol is frequently  used with a large corporate email server system and provides  access to email  contact  and calendar synchronization     Creating an Internet Email Account  1  From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt   ei   Email    2  If you already have other email account setup     Open an existing email account  press    l and then tap    Settings  gt      Add account      Account name    Fo inh    A Loading messages          Access available  accounts and  folders    Enter your Email address and Password information       Email address  your Internet email address       Password  typically your network access password   case s
408. ur device     Important  The device name is also used to provide an  identification for your device   s Bluetooth and Wi Fi  Direct names     14  Tap Finish to complete the setup process   15  Read the on screen Collect diagnostics information     Note  This software collects only diagnostic data from your    device so that T Mobile technicians can better  troubleshoot issues with your device     16  Select either More Info  to read additional information   or Close to close the message screen     18    Important  Selecting Close only closes the current description    screen and does not disable data collection    To disable data collection  go to Settings  gt   Accounts tab  gt  Backup and reset  gt  Collect  diagnostics and turn off the Allow diagnostics to be  collected feature  For more information  refer to     Collect Diagnostics    on page 343     Switching the Device On or Off   Once the device has been configured  you will not be   prompted with setup screens again    To turn the device on    Ww Press and hold       o  Power End  until the device   switches on  E  The device searches for your network and after finding  it  you can make or receive calls     Note  The display language is preset to English at the factory   To change the language  use the Language menu  For  more information  refer to    Language and Input  Settings    on page 325     To turn the device off   1  Press and hold            Power End  until the Device  options screen appears     2  Tap Powe
409. urrent application on the  Screen    When launching applications that contain multimedia  files  music video   audio from both files will be played  simultaneously     In this example we will be launching both the Internet and  Maps applications   1  Launch an application     From the Home screen  tap  CD intemen   2  Activate the Multi window feature   3  Tapthe tab to display the apps panel   4  Touch and hold the desired app  such as Maps  until it  detaches from the panel   5  Inasingle motion  drag it over the current app and  drop the new Multi window app over either the top or  bottom area of the current on screen app     EE  Apps   gt     Note  Once two applications are running  the device displays a    split screen view containing both the initial app and the  new Multi window app   Each application is still independent of the other     Understanding Your Device 61    To switch the arrangement of the applications     1     To increase the size of a  desired application window     1     62    With the two Appii Split Maximize  applications shown in a  Split screen  tap the WE  D Em  Border bar to show the  Railing wn  on screen icons    Tap the desired  application area  top or  bottom   ES  Locate and tap oo   Switch app location    The current apps are  switched     With the two   applications shown ina App  2 Border Switch  split screen  locate the Bar Positions  Border bar indicating   the edge of the app window     In a single motion  touch and hold the Border ba
410. ustomizing 67  Replacing 68    Q  Quick Dialing 76  Quick Messaging 132   R    Recently used Applications  Accessing 64  Red Eye  Correction 180  Redialing the last number 82  Reducing Exposure  Hands Free Kits and Other  Accessories 358  Reject Call  Rejection Messages 311  Reject Calls  Managing 79  Reject List  Add To 80  Add to 95  96  Adding 116  Auto Reject 80  Removing 116  Rejection List  Assigning Multiple Numbers 80    Assigning Single Numbers 80  Rejection Messages   Set Up 311  Reset 343  Reset App Preferences 350  Reset Device 343  Responsible Listening 371  Restarting   Device 19  Restore 339  Restrict   Background Data 289  Restricting Children s Access to Your  Mobile device 376  Ringtone   Assigning 312  319   Device 308   Volume 307  rvice 207    S Beam 297  On 175  297  Sharing Multiple Pictures 176  Sharing Pictures 175    405    S Memo  Creating a New Memo 246  S Translator  Translate Text 248  Translate Using Voice 249  S Voice 249  Set Wake Up Command 299  Using 93  Samsung Account  Backing Up Bookmarks 342  Creating 21  Merge Contacts 115  Samsung Hub  Creating a New Account 186  Using 186  Samsung Keyboard 103  ABC Mode 105  Changing the Input Type 104  Enabling 103  Entering Symbols 106  Handwriting Settings 326  Predictive Text Settings 327  Reset Settings 327  Settings 326    406    Symbol Numeric Mode 106  Samsung Link  Configuring Settings 206  Definitions 251  Deregister Storage 207  Sharing Files 208  Sharing Media 209  Uploading Images to Web 
411. vX video up to HD 720p  including premium content    ABOUT DIVX VIDEO  DivX is a digital video format created by DivX  LLC  a subsidiary of Rovi Corporation  This is an official DivX   Certified  device that has passed rigorous testing to verify that it plays DivX video  Visit www divx com for more information and   software tools to convert your files into DivX videos    ABOUT DIVX VIDEO ON DEMAND  This DivX Certified  device must be registered in order to play purchased DivX   Video on Demand  VOD  movies  To obtain your registration code  locate the DivX VOD section in your device setup menu  tap   Apps  gt  Settings  gt  More tab  gt  About device  gt  Legal information  gt  License settings  gt  DivX   VOD  gt  Register   Go to vod divx com for   more information on how to complete your registration    Dynamic Noise Suppression from Audience   Your phone is equipped with an advanced voice processing chip that delivers clear mobile calls by suppressing background noise    intermittent sounds  like a siren or nearby conversation   and echoes  allowing you to hear and be heard nearly anywhere    How Does It Work    Based on the intelligence of the human hearing system  the technology      Captures  evaluates and distinguishes all the sound signals surrounding your phone  and the person you re speaking with      Then isolates the primary voice in conversation and filters out the background noise   so the person you re calling hears only your voice   without disturbing backgr
412. ve to opt out of this dispute resolution procedure  Opting  out of this dispute resolution procedure will not affect the  coverage of the Limited Warranty in any way  and you will  continue to enjoy the benefits of the Limited Warranty     Severability    If any portion of this Limited Warranty is held to be illegal or  unenforceable  such partial illegality or unenforceability shall  not affect the enforceability of the remainder of the Limited  Warranty     Precautions for Transfer and Disposal    If data stored on this device is deleted or reformatted using  the standard methods  the data only appears to be removed  on a superficial level  and it may be possible for someone to  retrieve and reuse the data by means of special software    To avoid unintended information leaks and other problems of  this sort  it is recommended that the device be returned to  Samsung   s Customer Care Center for an Extended File  System  EFS  Clear which will eliminate all user memory and  return all settings to default settings  Please contact the  Samsung Customer Care Center for details     Important  Please provide warranty information  proof of  purchase  to Samsung   s Customer Care Center in  order to provide this service at no charge  If the  warranty has expired on the device  charges may  apply     Warranty Information 383    Samsung Telecommunications America  LLC   1301 E  Lookout Drive   Richardson  Texas 75082   Phone  1 800 SAMSUNG   Phone  1 888 987 HELP  4357    92012 Samsung
413. vice     Displays when the an outbound file transfer is in  progress     Displays when a file or application download is in  progress     Displays when the Share shot option is enabled  from within the Camera Shooting mode menu and  images and being shared via Wi Fi Direct    For more information  referto  Camera Options  on  page 164     Understanding Your Device 35    Displays whenascreen capture has been taken and  stored in the clipboard   For more information  refer to  Using Motions and  Gestures  on page 55     Displays when your device is connected being  used to control streaming media and is connected  to a Digital Living Network Alliance  DLNA   certified devices     Displays when your device is currently sharing   streaming media to paired device using the  Samsung Link application     Displays when AllShare Cast Hub is active   connected to your device  and communicating     For more information  referto  AllShare Cast Hub     on page 210     Displays when updates are available for download     Displays when a Play Store download has  completed     2     PM    a     ID m E25     Displays when Wi Fi is connected  active  and  communicating with a Wireless Access Point     WAP      Displays when Wi Fi is active and there is an  available open wireless network     Displays when Wi Fi Direct is active and  configured for a direct connection to another  compatible device in the same direct  communication mode     Displays when Wi Fi Direct is communicating  with anoth
414. vice with other users    Enable Share shot    Multimedia 173    To enable Wi Fi Direct  SEM  Note  The target device must also have Wi Fi Direct service    active and running before it can be detected by your  device     Important  The target device must already be connected to the    same Wi Fi and have its Wi Fi Direct feature active  and scanning before you can your pairing         5  Tap Done  The direct connection is then established   From the Home screen  press T    and then tap Confirm appears in the Status bar   Settings  gt  MISI  Connections tab   6  When prompted to complete the connection  the  In a single motion touch and slide the Wi Fi slider to the recipient should tap OK  Your status field now reads  right to turn it on  The slider color indicates the  Connected  and your connected device is listed within  activation status  the Wi Fi Direct devices listing     Tap Wi Fi Direct  7  Each partner  including yourself  must then tap Accept      Tap Scan and select the single device name to begin    the connection process to another Wi Fi Direct    to consent to the new Wi Fi Direct pairing     To enable Share shot on Camera     compatible device  1  From the Home screen  tap ie  Camera   gt  e   er  Quick Settings   gt   lt     Share   gt    a  Share shot   Tap Multi connect Scan and select all the device 2  If you are prompted to activate your Wi Fi Direct    names to begin the connection process to these Wi Fi  Direct compatible devices     connection  tap OK 
415. will not be able  1o use Samsung Link      My device  displays your device name as it is used with  Samsung Link  Tap to change the device name      Save to  allows you to save your media to your internal phone  memory or to an SD card      Auto upload  allows you to enable automatic upload of images  from your device to those storage locations specified within the  Web storage list  Move the slider to the on position to activate  the feature      Video optimization  allows you to setup the video quality for  streamed video content  Move the slider to the on position to  activate the feature    Password lock  allows you to restrict access to Samsung Link  by requiring a user enter the currently active and associated  Samsung account password  Move the slider to the on position  to activate the feature      My account  displays Samsung account information      Customer support  allows you to contact the Samsung Link  team via a new email from an available email account                   About this service  displays application information     Setting Up Web Storage    Web storage services allow you to use storage space to store  your files and share them on the  Cloud      Note  If you are using another Web storage service  log into    that service first before using Samsung Link     1  From the Home screen  tap dE  Apps   gt       Samsung Link    gt  DEVICES  amp  STORAGE     Note  When adding storage  an N Drive is added     2  If not already signed into your Cloud storage  
416. with  the device  launching Keypad  etc    you might be  accidentally swiping over the front sensors     Call Functions and Contacts List     75    Quick Dialing a Number from the Contacts List   1  From the Home screen  tap Es  Contacts     2  Locate a contact from the list    3  Ina single motion  touch and drag your finger over the  number by going to the right  This action places a call  to the recipient    Running a Call in the Background    If you exit the current call screen and return to the Home  Screen  you are visually notified that you are still on an active  call by the green phone icon within the Status bar    This is the best way to stay on your current call and do  something else  multi task  such as access the Contacts list   view a recent email  locate a picture  etc      In Call Notification    Story Album       76    Ending a Call  m Briefly tap Eh key to end the call     Note  To redial a recent number  tap at the end of the call    or locate the number from the Logs list  tap the entry  and tap Call     Ending a Call from the Status Bar   1  From an active call  you can launch a separate  application or return to the Home screen  The current  call is kept active in the background    2  Tap the Status bar to reveal the Notifications tab  and  then drag the tab to the bottom of the screen to open  the Notifications panel  1     3  Tap End to end the currently active call  2      Making Emergency Calls  If you do not have a SIM card installed the first time
417. with a unique  name  Ex  Work   then tap Done     152    Opening an Exchange Email  1  From the Home screen  tap EE  gt      Email    2  Tap the account name field  upper left  to open the  complete email account list page   3  Select an exchange email account and tap an email  message     Refreshing Exchange Email  1  From the Home screen  tap ER  gt      Email    2  Select an email account   e  f you are already in an email account  tap the account name  field  upper left  to open the complete email account list page   e Select an available email account     3  Tap  Refresh      Composing Exchange Email    m For more information  refer to    Composing Email    on  page 147     Deleting an Exchange Email Message    Touch and hold an email  from your inbox list  and  select Delete from the on screen context menu   With the email message displayed  tap Ur  Delete      Configuring Microsoft Exchange Email Settings    1     From the Home screen  press  I and then tap  Settings and then navigate to the Accounts area   Tap the Microsoft Exchange account and Settings  gt    lt Exchange email account gt      or    From the Home screen  tap ER  gt   9  Email    select an account  and press A and then tap  Settings  gt    Account       Alter any of the following settings      Email notifications  Activates the email notification icon to  appear within the Notifications area of the status bar when a  new email is received      Select ringtone  Plays a selected ringtone when a new email
418. wnloading 242  NFC  Near Field Communication  296  Noise Reduction 88  Non Market Applications 244  Notification   Vibration Setting 307  Notification Bar 38   Using 38  Notifications   Volume 307   0   On Off Switch 18  Operating Environment 373  Optical Reader 104  240  Organizer   Calculator 216   World Clock 222  Other Important Safety Information  377  Out of Office   Message 154   Settings 154    404    Outlook 144    Overview  Home Screen 40  P  Palm Motion    Activate 56  333   Capture Screen 334   Mute Pause 334   On 56  178  333  Passpoint   On 282  Passwords   Make Visible 346  Pause   Adding to a Contact 114  Pause Dialing 81  Personal Localized Alerting Network   PLAN  362  Personalize   Call Sound 87  Phone   Icons 32   Switching on off 18    Phone number   Finding 75  Phone Ringtone 308  Phone Vibration 308  Photo   Editing 179  Photo Reader   Detect Text 170  Photos   Options 169  170  172   Sharing 169  170  172  Picture   Color Correction 180   Face Corrections 180   Frame 180   Set As 178   Streaming from Gallery 177  Picture In Picture 183  Pictures   Instant Sharing 173   Sharing 173  175    Play Books 240  Play Music 242  Play Store 242  Quick Access 43  Pointer Speed  Configuration 331  Power  Auto Adjust Screen Tone 305  Power Saving  CPU Power 321  Haptic Feedback 322  LCD Adjustment 305  Learning About 322  Screen Power 321  Power Saving Mode 321  Predictive Text  Activation 327  Prepend  Area Code 316  Primary Shortcuts 42  Adding and Deleting 67  C
419. y  This  procedure allows you to copy numbers saved to the phone   s  memory  onto the SIM card   1  From the Home screen  tap 2    2  From the Contacts List  press     and then tap  Import Export  gt  Export to SIM card   3  Tap Select all to choose all current phone contact  entries    or   Select a specific entry by touching an entry  A check  mark indicates a selection     4  Tap Done  The name and phone number for the  selected contact is then copied to the SIM     Contacts 121    Copying Contact Information to the microSD  Card    This procedure allows you to copy entry information saved  on the phone s memory  onto the SIM card     1  From the Home screen  tap m8     2  From the Contacts List  press Iri and then tap  Import Export  gt  Export to SD card   3  Tap OK to choose all current phone contact entries     122    Synchronizing Contacts  Syncing data from your managed accounts allows you to add  and manage a new or existing contact from your online or  remote accounts to your phone  Prior to syncing  you must  first have an active Google or Microsoft Exchange account  with current Contact entries  and be signed into your account  via the phone   With syncing  any Contacts entries  with phone numbers   email addresses  pictures  etc   are updated and synced with  your device  ER  1  From the Home screen  press FA and then tap  Settings  gt   Accounts tab  and then navigate  to the My accounts area   2  Selectthe email account containing the contacts you  wish to sy
420. y service     What are the limits on SAMSUNG s liability     THIS LIMITED WARRANTY SETS OUT THE FULL EXTENT OF  SAMSUNG S RESPONSIBILITIES  AND THE EXCLUSIVE  REMEDY REGARDING THE PRODUCTS     ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING WITHOUT  LIMITATION  IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  ARE LIMITED TO  THE DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY  IN NO EVENT  SHALL SAMSUNG BE LIABLE FOR DAMAGES IN EXCESS OF  THE PURCHASE PRICE OF THE PRODUCT OR FOR  WITHOUT  LIMITATION  COMMERCIAL LOSS OF ANY SORT  LOSS OF  USE  TIME  DATA  REPUTATION  OPPORTUNITY  GOODWILL   PROFITS OR SAVINGS  INCONVENIENCE  INCIDENTAL   SPECIAL  CONSEQUENTIAL OR PUNITIVE DAMAGES  OR  DAMAGES ARISING FROM THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE  PRODUCT  SOME STATES AND JURISDICTIONS DO NOT  ALLOW LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED WARRANTY  LASTS  OR THE DISCLAIMER OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  S0 THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS  AND DISCLAIMERS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU    SAMSUNG MAKES NO WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS   EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE  AS TO  THE QUALITY  CAPABILITIES  OPERATIONS  PERFORMANCE    OR SUITABILITY OF ANY THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR  EQUIPMENT USED IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE PRODUCT  OR  THE ABILITY TO INTEGRATE ANY SUCH SOFTWARE OR  EQUIPMENT WITH THE PRODUCT  WHETHER SUCH  THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT IS INCLUDED WITH  THE PRODUCT DISTRIBUTED BY SAMSUNG OR OTHERWISE   RESPONSIBILITY FOR THE QUALITY  CAPABILITIES   OPERATIONS  PERFOR
421. you must send notice by e mail to  optout sta samsung com  with the subject line   Arbitration  Opt Out   You must include in the opt out e mail  a  your  name and address   b  the date on which the device was  purchased   c  the device model name or model number  and   d  the IMEI or MEID or Serial Number  as applicable  if you  have it  the IMEI or MEID or Serial Number can be found  i  on  the device box   ii  on the device information screen  which  can be found under  Settings    iii  on a label on the back of  the device beneath the battery  if the battery is removable   and  iv  on the outside of the device if the battery is not  removable   Alternatively  you may opt out by calling  1 888 987 4357 no later than 30 calendar days from the    date of the first consumer purchaser s purchase of the  device and providing the same information  These are the  only two forms of notice that will be effective to opt out of  this dispute resolution procedure  Opting out of this dispute  resolution procedure will not affect your use of the device or  its preloaded Software  and you will continue to enjoy the  benefits of this license    16  ENTIRE AGREEMENT  SEVERABILITY  This EULA is the  entire agreement between you and Samsung Electronics Co   relating to the Software and supersedes all prior or  contemporaneous oral or written communications  proposals  and representations with respect to the Software or any other  subject matter covered by this EULA  If any provision of this 
422. your Circles  use Messenger for fast  messaging with everyone in your Circles  or use Instant  Upload to automatically upload videos and photos to your  own private album on Google      1     160    Sign on to your Google account  For more information     refer to    Creating a New Google Account    on page 19     From the Home screen  tap EA  Apps   gt    Google      Select the account you want to use to sign in to  Google      or    Tap Add account to create another account     4  Follow the on screen instructions to use Google    5  Visit www google com mobile    for more information   Messenger    Messenger allows you to bring groups of friends together into  a simple group conversation  When you get a new  conversation in Messenger  Google   sends an update to your  device     1        Sign on to your Google account  For more information   refer to  Creating a New Google Account  on page 19     From the Home screen  tap EE  Apps   gt    Messenger      From the Google   application  select Messenger   Select the account you want to use to sign in to  Google     Tap Add account to create another account     10     When prompted  configure the Sync contacts  parameter  Sync contacts or Don t sync  and tap  Continue    When prompted  configure the Instant Upload  parameters as desired and tap DONE    Follow any on screen setup instructions    At the Messenger screen  tap to start a new  message    In the upper text field  enter a name  email address  or  circle    In the bot
423. your device enter a sleep mode  your Wi Fi  connection stays on all the time  If the feature is Never    enabled during sleep that current data usage is taken over by  your SIM and its network connection     1     From the Home screen  press     1 and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi    Press     and then tap Advanced  gt  Keep Wi Fi on  during sleep    Select an available option      Always  maintains your current active Wi Fi connection even  during sleep     Only when plugged in  maintains the active Wi Fi connection  only when the device detects it is connected to a power supply   This reduced the drain on your device s battery      Never  increase data usage   shuts off the current Wi Fi  connection during sleep and diverts any current data usage to  the cellular network connection           Check for Internet Service    Allows you to check for Wi Fi Internet access once connected  to a WAP  Wireless Access Point      1     From the Home screen  press    and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi    Press    and then tap Advanced    Tap the Check for Internet service field to activate the  feature  A green check mark indicates the feature is  active     Changing Your Settings 283    Finding your WI Fi Address Information  1  From the Home screen  press 11 and then tap  Settings  gt  Connections tab  gt  Wi Fi   2  Press   and then tap Advanced   3  Locate the MAC Address and IP Address information at  the bottom of the screen     MAC address
424. ys  On hold  The new active call displays a green  background behind the number     Turning the Speakerphone on and off  While on a call  you can use your Speakerphone by following  these steps   1  Tap        4    Speaker off  to toggle the speakerphone on     Speaker                2  Tap ied  Speaker on  to toggle the speakerphone off        Tip  When the speaker is turned On  the color of the speaker is    green  When the speaker is turned Off  the color of the  speaker is white     Muting a Call  1  Tap    Mute off  to turn mute on so the other caller  cannot hear you speaking   2  Tap  amp   Mute on  to turn mute off and resume your  conversation                       Switching to Bluetooth Headset   1  Pairthe target Bluetooth headset prior to your call    2  While on a call  switch to the Bluetooth headset instead  of speaker by tapping      Headset off     3  Atthe prompt  tap OK to enable Bluetooth if it is not  already activated    4  While on a call  switch back to the device speaker by  tapping Q  Headset on      Headset                            More In call Options  During a call you can save the current caller   s information to  the Contacts list  or create a Memo   Viewing the Contacts List  During a call you can look up a number in the Contacts list   1  Press    and then tap Contacts   2  Browse the Contacts list for the information you need   3  Press to return to the active call     Call Functions and Contacts List 89    Creating a Message During a Call
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
Product Manual  8月17日 通知された消費者事故等の対応状況について[PDF  Samsung PS-42C96HD Felhasználói kézikönyv  Impex STB-98005 Owner's Manual  G Data AntiVirus Client  Retail Teller Oracle FLEXCUBE Universal Banking Release 11.3.1.0  SCOTT SDM 10 PK  Home Decorators Collection ASGM2831 Instructions / Assembly    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file